Don't use the abbreviation "win" to refer to Windows (Bug#10421).
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @include gnus-overrides.texi
4
5 @setfilename ../../info/gnus
6 @settitle Gnus Manual
7 @syncodeindex fn cp
8 @syncodeindex vr cp
9 @syncodeindex pg cp
10
11 @documentencoding UTF-8
12
13 @copying
14 Copyright @copyright{} 1995-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
15
16 @quotation
17 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
18 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
19 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
20 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual'',
21 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
22 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
23
24 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
25 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
26 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
27 @end quotation
28 @end copying
29
30 @iftex
31 @iflatex
32 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
33 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
34 \usepackage{pagestyle}
35 \usepackage{epsfig}
36 \usepackage{pixidx}
37 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
38
39 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
40 \else
41 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
42 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
43 \pdfcompresslevel=9
44 \fi
45
46 \makeindex
47 \begin{document}
48
49 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
50 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
51 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
52 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
53
54 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
55
56 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
57 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
58 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
59 \else
60 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
61 \fi
62 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
63 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
64
65 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
67
68 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
70 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
75 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
77 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
78 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
79 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
80 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
81 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
82 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
85 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
89 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
92
93 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
95 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
96 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
97 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
98 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
99 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
100 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
101 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
104 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
106
107 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
109 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
110 }
111
112 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
113
114 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
115 {\mbox{}}
116 }
117
118 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
119 \gnusdimen 0pt
120
121 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
122 \gnuscleardoublepage
123 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
124 \chapter{#2}
125 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
126 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
127 \thispagestyle{empty}
128 \hspace*{-2cm}
129 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
130 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
131 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
132 \end{picture}
133 \clearpage
134 }
135
136 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
137 \begin{figure}
138 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
139 #3
140 \end{picture}
141 \caption{#1}
142 \end{figure}
143 }
144
145 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
146 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
147 }
148
149 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
150 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
151 }
152
153 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
154 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
155 }
156
157 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
158 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
159 }
160
161 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
162
163 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
164 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
165 \section{#1}
166 }
167
168 \newenvironment{codelist}%
169 {\begin{list}{}{
170 }
171 }{\end{list}}
172
173 \newenvironment{asislist}%
174 {\begin{list}{}{
175 }
176 }{\end{list}}
177
178 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
179 {\begin{list}{}{
180 \labelwidth=0cm
181 }
182 }{\end{list}}
183
184 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
185 {\begin{list}{}{
186 }
187 }{\end{list}}
188
189 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
190 {\begin{list}{}{
191 }
192 }{\end{list}}
193
194 \newenvironment{samplist}%
195 {\begin{list}{}{
196 }
197 }{\end{list}}
198
199 \newenvironment{varlist}%
200 {\begin{list}{}{
201 }
202 }{\end{list}}
203
204 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
205 {\begin{list}{}{
206 }
207 }{\end{list}}
208
209 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
210 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
211 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
212
213 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
214 {
215 {
216 \ifodd\count0
217 {
218 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
219 }
220 \else
221 {
222 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
223 }
224 }
225 \fi
226 }
227 }
228 {
229 \ifodd\count0
230 \mbox{} \hfill
231 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
232 \else
233 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
234 \hfill \mbox{}
235 \fi
236 }
237
238 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
239 {
240 {
241 \ifodd\count0
242 {
243 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
244 }
245 \else
246 {
247 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
248 }
249 \fi
250 }
251 }
252 {
253 \ifodd\count0
254 \mbox{} \hfill
255 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
256 \else
257 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
258 \hfill \mbox{}
259 \fi
260 }
261
262 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
263 {
264 {
265 \ifodd\count0
266 {
267 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
268 }
269 \else
270 {
271 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
272 }
273 \fi
274 }
275 }
276 {
277 \ifodd\count0
278 \mbox{} \hfill
279 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
280 \else
281 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
282 \hfill \mbox{}
283 \fi
284 }
285
286 \pagenumbering{roman}
287 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
288
289 @end iflatex
290 @end iftex
291
292 @iftex
293 @iflatex
294
295 \begin{titlepage}
296 {
297
298 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
299 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
300 \parindent=0cm
301 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
302
303 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
304 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
305 \vfill
306 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
307 \vfill
308 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
309 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
310 \newpage
311 }
312
313 \mbox{}
314 \vfill
315
316 \thispagestyle{empty}
317
318 @c @insertcopying
319 \newpage
320 \end{titlepage}
321 @end iflatex
322 @end iftex
323
324 @dircategory Emacs network features
325 @direntry
326 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
327 @end direntry
328 @iftex
329 @finalout
330 @end iftex
331
332
333 @titlepage
334 @ifset WEBHACKDEVEL
335 @title Gnus Manual (DEVELOPMENT VERSION)
336 @end ifset
337 @ifclear WEBHACKDEVEL
338 @title Gnus Manual
339 @end ifclear
340
341 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
342 @page
343 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
344 @insertcopying
345 @end titlepage
346
347 @summarycontents
348 @contents
349
350 @node Top
351 @top The Gnus Newsreader
352
353 @ifinfo
354
355 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
356 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
357 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
358 luck.
359
360 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
361 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
362
363 @ifnottex
364 @insertcopying
365 @end ifnottex
366
367 @end ifinfo
368
369 @iftex
370
371 @iflatex
372 \tableofcontents
373 \gnuscleardoublepage
374 @end iflatex
375
376 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
377 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
378
379 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
380 being accused of plagiarism:
381
382 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
383 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
384 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
385 can even read news with it!
386
387 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
388 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
389 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
390 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
391 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
392 the program.
393
394 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
395 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
396
397 @heading Other related manuals
398 @itemize
399 @item Message manual: Composing messages
400 @item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
401 @item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
402 @item EasyPG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
403 @item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
404 @end itemize
405
406 @end iftex
407
408 @menu
409 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
410 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
411 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
412 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
413 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
414 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
415 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
416 * Searching:: Mail and News search engines.
417 * Various:: General purpose settings.
418 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
419 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
420 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
421 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
422 * Key Index:: Key Index.
423
424 Other related manuals
425
426 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
427 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
428 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
429 * EasyPG:(epa). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
430 * SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
431
432 @detailmenu
433 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
434
435 Starting Gnus
436
437 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
438 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
439 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
440 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
441 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
442 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
443 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
444 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
445 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
446 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
447
448 New Groups
449
450 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
451 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
452 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
453
454 Group Buffer
455
456 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
457 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
458 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
459 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
460 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
461 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
462 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
463 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
464 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
465 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
466 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
467 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
468 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
469 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
470 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
471 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
472 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
473 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
474
475 Group Buffer Format
476
477 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
478 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
479 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
480
481 Group Topics
482
483 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
484 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
485 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
486 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
487 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
488
489 Misc Group Stuff
490
491 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
492 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
493 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
494 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
495 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
496
497 Summary Buffer
498
499 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
500 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
501 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
502 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
503 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
504 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
505 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
506 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
507 * Threading:: How threads are made.
508 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
509 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
510 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
511 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
512 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
513 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
514 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
515 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
516 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
517 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
518 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
519 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
520 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
521 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
522 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
523 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
524 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
525 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
526 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
527 or reselecting the current group.
528 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
529 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
530 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
531 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
532
533 Summary Buffer Format
534
535 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
536 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
537 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
538 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
539
540 Choosing Articles
541
542 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
543 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
544
545 Reply, Followup and Post
546
547 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
548 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
549 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
550 * Canceling and Superseding::
551
552 Marking Articles
553
554 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
555 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
556 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
557 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
558 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
559 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
560
561 Threading
562
563 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
564 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
565
566 Customizing Threading
567
568 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
569 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
570 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
571 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
572
573 Decoding Articles
574
575 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
576 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
577 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
578 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
579 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
580 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
581
582 Decoding Variables
583
584 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
585 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
586 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
587
588 Article Treatment
589
590 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
591 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
592 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
593 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
594 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
595 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
596 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
597 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
598 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys, Gravatars
599 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
600 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
601
602 Alternative Approaches
603
604 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
605 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
606
607 Various Summary Stuff
608
609 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
610 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
611 * Summary Generation Commands::
612 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
613
614 Article Buffer
615
616 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
617 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
618 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
619 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
620 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
621
622 Composing Messages
623
624 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
625 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
626 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
627 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
628 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
629 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
630 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
631 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
632 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
633
634 Select Methods
635
636 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
637 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
638 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
639 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
640 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
641 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
642 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
643 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
644 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
645
646 Server Buffer
647
648 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
649 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
650 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
651 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
652 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
653 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
654 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
655
656 Getting News
657
658 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
659 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
660
661 @acronym{NNTP}
662
663 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
664 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
665 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
666
667 Getting Mail
668
669 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
670 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
671 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
672 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
673 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
674 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
675 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
676 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
677 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
678 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
679 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
680 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
681 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
682
683 Mail Sources
684
685 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
686 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
687 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
688
689 Choosing a Mail Back End
690
691 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
692 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
693 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
694 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
695 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
696 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
697 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
698
699 Browsing the Web
700
701 * Archiving Mail::
702 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
703 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
704 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
705
706 Other Sources
707
708 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
709 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
710 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
711 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
712 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
713
714 Document Groups
715
716 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
717
718 Combined Groups
719
720 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
721
722 Email Based Diary
723
724 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
725 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
726 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
727
728 The NNDiary Back End
729
730 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
731 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
732 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
733
734 The Gnus Diary Library
735
736 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
737 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
738 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
739 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
740
741 Gnus Unplugged
742
743 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
744 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
745 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
746 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
747 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
748 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
749 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
750 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
751 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
752 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
753 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
754 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
755 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
756 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
757
758 Agent Categories
759
760 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
761 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
762 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
763
764 Agent Commands
765
766 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
767 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
768 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
769
770 Scoring
771
772 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
773 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
774 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
775 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
776 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
777 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
778 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
779 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
780 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
781 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
782 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
783 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
784 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
785 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
786 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
787 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
788
789 Advanced Scoring
790
791 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
792 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
793 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
794
795 Searching
796
797 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
798 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
799
800 nnir
801
802 * What is nnir?:: What does nnir do.
803 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
804 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up nnir.
805
806 Setting up nnir
807
808 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
809
810 Various
811
812 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
813 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
814 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
815 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
816 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
817 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
818 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
819 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
820 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
821 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
822 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
823 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
824 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
825 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
826 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
827 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
828 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
829 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
830 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
831
832 Formatting Variables
833
834 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
835 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
836 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
837 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
838 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
839 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
840 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
841 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
842
843 Image Enhancements
844
845 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
846 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
847 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
848 meant to be shown.
849 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
850 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
851 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
852
853 Thwarting Email Spam
854
855 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
856 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
857 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
858 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
859
860 Spam Package
861
862 * Spam Package Introduction::
863 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
864 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
865 * Spam and Ham Processors::
866 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
867 * Spam Back Ends::
868 * Extending the Spam package::
869 * Spam Statistics Package::
870
871 Spam Statistics Package
872
873 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
874 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
875 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
876
877 Appendices
878
879 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
880 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
881 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
882 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
883 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
884 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
885 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
886 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
887 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
888
889 History
890
891 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
892 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
893 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
894 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
895 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
896 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
897 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
898 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
899
900 New Features
901
902 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
903 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
904 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
905 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
906 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
907 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
908 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13
909 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
910
911 Customization
912
913 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
914 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
915 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
916 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
917
918 Gnus Reference Guide
919
920 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
921 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
922 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
923 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
924 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
925 * Group Info:: The group info format.
926 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
927 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
928 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
929
930 Back End Interface
931
932 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
933 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
934 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
935 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
936 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
937 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
938
939 Various File Formats
940
941 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
942 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
943
944 Emacs for Heathens
945
946 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
947 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
948
949 @end detailmenu
950 @end menu
951
952 @node Starting Up
953 @chapter Starting Gnus
954 @cindex starting up
955
956 If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
957 Heathens} first.
958
959 @kindex M-x gnus
960 @findex gnus
961 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
962 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
963 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
964 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
965 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
966 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
967
968 @findex gnus-other-frame
969 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
970 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
971 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
972
973 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
974 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
975 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
976
977 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
978 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
979
980 @menu
981 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
982 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
983 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
984 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
985 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
986 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
987 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
988 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
989 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
990 @end menu
991
992
993 @node Finding the News
994 @section Finding the News
995 @cindex finding news
996
997 First of all, you should know that there is a special buffer called
998 @code{*Server*} that lists all the servers Gnus knows about. You can
999 press @kbd{^} from the Group buffer to see it. In the Server buffer,
1000 you can press @kbd{RET} on a defined server to see all the groups it
1001 serves (subscribed or not!). You can also add or delete servers, edit
1002 a foreign server's definition, agentize or de-agentize a server, and
1003 do many other neat things. @xref{Server Buffer}.
1004 @xref{Foreign Groups}. @xref{Agent Basics}.
1005
1006 @vindex gnus-select-method
1007 @c @head
1008 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1009 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1010 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1011 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
1012 secondary or foreign groups.
1013
1014 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1015 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1016
1017 @lisp
1018 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1019 @end lisp
1020
1021 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1022
1023 @lisp
1024 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1025 @end lisp
1026
1027 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1028 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1029 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1030 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1031
1032 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1033 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1034 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1035 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1036 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1037 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1038 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1039 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1040 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1041
1042 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1043 @kindex B (Group)
1044 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1045 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1046 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1047 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1048 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1049 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1050
1051 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1052 @c @head
1053 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1054 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1055 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1056 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1057 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1058 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1059 groups are.
1060
1061 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1062 you would typically set this variable to
1063
1064 @lisp
1065 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1066 @end lisp
1067
1068
1069
1070 @node The Server is Down
1071 @section The Server is Down
1072 @cindex server errors
1073
1074 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1075 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1076 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1077
1078 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1079 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1080 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1081 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1082 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1083 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1084 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1085
1086 @findex gnus-no-server
1087 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1088 @c @head
1089 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1090 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1091 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1092 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1093 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1094 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1095 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1096
1097
1098 @node Slave Gnusae
1099 @section Slave Gnusae
1100 @cindex slave
1101
1102 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1103 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1104 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1105 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1106
1107 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1108 @file{.newsrc} file.
1109
1110 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1111 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1112 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1113 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1114 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1115 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1116 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1117
1118 @findex gnus-slave
1119 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1120 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1121 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1122 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1123 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1124 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1125 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1126 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1127
1128 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1129 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1130
1131 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1132 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1133 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1134 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1135 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1136
1137
1138
1139 @node New Groups
1140 @section New Groups
1141 @cindex new groups
1142 @cindex subscription
1143
1144 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1145 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1146 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1147 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1148 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1149 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1150 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1151 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1152 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1153
1154 @menu
1155 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1156 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1157 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1158 @end menu
1159
1160
1161 @node Checking New Groups
1162 @subsection Checking New Groups
1163
1164 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing
1165 the list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of
1166 subscribed and dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method.
1167 If @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will
1168 ask the server for new groups since the last time. This is both
1169 faster and cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list
1170 of killed groups (@pxref{Group Levels}) altogether, so you may set
1171 @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to @code{nil}, which will save time both
1172 at startup, at exit, and all over. Saves disk space, too. Why isn't
1173 this the default, then? Unfortunately, not all servers support this
1174 command.
1175
1176 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1177 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1178 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1179 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1180 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1181 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1182 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1183 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1184 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1185 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1186 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1187
1188 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1189 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1190 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1191 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1192 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1193 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1194
1195
1196 @node Subscription Methods
1197 @subsection Subscription Methods
1198
1199 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1200 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1201 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1202
1203 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1204 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1205
1206 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1207
1208 @table @code
1209
1210 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1211 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1212 Make all new groups zombies (@pxref{Group Levels}). This is the
1213 default. You can browse the zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either
1214 kill them all off properly (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them
1215 (with @kbd{u}).
1216
1217 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1218 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1219 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1220 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1221
1222 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1223 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1224 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1225
1226 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1227 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1228 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1229 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1230 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1231 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1232 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1233 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1234 up. Or something like that.
1235
1236 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1237 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1238 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1239 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1240 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1241
1242 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1243 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1244 Kill all new groups.
1245
1246 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1247 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1248 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1249 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1250 topic parameter that looks like
1251
1252 @example
1253 "nnml"
1254 @end example
1255
1256 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1257 that topic.
1258
1259 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1260 top-level topic.
1261
1262 @end table
1263
1264 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1265 A closely related variable is
1266 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1267 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1268 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1269 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1270 hierarchy or not.
1271
1272 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1273 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1274 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1275 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1276
1277
1278 @node Filtering New Groups
1279 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1280
1281 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1282 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1283 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1284
1285 @example
1286 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1287 @end example
1288
1289 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1290 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1291 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1292 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1293 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1294 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1295 subscribing these groups.
1296 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1297 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1298
1299 The ``options -n'' format is very simplistic. The syntax above is all
1300 that is supports -- you can force-subscribe hierarchies, or you can
1301 deny hierarchies, and that's it.
1302
1303 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1304 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1305 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1306 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1307 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1308 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1309 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1310 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1311
1312 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1313 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1314 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1315 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1316 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1317 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1318 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1319 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1320 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, @code{nnimap}, and
1321 @code{nnmaildir}) subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this
1322 variable to @code{nil}.
1323
1324 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-categories
1325 As if that wasn't enough, @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-categories} also
1326 allows you to specify that new groups should be subscribed based on the
1327 category their select methods belong to. The default is @samp{(mail
1328 post-mail)}, meaning that all new groups from mail-like backends
1329 should be subscribed automatically.
1330
1331 New groups that match these variables are subscribed using
1332 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1333
1334
1335 @node Changing Servers
1336 @section Changing Servers
1337 @cindex changing servers
1338
1339 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1340 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1341 very flaky and you want to use another.
1342
1343 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1344 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1345
1346 @emph{Wrong!}
1347
1348 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1349 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1350 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1351 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1352 worthless.
1353
1354 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1355 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1356 You can use the @kbd{M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups}
1357 command to clear out all data that you have on your native groups.
1358 Use with caution.
1359
1360 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1361 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1362 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1363 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1364
1365 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1366 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1367 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1368 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1369 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1370 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1371 cache for all groups).
1372
1373
1374 @node Startup Files
1375 @section Startup Files
1376 @cindex startup files
1377 @cindex .newsrc
1378 @cindex .newsrc.el
1379 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1380
1381 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1382 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1383 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1384 read.
1385
1386 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1387 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1388 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1389 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1390 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1391 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1392 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1393
1394 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1395 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1396 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1397 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1398 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1399 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1400
1401 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1402 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1403 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1404 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1405 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1406 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1407 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1408 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1409 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1410 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1411 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1412 news reader.
1413
1414 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1415 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1416 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1417 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1418 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1419 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1420 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1421 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1422 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1423 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1424 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1425 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1426
1427 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1428 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1429 @vindex version-control
1430 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1431 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1432 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1433 If you want to keep multiple numbered backups of this file, set
1434 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1435 @code{version-control} variable.
1436
1437 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1438 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1439 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1440 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1441 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1442 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1443 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1444 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1445 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1446 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1447
1448 @lisp
1449 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1450 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1451
1452 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1453 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1454 @end lisp
1455
1456 @vindex gnus-init-file
1457 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1458 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1459 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1460 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1461 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1462 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1463 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1464 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1465 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1466 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1467 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1468 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1469 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1470
1471
1472 @node Auto Save
1473 @section Auto Save
1474 @cindex dribble file
1475 @cindex auto-save
1476
1477 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1478 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1479 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1480 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1481 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1482 this file.
1483
1484 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1485 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1486 saved.
1487
1488 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1489 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1490 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1491
1492 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1493 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1494 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1495 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1496 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1497 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1498
1499 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1500 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1501 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1502
1503
1504 @node The Active File
1505 @section The Active File
1506 @cindex active file
1507 @cindex ignored groups
1508
1509 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1510 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1511 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1512
1513 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1514 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1515 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1516 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1517 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1518 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1519 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1520
1521 @c This variable is
1522 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1523 @c if you set it to anything else.
1524
1525 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1526 @c @head
1527 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1528 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1529 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1530
1531 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1532 you actually subscribe to.
1533
1534 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1535 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1536 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1537 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1538
1539 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1540 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1541 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1542 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1543 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1544 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1545
1546 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1547 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1548 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1549 variable.
1550
1551 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1552 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1553 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1554 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1555 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1556 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1557
1558 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1559 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1560
1561 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1562 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1563
1564 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1565 secondary select methods.
1566
1567
1568 @node Startup Variables
1569 @section Startup Variables
1570
1571 @table @code
1572
1573 @item gnus-load-hook
1574 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1575 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1576 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1577 times you start Gnus.
1578
1579 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1580 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1581 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is started.
1582
1583 @item gnus-startup-hook
1584 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1585 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1586
1587 @item gnus-started-hook
1588 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1589 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1590 successfully.
1591
1592 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1593 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1594 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1595 generating the group buffer.
1596
1597 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1598 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1599 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1600 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1601 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1602 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1603 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1604 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1605
1606 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1607 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1608 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1609 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1610 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1611 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1612
1613 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1614 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1615 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1616
1617 @item gnus-use-backend-marks
1618 @vindex gnus-use-backend-marks
1619 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will store article marks both in the
1620 @file{.newsrc.eld} file and in the backends. This will slow down
1621 group operation some.
1622
1623 @end table
1624
1625
1626 @node Group Buffer
1627 @chapter Group Buffer
1628 @cindex group buffer
1629
1630 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1631 @c
1632 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1633 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1634 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1635 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1636 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1637 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1638 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1639 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1640 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1641 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1642 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1643 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1644 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1645 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1646 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1647 @c human rights at 9...
1648
1649
1650 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1651 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1652 long as Gnus is active.
1653
1654 @iftex
1655 @iflatex
1656 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1657 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1658 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1659 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1660 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1661 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1662 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1663 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1664 }
1665 @end iflatex
1666 @end iftex
1667
1668 @menu
1669 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1670 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1671 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1672 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1673 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1674 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1675 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1676 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1677 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1678 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1679 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1680 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1681 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1682 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1683 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1684 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1685 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
1686 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1687 @end menu
1688
1689
1690 @node Group Buffer Format
1691 @section Group Buffer Format
1692
1693 @menu
1694 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1695 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1696 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1697 @end menu
1698
1699 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1700 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1701 available in Emacs.
1702
1703 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1704 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1705 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1706 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1707 Emacs version.
1708
1709 @node Group Line Specification
1710 @subsection Group Line Specification
1711 @cindex group buffer format
1712
1713 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1714 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1715
1716 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1717
1718 @example
1719 25: news.announce.newusers
1720 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1721 @end example
1722
1723 Quite simple, huh?
1724
1725 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1726 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1727 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1728 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1729
1730 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1731 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1732 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1733 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1734 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1735 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1736
1737 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1738
1739 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1740 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1741 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1742 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1743 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1744
1745 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1746 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1747 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1748
1749 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1750
1751 @table @samp
1752
1753 @item M
1754 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1755
1756 @item S
1757 Whether the group is subscribed.
1758
1759 @item L
1760 Level of subscribedness.
1761
1762 @item N
1763 Number of unread articles.
1764
1765 @item I
1766 Number of dormant articles.
1767
1768 @item T
1769 Number of ticked articles.
1770
1771 @item R
1772 Number of read articles.
1773
1774 @item U
1775 Number of unseen articles.
1776
1777 @item t
1778 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1779 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1780
1781 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1782 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1783 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1784 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1785 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1786 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1787 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1788
1789 The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1790 compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1791 renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1792 getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1793 future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1794 date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1795 server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
1796
1797 @item y
1798 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1799
1800 @item i
1801 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1802
1803 @item g
1804 Full group name.
1805
1806 @item G
1807 Group name.
1808
1809 @item C
1810 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1811 comment element in the group parameters.
1812
1813 @item D
1814 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1815 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1816 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1817 command.
1818
1819 @item o
1820 @samp{m} if moderated.
1821
1822 @item O
1823 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1824
1825 @item s
1826 Select method.
1827
1828 @item B
1829 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1830
1831 @item n
1832 Select from where.
1833
1834 @item z
1835 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1836 used.
1837
1838 @item P
1839 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1840
1841 @item c
1842 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1843 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1844 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1845 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1846 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1847
1848 @item m
1849 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1850 @cindex %
1851 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1852 the group lately.
1853
1854 @item p
1855 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1856
1857 @item d
1858 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1859 Timestamp}).
1860
1861 @item F
1862 The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1863 agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1864 megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1865 of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1866
1867 @item u
1868 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1869 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1870 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1871 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1872 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1873 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1874 specifier.
1875 @end table
1876
1877 @cindex *
1878 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1879 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1880 group, or a bogus native group.
1881
1882
1883 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1884 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1885 @cindex group mode line
1886
1887 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1888 The mode line can be changed by setting
1889 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1890 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1891
1892 @table @samp
1893 @item S
1894 The native news server.
1895 @item M
1896 The native select method.
1897 @end table
1898
1899
1900 @node Group Highlighting
1901 @subsection Group Highlighting
1902 @cindex highlighting
1903 @cindex group highlighting
1904
1905 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1906 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1907 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1908 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1909 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1910
1911 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1912 background is dark:
1913
1914 @lisp
1915 (cond (window-system
1916 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1917 (defface my-group-face-1
1918 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1919 (defface my-group-face-2
1920 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1921 "Second group face")
1922 (defface my-group-face-3
1923 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1924 (defface my-group-face-4
1925 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1926 (defface my-group-face-5
1927 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1928
1929 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1930 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1931 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1932 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1933 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1934 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1935 @end lisp
1936
1937 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1938
1939 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1940 include:
1941
1942 @table @code
1943 @item group
1944 The group name.
1945 @item unread
1946 The number of unread articles in the group.
1947 @item method
1948 The select method.
1949 @item mailp
1950 Whether the group is a mail group.
1951 @item level
1952 The level of the group.
1953 @item score
1954 The score of the group.
1955 @item ticked
1956 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1957 @item total
1958 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1959 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1960 @item topic
1961 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1962 topic being inserted.
1963 @end table
1964
1965 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1966 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1967 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1968
1969 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1970 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1971 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1972 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
1973
1974
1975 @node Group Maneuvering
1976 @section Group Maneuvering
1977 @cindex group movement
1978
1979 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1980 expected, hopefully.
1981
1982 @table @kbd
1983
1984 @item n
1985 @kindex n (Group)
1986 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1987 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1988 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1989
1990 @item p
1991 @itemx DEL
1992 @kindex DEL (Group)
1993 @kindex p (Group)
1994 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1995 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1996 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1997
1998 @item N
1999 @kindex N (Group)
2000 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2001 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2002
2003 @item P
2004 @kindex P (Group)
2005 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2006 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2007
2008 @item M-n
2009 @kindex M-n (Group)
2010 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2011 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2012 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2013
2014 @item M-p
2015 @kindex M-p (Group)
2016 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2017 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2018 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2019 @end table
2020
2021 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2022
2023 @table @kbd
2024
2025 @item j
2026 @kindex j (Group)
2027 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2028 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2029 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2030 like living groups.
2031
2032 @item ,
2033 @kindex , (Group)
2034 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2035 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2036 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2037
2038 @item .
2039 @kindex . (Group)
2040 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2041 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2042 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2043 @end table
2044
2045 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2046 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2047 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2048 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2049 is @code{t}.
2050
2051 @vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2052 If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2053 exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2054 Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2055 @code{t}.
2056
2057 @node Selecting a Group
2058 @section Selecting a Group
2059 @cindex group selection
2060
2061 @table @kbd
2062
2063 @item SPACE
2064 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2065 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2066 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2067 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2068 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2069 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2070 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2071 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2072 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2073 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2074
2075 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2076 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2077 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2078
2079 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2080 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2081 ones.
2082
2083 @item RET
2084 @kindex RET (Group)
2085 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2086 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2087 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2088 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2089 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2090 entry.
2091
2092 @item M-RET
2093 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2094 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2095 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2096 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2097 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2098 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2099 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2100 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2101 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2102 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2103
2104 @item M-SPACE
2105 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2106 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2107 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2108 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2109 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2110
2111 @item C-M-RET
2112 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2113 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2114 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2115 doing any processing of its contents
2116 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2117 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2118 manner will have no permanent effects.
2119
2120 @end table
2121
2122 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2123 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2124 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2125 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2126 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2127 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2128 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2129 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2130 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2131 most recently will be fetched.
2132
2133 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2134 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2135 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2136 newsgroups.
2137
2138 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
2139 In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2140 very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2141 such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2142 for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2143 are actually only the articles 1-10 and 29999900-30000000, Gnus doesn't
2144 know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2145 it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2146 stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
2147 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2148 The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2149 latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2150 get only the articles 29990001-30000000 (if the latest article number is
2151 30000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2152 prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2153 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2154 means Gnus never ignores old articles.
2155
2156 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2157 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2158 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2159 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2160 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2161 Which article this is controlled by the
2162 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2163 variable are:
2164
2165 @table @code
2166
2167 @item unread
2168 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2169
2170 @item first
2171 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2172
2173 @item unseen
2174 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2175
2176 @item unseen-or-unread
2177 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2178 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2179 unread article.
2180
2181 @item best
2182 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2183
2184 @end table
2185
2186 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2187 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2188
2189 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2190 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2191 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2192 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2193 selected.
2194
2195
2196 @node Subscription Commands
2197 @section Subscription Commands
2198 @cindex subscription
2199
2200 The following commands allow for managing your subscriptions in the
2201 Group buffer. If you want to subscribe to many groups, it's probably
2202 more convenient to go to the @ref{Server Buffer}, and choose the
2203 server there using @kbd{RET} or @kbd{SPC}. Then you'll have the
2204 commands listed in @ref{Browse Foreign Server} at hand.
2205
2206 @table @kbd
2207
2208 @item S t
2209 @itemx u
2210 @kindex S t (Group)
2211 @kindex u (Group)
2212 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2213 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2214 Toggle subscription to the current group
2215 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2216
2217 @item S s
2218 @itemx U
2219 @kindex S s (Group)
2220 @kindex U (Group)
2221 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2222 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2223 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2224 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2225
2226 @item S k
2227 @itemx C-k
2228 @kindex S k (Group)
2229 @kindex C-k (Group)
2230 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2231 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2232 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2233
2234 @item S y
2235 @itemx C-y
2236 @kindex S y (Group)
2237 @kindex C-y (Group)
2238 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2239 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2240
2241 @item C-x C-t
2242 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2243 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2244 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2245 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2246 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2247
2248 @item S w
2249 @itemx C-w
2250 @kindex S w (Group)
2251 @kindex C-w (Group)
2252 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2253 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2254
2255 @item S z
2256 @kindex S z (Group)
2257 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2258 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2259
2260 @item S C-k
2261 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2262 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2263 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2264 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2265 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2266 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2267 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2268 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2269 @file{.newsrc} file.
2270
2271 @end table
2272
2273 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2274
2275
2276 @node Group Data
2277 @section Group Data
2278
2279 @table @kbd
2280
2281 @item c
2282 @kindex c (Group)
2283 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2284 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2285 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2286 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2287 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2288 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2289 the group buffer.
2290
2291 @item C
2292 @kindex C (Group)
2293 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2294 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2295 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2296
2297 @item M-c
2298 @kindex M-c (Group)
2299 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2300 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2301 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2302
2303 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2304 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2305 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2306 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2307 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2308 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2309 caution.
2310
2311 @end table
2312
2313
2314 @node Group Levels
2315 @section Group Levels
2316 @cindex group level
2317 @cindex level
2318
2319 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2320 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2321 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2322 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2323 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2324
2325 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2326
2327 @table @kbd
2328
2329 @item S l
2330 @kindex S l (Group)
2331 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2332 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2333 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2334 prompted for a level.
2335 @end table
2336
2337 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2338 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2339 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2340 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2341 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2342 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2343 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2344 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2345 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2346 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2347 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2348 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2349 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2350 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2351 reasons of efficiency.
2352
2353 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2354 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2355
2356 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2357 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2358 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2359 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2360 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2361 groups are hidden, in a way.
2362
2363 @cindex zombie groups
2364 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2365 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2366 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2367 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2368 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2369 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2370
2371 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2372 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2373 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2374 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2375 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2376 list of killed groups.)
2377
2378 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2379 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2380 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2381
2382 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2383 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2384 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2385 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2386 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2387 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2388 relevant valid ranges.
2389
2390 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2391 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2392 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2393 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2394 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2395 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2396 rest.
2397
2398 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2399 one with the best level.
2400
2401 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2402 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2403 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2404 by default.
2405 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2406 be called and the result will be used as value.
2407
2408
2409 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2410 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2411 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2412 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2413 listed.
2414
2415 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2416 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2417 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2418 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2419
2420 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2421 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2422 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2423 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2424 to 5. The default is 6.
2425
2426
2427 @node Group Score
2428 @section Group Score
2429 @cindex group score
2430 @cindex group rank
2431 @cindex rank
2432
2433 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2434 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2435 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2436 reason?
2437
2438 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2439 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2440 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2441 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2442 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2443 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2444 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2445 least significant part.))
2446
2447 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2448 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2449 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2450 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2451 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2452 action after each summary exit, you can add
2453 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2454 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2455 slow things down somewhat.
2456
2457
2458 @node Marking Groups
2459 @section Marking Groups
2460 @cindex marking groups
2461
2462 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2463 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2464 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2465 bidding on those groups.
2466
2467 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2468 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2469 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2470
2471 @table @kbd
2472
2473 @item #
2474 @kindex # (Group)
2475 @itemx M m
2476 @kindex M m (Group)
2477 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2478 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2479
2480 @item M-#
2481 @kindex M-# (Group)
2482 @itemx M u
2483 @kindex M u (Group)
2484 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2485 Remove the mark from the current group
2486 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2487
2488 @item M U
2489 @kindex M U (Group)
2490 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2491 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2492
2493 @item M w
2494 @kindex M w (Group)
2495 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2496 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2497
2498 @item M b
2499 @kindex M b (Group)
2500 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2501 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2502
2503 @item M r
2504 @kindex M r (Group)
2505 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2506 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2507 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2508 @end table
2509
2510 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2511
2512 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2513 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2514 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2515 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2516 the command to be executed.
2517
2518
2519 @node Foreign Groups
2520 @section Foreign Groups
2521 @cindex foreign groups
2522
2523 If you recall how to subscribe to servers (@pxref{Finding the News})
2524 you will remember that @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} and
2525 @code{gnus-select-method} let you write a definition in Emacs Lisp of
2526 what servers you want to see when you start up. The alternate
2527 approach is to use foreign servers and groups. ``Foreign'' here means
2528 they are not coming from the select methods. All foreign server
2529 configuration and subscriptions are stored only in the
2530 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file.
2531
2532 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2533 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2534 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2535 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2536 consulted.
2537
2538 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2539 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2540 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2541
2542 @table @kbd
2543
2544 @item G m
2545 @kindex G m (Group)
2546 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2547 @cindex making groups
2548 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2549 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2550 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2551
2552 @item G M
2553 @kindex G M (Group)
2554 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2555 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2556 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2557
2558 @item G r
2559 @kindex G r (Group)
2560 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2561 @cindex renaming groups
2562 Rename the current group to something else
2563 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2564 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2565 on some back ends.
2566
2567 @item G c
2568 @kindex G c (Group)
2569 @cindex customizing
2570 @findex gnus-group-customize
2571 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2572
2573 @item G e
2574 @kindex G e (Group)
2575 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2576 @cindex renaming groups
2577 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2578 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2579
2580 @item G p
2581 @kindex G p (Group)
2582 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2583 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2584 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2585
2586 @item G E
2587 @kindex G E (Group)
2588 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2589 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2590 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2591
2592 @item G d
2593 @kindex G d (Group)
2594 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2595 @cindex nndir
2596 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2597 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2598
2599 @item G h
2600 @kindex G h (Group)
2601 @cindex help group
2602 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2603 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2604
2605 @item G D
2606 @kindex G D (Group)
2607 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2608 @cindex nneething
2609 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2610 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2611 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2612
2613 @item G f
2614 @kindex G f (Group)
2615 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2616 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2617 @cindex nndoc
2618 Make a group based on some file or other
2619 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2620 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2621 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2622 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2623 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2624 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2625 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2626 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2627 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2628
2629 @item G u
2630 @kindex G u (Group)
2631 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2632 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2633 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2634 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2635
2636 @item G w
2637 @kindex G w (Group)
2638 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2639 @cindex Google
2640 @cindex nnweb
2641 @cindex gmane
2642 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2643 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2644 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2645 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2646 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2647 @xref{Web Searches}.
2648
2649 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2650 to a particular group by using a match string like
2651 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2652
2653 @item G R
2654 @kindex G R (Group)
2655 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2656 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2657 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2658 @xref{RSS}.
2659
2660 @item G DEL
2661 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2662 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2663 This function will delete the current group
2664 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2665 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2666 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2667 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2668 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2669
2670 @item G V
2671 @kindex G V (Group)
2672 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2673 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2674 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2675
2676 @item G v
2677 @kindex G v (Group)
2678 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2679 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2680 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2681 @end table
2682
2683 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2684 methods.
2685
2686 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2687 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2688 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2689 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2690 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2691 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2692 newsgroups.
2693
2694
2695 The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2696 only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2697
2698 @table @code
2699 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2700 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2701 @vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2702 Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2703 HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2704 Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2705 the article range.
2706
2707 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2708 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2709 This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2710 the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
2711 given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include e.g.
2712 @url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2713 @url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2714 @url{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2715 @url{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2716 @url{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
2717
2718 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2719 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2720 Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2721 bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2722 specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2723
2724 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2725 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2726 Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2727 @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2728 @end table
2729
2730 Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2731 Buttons}.
2732
2733 Here is an example:
2734 @lisp
2735 (require 'gnus-art)
2736 (add-to-list
2737 'gnus-button-alist
2738 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2739 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2740 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2741 @end lisp
2742
2743
2744 @node Group Parameters
2745 @section Group Parameters
2746 @cindex group parameters
2747
2748 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2749
2750 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2751 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2752 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2753 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2754 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2755 Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2756 @code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2757
2758 Here's an example group parameter list:
2759
2760 @example
2761 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2762 (auto-expire . t))
2763 @end example
2764
2765 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2766 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2767 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2768 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2769
2770 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2771 is an alist of regexps and values.
2772
2773 The following group parameters can be used:
2774
2775 @table @code
2776 @item to-address
2777 @cindex to-address
2778 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2779
2780 @example
2781 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2782 @end example
2783
2784 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2785 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2786 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2787 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2788 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2789
2790 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2791 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2792 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2793 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2794 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2795 list address instead.
2796
2797 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2798
2799 @item to-list
2800 @cindex to-list
2801 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2802
2803 @example
2804 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2805 @end example
2806
2807 It is totally ignored
2808 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2809 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2810
2811 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2812 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2813 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2814 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2815 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2816
2817 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2818 @cindex mail list groups
2819 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2820 entering summary buffer.
2821
2822 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2823
2824 @anchor{subscribed}
2825 @item subscribed
2826 @cindex subscribed
2827 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2828 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2829 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2830 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2831 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2832 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2833 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2834 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2835
2836 @lisp
2837 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2838 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2839 @end lisp
2840
2841 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2842 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2843
2844 @item visible
2845 @cindex visible
2846 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2847 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2848 of whether it has any unread articles.
2849
2850 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2851 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2852
2853 @item broken-reply-to
2854 @cindex broken-reply-to
2855 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2856 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2857 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2858 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2859 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2860 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2861
2862 @item to-group
2863 @cindex to-group
2864 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2865 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2866
2867 @item newsgroup
2868 @cindex newsgroup
2869 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2870 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2871 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2872 news group.
2873
2874 @item gcc-self
2875 @cindex gcc-self
2876 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2877 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2878 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2879 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2880 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2881 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2882 (@pxref{Archived Messages}), with the exception for messages to resend.
2883
2884 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2885 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2886 doesn't accept articles.
2887
2888 @item auto-expire
2889 @cindex auto-expire
2890 @cindex expiring mail
2891 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2892 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2893 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2894
2895 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2896
2897 @item total-expire
2898 @cindex total-expire
2899 @cindex expiring mail
2900 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2901 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2902 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2903 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2904 expiry.
2905
2906 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2907
2908 @item expiry-wait
2909 @cindex expiry-wait
2910 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2911 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2912 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2913 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2914 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2915 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2916 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2917
2918 @item expiry-target
2919 @cindex expiry-target
2920 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2921 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2922
2923 @item score-file
2924 @cindex score file group parameter
2925 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2926 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2927 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2928
2929 @item adapt-file
2930 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2931 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2932 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2933 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2934
2935 @item admin-address
2936 @cindex admin-address
2937 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2938 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2939 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2940 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2941
2942 @item display
2943 @cindex display
2944 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2945 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2946
2947 @table @code
2948 @item all
2949 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2950
2951 @item an integer
2952 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2953 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2954
2955 @item default
2956 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2957 ticked articles.
2958
2959 @item an array
2960 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2961
2962 Here are some examples:
2963
2964 @table @code
2965 @item [unread]
2966 Display only unread articles.
2967
2968 @item [not expire]
2969 Display everything except expirable articles.
2970
2971 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2972 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2973 responded to.
2974 @end table
2975
2976 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2977 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2978 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2979 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2980 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, and @code{unseen}.
2981
2982 @end table
2983
2984 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2985 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2986 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2987
2988 @item comment
2989 @cindex comment
2990 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2991 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2992 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2993
2994 @item charset
2995 @cindex charset
2996 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2997 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2998 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2999
3000 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3001
3002 @item ignored-charsets
3003 @cindex ignored-charset
3004 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3005 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3006 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3007
3008 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3009
3010 @item posting-style
3011 @cindex posting-style
3012 You can store additional posting style information for this group
3013 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3014 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3015 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3016 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3017
3018 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3019 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3020 like this in the group parameters:
3021
3022 @example
3023 (posting-style
3024 (name "Funky Name")
3025 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
3026 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3027 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3028 @end example
3029
3030 If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3031 (@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3032 the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3033 groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3034 group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3035 entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3036 to.
3037
3038
3039 @item post-method
3040 @cindex post-method
3041 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3042 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3043
3044 @item mail-source
3045 @cindex mail-source
3046 If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3047 @code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3048 mail source for this group.
3049
3050 @item banner
3051 @cindex banner
3052 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3053 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3054 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3055 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3056 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3057
3058 @item sieve
3059 @cindex sieve
3060 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3061 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3062 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3063 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3064
3065 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3066 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3067 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3068 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3069
3070 @example
3071 if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3072 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3073 @}
3074 @end example
3075
3076 To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3077 like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3078 When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3079 like the following is generated:
3080
3081 @example
3082 if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3083 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3084 @}
3085 @end example
3086
3087 See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3088 interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3089
3090 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3091 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3092
3093 @item (agent parameters)
3094 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of its parameters to
3095 control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3096 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3097 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3098 minimize the configuration effort.
3099
3100 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3101 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3102 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3103 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3104 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3105 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3106 @code{eval}ed there.
3107
3108 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer
3109 if and only if @var{variable} has been bound as a variable. Otherwise,
3110 only evaluating the form will take place. So, you may want to bind the
3111 variable in advance using @code{defvar} or other if the result of the
3112 form needs to be set to it.
3113
3114 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3115 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3116 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3117 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3118 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3119 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3120 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3121
3122 @lisp
3123 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3124 @end lisp
3125
3126 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3127 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3128 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3129
3130 @example
3131 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3132 @end example
3133
3134 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3135 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3136 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3137 into the group parameters for the group.
3138
3139 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3140 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3141 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group. If
3142 @code{dummy-variable} has been bound (see above), it will be set to the
3143 (meaningless) result of the @code{(ding)} form.
3144
3145 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3146 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3147 following is added to a group parameter
3148
3149 @lisp
3150 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3151 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3152 @end lisp
3153
3154 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3155 expired.
3156
3157 @end table
3158
3159 @vindex gnus-parameters
3160 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3161 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3162 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3163 For example:
3164
3165 @lisp
3166 (setq gnus-parameters
3167 '(("mail\\..*"
3168 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3169 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3170 (gnus-summary-line-format
3171 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3172 (gcc-self . t)
3173 (display . all))
3174
3175 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3176 (to-group . "\\1"))
3177
3178 ("mail\\.me"
3179 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3180
3181 ("list\\..*"
3182 (total-expire . t)
3183 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3184 @end lisp
3185
3186 All clauses that matches the group name will be used, but the last
3187 setting ``wins''. So if you have two clauses that both match the
3188 group name, and both set, say @code{display}, the last setting will
3189 override the first.
3190
3191 Parameters that are strings will be subjected to regexp substitution,
3192 as the @code{to-group} example shows.
3193
3194 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3195 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3196 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3197 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3198 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3199 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3200 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3201 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3202 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3203 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3204 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3205 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3206
3207 You can define different sorting to different groups via
3208 @code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3209 group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3210 @acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3211 Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3212 news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3213 weekly news RSS feed
3214 @url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3215 @xref{RSS}.
3216
3217 @lisp
3218 (setq
3219 gnus-parameters
3220 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3221 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3222 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3223 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3224 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3225 ("nnrss.*debian"
3226 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3227 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3228 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3229 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3230 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3231 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3232 @end lisp
3233
3234
3235 @node Listing Groups
3236 @section Listing Groups
3237 @cindex group listing
3238
3239 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3240
3241 @table @kbd
3242
3243 @item l
3244 @itemx A s
3245 @kindex A s (Group)
3246 @kindex l (Group)
3247 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3248 List all groups that have unread articles
3249 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3250 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3251 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3252 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3253 groups).
3254
3255 @item L
3256 @itemx A u
3257 @kindex A u (Group)
3258 @kindex L (Group)
3259 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3260 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3261 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3262 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3263 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3264 unsubscribed groups).
3265
3266 @item A l
3267 @kindex A l (Group)
3268 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3269 List all unread groups on a specific level
3270 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3271 with no unread articles.
3272
3273 @item A k
3274 @kindex A k (Group)
3275 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3276 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3277 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3278 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3279 from the server.
3280
3281 @item A z
3282 @kindex A z (Group)
3283 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3284 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3285
3286 @item A m
3287 @kindex A m (Group)
3288 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3289 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3290 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3291
3292 @item A M
3293 @kindex A M (Group)
3294 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3295 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3296
3297 @item A A
3298 @kindex A A (Group)
3299 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3300 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3301 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3302 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3303 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3304 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3305 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3306 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3307
3308 @item A a
3309 @kindex A a (Group)
3310 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3311 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3312 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3313
3314 @item A d
3315 @kindex A d (Group)
3316 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3317 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3318 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3319
3320 @item A c
3321 @kindex A c (Group)
3322 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3323 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3324
3325 @item A ?
3326 @kindex A ? (Group)
3327 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3328 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3329
3330 @item A !
3331 @kindex A ! (Group)
3332 @findex gnus-group-list-ticked
3333 List all groups with ticked articles (@code{gnus-group-list-ticked}).
3334
3335 @item A /
3336 @kindex A / (Group)
3337 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3338 Further limit groups within the current selection
3339 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}). If you've first limited to groups
3340 with dormant articles with @kbd{A ?}, you can then further limit with
3341 @kbd{A / c}, which will then limit to groups with cached articles,
3342 giving you the groups that have both dormant articles and cached
3343 articles.
3344
3345 @item A f
3346 @kindex A f (Group)
3347 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3348 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3349
3350 @item A p
3351 @kindex A p (Group)
3352 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3353 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3354
3355 @end table
3356
3357 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3358 @cindex visible group parameter
3359 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3360 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3361 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3362 get the same effect.
3363
3364 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3365 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3366 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3367 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3368 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3369
3370
3371 @node Sorting Groups
3372 @section Sorting Groups
3373 @cindex sorting groups
3374
3375 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3376 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3377 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3378 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3379 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3380 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3381 include:
3382
3383 @table @code
3384
3385 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3386 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3387 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3388
3389 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3390 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3391 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3392
3393 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3394 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3395 Sort by group level.
3396
3397 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3398 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3399 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3400
3401 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3402 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3403 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3404 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3405
3406 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3407 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3408 Sort by number of unread articles.
3409
3410 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3411 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3412 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3413
3414 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3415 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3416 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3417
3418
3419 @end table
3420
3421 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3422 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3423 the last one.
3424
3425
3426 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3427 some sorting criteria:
3428
3429 @table @kbd
3430 @item G S a
3431 @kindex G S a (Group)
3432 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3433 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3434 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3435
3436 @item G S u
3437 @kindex G S u (Group)
3438 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3439 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3440 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3441
3442 @item G S l
3443 @kindex G S l (Group)
3444 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3445 Sort the group buffer by group level
3446 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3447
3448 @item G S v
3449 @kindex G S v (Group)
3450 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3451 Sort the group buffer by group score
3452 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3453
3454 @item G S r
3455 @kindex G S r (Group)
3456 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3457 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3458 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3459
3460 @item G S m
3461 @kindex G S m (Group)
3462 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3463 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3464 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3465
3466 @item G S n
3467 @kindex G S n (Group)
3468 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3469 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3470 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3471
3472 @end table
3473
3474 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3475 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3476
3477 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3478 commands will sort in reverse order.
3479
3480 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3481
3482 @table @kbd
3483 @item G P a
3484 @kindex G P a (Group)
3485 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3486 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3487 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3488
3489 @item G P u
3490 @kindex G P u (Group)
3491 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3492 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3493 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3494
3495 @item G P l
3496 @kindex G P l (Group)
3497 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3498 Sort the groups by group level
3499 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3500
3501 @item G P v
3502 @kindex G P v (Group)
3503 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3504 Sort the groups by group score
3505 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3506
3507 @item G P r
3508 @kindex G P r (Group)
3509 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3510 Sort the groups by group rank
3511 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3512
3513 @item G P m
3514 @kindex G P m (Group)
3515 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3516 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3517 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3518
3519 @item G P n
3520 @kindex G P n (Group)
3521 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3522 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3523 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3524
3525 @item G P s
3526 @kindex G P s (Group)
3527 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3528 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3529
3530 @end table
3531
3532 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3533 move groups around.
3534
3535
3536 @node Group Maintenance
3537 @section Group Maintenance
3538 @cindex bogus groups
3539
3540 @table @kbd
3541 @item b
3542 @kindex b (Group)
3543 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3544 Find bogus groups and delete them
3545 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3546
3547 @item F
3548 @kindex F (Group)
3549 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3550 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3551 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3552 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3553 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3554 zombies.
3555
3556 @item C-c C-x
3557 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3558 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3559 @cindex expiring mail
3560 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3561 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3562 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3563 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3564
3565 @item C-c C-M-x
3566 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3567 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3568 @cindex expiring mail
3569 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3570 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3571
3572 @end table
3573
3574
3575 @node Browse Foreign Server
3576 @section Browse Foreign Server
3577 @cindex foreign servers
3578 @cindex browsing servers
3579
3580 @table @kbd
3581 @item B
3582 @kindex B (Group)
3583 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3584 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3585 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3586 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3587 @end table
3588
3589 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3590 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3591 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3592 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3593
3594 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3595
3596 @table @kbd
3597 @item n
3598 @kindex n (Browse)
3599 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3600 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3601
3602 @item p
3603 @kindex p (Browse)
3604 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3605 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3606
3607 @item SPACE
3608 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3609 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3610 Enter the current group and display the first article
3611 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3612
3613 @item RET
3614 @kindex RET (Browse)
3615 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3616 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3617
3618 @item u
3619 @kindex u (Browse)
3620 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3621 @vindex gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method
3622 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3623 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}). You
3624 can affect the way the new group is entered into the Group buffer
3625 using the variable @code{gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method}. See
3626 @pxref{Subscription Methods} for available options.
3627
3628 @item l
3629 @itemx q
3630 @kindex q (Browse)
3631 @kindex l (Browse)
3632 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3633 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3634
3635 @item d
3636 @kindex d (Browse)
3637 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3638 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3639
3640 @item ?
3641 @kindex ? (Browse)
3642 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3643 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3644 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3645 @end table
3646
3647
3648 @node Exiting Gnus
3649 @section Exiting Gnus
3650 @cindex exiting Gnus
3651
3652 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3653
3654 @table @kbd
3655 @item z
3656 @kindex z (Group)
3657 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3658 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3659 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3660 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3661
3662 @item q
3663 @kindex q (Group)
3664 @findex gnus-group-exit
3665 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3666 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3667
3668 @item Q
3669 @kindex Q (Group)
3670 @findex gnus-group-quit
3671 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3672 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3673 @end table
3674
3675 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3676 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3677 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3678 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3679 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3680 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3681 exiting Gnus.
3682
3683 Note:
3684
3685 @quotation
3686 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3687 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3688 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3689 plastic chair.
3690 @end quotation
3691
3692
3693 @node Group Topics
3694 @section Group Topics
3695 @cindex topics
3696
3697 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3698 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3699 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3700 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3701 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3702 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3703
3704 @iftex
3705 @iflatex
3706 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3707 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3708 }
3709 @end iflatex
3710 @end iftex
3711
3712 Here's an example:
3713
3714 @example
3715 Gnus
3716 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3717 3: comp.emacs
3718 2: alt.religion.emacs
3719 Naughty Emacs
3720 452: alt.sex.emacs
3721 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3722 Misc
3723 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3724 13: comp.sources.unix
3725 @end example
3726
3727 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3728 @kindex t (Group)
3729 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3730 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3731 is a toggling command.)
3732
3733 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3734 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3735 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3736 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3737 Hot and bothered?
3738
3739 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3740 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3741 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3742
3743 @lisp
3744 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3745 @end lisp
3746
3747 @menu
3748 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3749 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3750 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3751 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3752 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3753 @end menu
3754
3755
3756 @node Topic Commands
3757 @subsection Topic Commands
3758 @cindex topic commands
3759
3760 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3761 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3762 definitions slightly.
3763
3764 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3765 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3766 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3767 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3768 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3769 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3770
3771 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3772 the way you like.
3773
3774 @table @kbd
3775
3776 @item T n
3777 @kindex T n (Topic)
3778 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3779 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3780 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3781
3782 @item T TAB
3783 @itemx TAB
3784 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3785 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3786 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3787 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3788 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3789 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3790
3791 @item M-TAB
3792 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3793 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3794 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3795 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3796
3797 @end table
3798
3799 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3800 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3801 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3802 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3803
3804 @table @kbd
3805
3806 @item C-k
3807 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3808 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3809 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3810 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3811
3812 @item C-y
3813 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3814 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3815 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3816 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3817 before all groups.
3818
3819 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3820 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3821 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3822 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3823 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3824
3825 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3826 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3827
3828 @end table
3829
3830 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3831 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3832 key.
3833
3834 @table @kbd
3835
3836 @item RET
3837 @kindex RET (Topic)
3838 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3839 @itemx SPACE
3840 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3841 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3842 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3843 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3844 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3845 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3846
3847 @end table
3848
3849 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3850
3851 @table @kbd
3852
3853 @item T m
3854 @kindex T m (Topic)
3855 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3856 Move the current group to some other topic
3857 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3858 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3859
3860 @item T j
3861 @kindex T j (Topic)
3862 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3863 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3864
3865 @item T c
3866 @kindex T c (Topic)
3867 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3868 Copy the current group to some other topic
3869 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3870 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3871
3872 @item T h
3873 @kindex T h (Topic)
3874 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3875 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3876 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3877
3878 @item T s
3879 @kindex T s (Topic)
3880 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3881 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3882 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3883
3884 @item T D
3885 @kindex T D (Topic)
3886 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3887 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3888 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3889 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3890 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3891 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3892 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3893 topic.
3894
3895 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3896 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3897
3898 @item T M
3899 @kindex T M (Topic)
3900 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3901 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3902 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3903
3904 @item T C
3905 @kindex T C (Topic)
3906 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3907 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3908 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3909
3910 @item T H
3911 @kindex T H (Topic)
3912 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3913 Toggle hiding empty topics
3914 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3915
3916 @item T #
3917 @kindex T # (Topic)
3918 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3919 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3920 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3921 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3922
3923 @item T M-#
3924 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3925 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3926 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3927 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3928 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3929
3930 @item C-c C-x
3931 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3932 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3933 @cindex expiring mail
3934 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3935 expiry process (if any)
3936 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3937
3938 @item T r
3939 @kindex T r (Topic)
3940 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3941 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3942
3943 @item T DEL
3944 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3945 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3946 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3947
3948 @item A T
3949 @kindex A T (Topic)
3950 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3951 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3952 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3953
3954 @item T M-n
3955 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3956 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3957 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3958
3959 @item T M-p
3960 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3961 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3962 Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3963
3964 @item G p
3965 @kindex G p (Topic)
3966 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3967 @cindex group parameters
3968 @cindex topic parameters
3969 @cindex parameters
3970 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3971 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3972
3973 @end table
3974
3975
3976 @node Topic Variables
3977 @subsection Topic Variables
3978 @cindex topic variables
3979
3980 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3981 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3982
3983 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3984 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3985 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3986 Valid elements are:
3987
3988 @table @samp
3989 @item i
3990 Indentation.
3991 @item n
3992 Topic name.
3993 @item v
3994 Visibility.
3995 @item l
3996 Level.
3997 @item g
3998 Number of groups in the topic.
3999 @item a
4000 Number of unread articles in the topic.
4001 @item A
4002 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4003 @end table
4004
4005 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4006 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4007 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4008 The default is 2.
4009
4010 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4011 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4012
4013 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4014 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4015 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4016
4017
4018 @node Topic Sorting
4019 @subsection Topic Sorting
4020 @cindex topic sorting
4021
4022 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4023 commands:
4024
4025
4026 @table @kbd
4027 @item T S a
4028 @kindex T S a (Topic)
4029 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4030 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4031 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4032
4033 @item T S u
4034 @kindex T S u (Topic)
4035 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4036 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4037 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4038
4039 @item T S l
4040 @kindex T S l (Topic)
4041 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4042 Sort the current topic by group level
4043 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4044
4045 @item T S v
4046 @kindex T S v (Topic)
4047 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4048 Sort the current topic by group score
4049 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4050
4051 @item T S r
4052 @kindex T S r (Topic)
4053 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4054 Sort the current topic by group rank
4055 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4056
4057 @item T S m
4058 @kindex T S m (Topic)
4059 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4060 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4061 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4062
4063 @item T S e
4064 @kindex T S e (Topic)
4065 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4066 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4067 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4068
4069 @item T S s
4070 @kindex T S s (Topic)
4071 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4072 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4073 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4074 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4075
4076 @end table
4077
4078 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4079 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4080 sorting.
4081
4082
4083 @node Topic Topology
4084 @subsection Topic Topology
4085 @cindex topic topology
4086 @cindex topology
4087
4088 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4089
4090 @example
4091 @group
4092 Gnus
4093 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4094 3: comp.emacs
4095 2: alt.religion.emacs
4096 Naughty Emacs
4097 452: alt.sex.emacs
4098 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4099 Misc
4100 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4101 13: comp.sources.unix
4102 @end group
4103 @end example
4104
4105 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4106 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4107 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4108 follows:
4109
4110 @lisp
4111 (("Gnus" visible)
4112 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4113 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4114 (("Misc" visible)))
4115 @end lisp
4116
4117 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
4118 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4119 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4120 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4121 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4122 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4123
4124 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4125 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4126 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4127
4128
4129 @node Topic Parameters
4130 @subsection Topic Parameters
4131 @cindex topic parameters
4132
4133 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4134 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4135 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4136 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4137 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4138
4139 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4140 parameters:
4141
4142 @table @code
4143 @item subscribe
4144 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4145 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4146 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4147 topic.
4148
4149 @item subscribe-level
4150 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4151 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4152 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4153
4154 @end table
4155
4156 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4157 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4158 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4159 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4160
4161 @example
4162 @group
4163 Gnus
4164 Emacs
4165 3: comp.emacs
4166 2: alt.religion.emacs
4167 452: alt.sex.emacs
4168 Relief
4169 452: alt.sex.emacs
4170 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4171 Misc
4172 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4173 13: comp.sources.unix
4174 452: alt.sex.emacs
4175 @end group
4176 @end example
4177
4178 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4179 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4180 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4181 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4182 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4183 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4184
4185 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4186 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4187 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4188 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4189 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4190
4191 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4192 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4193 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4194 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4195 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4196 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4197 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4198 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4199
4200
4201 @node Non-ASCII Group Names
4202 @section Accessing groups of non-English names
4203 @cindex non-ascii group names
4204
4205 There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4206 expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4207 certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4208 spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4209 course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4210 supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4211 back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4212 back end.
4213
4214 Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4215 side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4216 charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4217 Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4218 article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4219 with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4220 non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4221 the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4222
4223 @table @code
4224 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4225 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4226 An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4227 @code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4228 method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4229
4230 @lisp
4231 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4232 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4233 @end lisp
4234
4235 Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4236 ones specified for the same groups with the
4237 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4238
4239 A select method can be very long, like:
4240
4241 @lisp
4242 (nntp "gmane"
4243 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4244 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4245 (nntp-open-connection-function
4246 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4247 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4248 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4249 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4250 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4251 @end lisp
4252
4253 In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4254 variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4255 the server name.
4256
4257 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4258 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4259 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4260 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4261 @code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4262 otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4263
4264 @lisp
4265 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4266 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4267 (".*" . utf-8)))
4268 @end lisp
4269
4270 Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4271 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4272 @end table
4273
4274 Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4275 and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4276 other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4277 you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4278 all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4279 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4280
4281 There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
4282 names:
4283
4284 @table @code
4285 @item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4286 @vindex nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4287 The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}. The
4288 default is @code{nil} in Emacs, or is the aliasee of the coding system
4289 named @code{file-name} (a certain coding system of which an alias is
4290 @code{file-name}) in XEmacs.
4291
4292 The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back end, the agent, and
4293 the cache use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and
4294 directories. This variable overrides the value of
4295 @code{file-name-coding-system} which specifies the coding system used
4296 when encoding and decoding those file names and directory names.
4297
4298 In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4299 is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
4300 file names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
4301 @code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
4302 is @code{nil} or it is bound to the value of
4303 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} which is @code{nil}.
4304
4305 Normally the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system} in Emacs or
4306 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} in XEmacs is initialized according
4307 to the locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable
4308 to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4309
4310 The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4311 does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4312 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4313 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4314
4315 If @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable is
4316 initialized by default to @code{iso-latin-1} for example, although you
4317 want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese, that is the most
4318 typical case where you have to customize
4319 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}. The @code{utf-8} coding system is
4320 a good candidate for it. Otherwise, you may change the locale in your
4321 system so that @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable
4322 may be initialized to an appropriate value.
4323 @end table
4324
4325 Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4326 group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4327 names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4328 header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4329
4330
4331 @node Misc Group Stuff
4332 @section Misc Group Stuff
4333
4334 @menu
4335 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4336 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4337 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4338 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4339 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4340 @end menu
4341
4342 @table @kbd
4343
4344 @item v
4345 @kindex v (Group)
4346 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4347 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4348 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4349
4350 @lisp
4351 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4352 (lambda ()
4353 (interactive)
4354 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4355 @end lisp
4356
4357 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4358 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4359
4360 @item ^
4361 @kindex ^ (Group)
4362 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4363 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4364 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4365
4366 @item a
4367 @kindex a (Group)
4368 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4369 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4370 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4371 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4372 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4373 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4374 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4375
4376 @item m
4377 @kindex m (Group)
4378 @findex gnus-group-mail
4379 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4380 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4381 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4382 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4383
4384 @item i
4385 @kindex i (Group)
4386 @findex gnus-group-news
4387 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4388 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4389 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4390
4391 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4392 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4393 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4394 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4395 for this to work though.
4396
4397 @item G z
4398 @kindex G z (Group)
4399 @findex gnus-group-compact-group
4400
4401 Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
4402 Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
4403 gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
4404 count.
4405
4406 @end table
4407
4408 Variables for the group buffer:
4409
4410 @table @code
4411
4412 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4413 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4414 is called after the group buffer has been
4415 created.
4416
4417 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4418 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4419 is called after the group buffer is
4420 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4421 unnatural way.
4422
4423 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4424 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4425 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4426 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4427
4428 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4429 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4430 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4431 whether they are empty or not.
4432
4433 @end table
4434
4435 @node Scanning New Messages
4436 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4437 @cindex new messages
4438 @cindex scanning new news
4439
4440 @table @kbd
4441
4442 @item g
4443 @kindex g (Group)
4444 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4445 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4446 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4447 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4448 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4449 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4450 back end(s).
4451
4452 @item M-g
4453 @kindex M-g (Group)
4454 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4455 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4456 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4457 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4458 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4459 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4460 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4461
4462 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4463 @cindex activating groups
4464 @item C-c M-g
4465 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4466 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4467
4468 @item R
4469 @kindex R (Group)
4470 @cindex restarting
4471 @findex gnus-group-restart
4472 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4473 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4474 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4475
4476 @end table
4477
4478 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4479 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4480
4481 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4482 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4483 news.
4484
4485
4486 @node Group Information
4487 @subsection Group Information
4488 @cindex group information
4489 @cindex information on groups
4490
4491 @table @kbd
4492
4493
4494 @item H d
4495 @itemx C-c C-d
4496 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4497 @kindex H d (Group)
4498 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4499 @cindex describing groups
4500 @cindex group description
4501 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4502 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4503 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4504
4505 @item M-d
4506 @kindex M-d (Group)
4507 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4508 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4509 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4510
4511 @item H v
4512 @itemx V
4513 @kindex V (Group)
4514 @kindex H v (Group)
4515 @cindex version
4516 @findex gnus-version
4517 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4518
4519 @item ?
4520 @kindex ? (Group)
4521 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4522 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4523
4524 @item C-c C-i
4525 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4526 @cindex info
4527 @cindex manual
4528 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4529 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4530 @end table
4531
4532
4533 @node Group Timestamp
4534 @subsection Group Timestamp
4535 @cindex timestamps
4536 @cindex group timestamps
4537
4538 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4539 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4540 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4541
4542 @lisp
4543 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4544 @end lisp
4545
4546 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4547
4548 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4549 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4550
4551 @lisp
4552 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4553 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4554 @end lisp
4555
4556 This will result in lines looking like:
4557
4558 @example
4559 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4560 0: custom 19961002T012713
4561 @end example
4562
4563 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4564 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4565 something like:
4566
4567 @lisp
4568 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4569 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4570 @end lisp
4571
4572 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4573 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4574 trick:
4575
4576 @lisp
4577 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4578 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4579 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4580 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4581 (if time
4582 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4583 "")))
4584 @end lisp
4585
4586 To see what variables are dynamically bound (like
4587 @code{gnus-tmp-group}), you have to look at the source code. The
4588 variable names aren't guaranteed to be stable over Gnus versions,
4589 either.
4590
4591
4592 @node File Commands
4593 @subsection File Commands
4594 @cindex file commands
4595
4596 @table @kbd
4597
4598 @item r
4599 @kindex r (Group)
4600 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4601 @vindex gnus-init-file
4602 @cindex reading init file
4603 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4604 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4605
4606 @item s
4607 @kindex s (Group)
4608 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4609 @cindex saving .newsrc
4610 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4611 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4612 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4613
4614 @c @item Z
4615 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4616 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4617 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4618
4619 @end table
4620
4621
4622 @node Sieve Commands
4623 @subsection Sieve Commands
4624 @cindex group sieve commands
4625
4626 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4627 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4628 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4629 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4630 script that can be transferred to the server somehow.
4631
4632 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4633 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4634 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4635 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4636 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4637 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4638 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4639 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4640 regenerate the Sieve script.
4641
4642 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4643 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4644 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4645 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4646 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4647 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4648 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4649 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4650 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4651 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4652
4653 @example
4654 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4655 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4656 stop;
4657 @}
4658 @end example
4659
4660 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4661
4662 @table @kbd
4663
4664 @item D g
4665 @kindex D g (Group)
4666 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4667 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4668 @cindex generating sieve script
4669 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4670 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4671
4672 @item D u
4673 @kindex D u (Group)
4674 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4675 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4676 @cindex updating sieve script
4677 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4678 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4679 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4680
4681 @end table
4682
4683
4684 @node Summary Buffer
4685 @chapter Summary Buffer
4686 @cindex summary buffer
4687
4688 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4689 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4690
4691 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4692 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4693
4694 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4695
4696 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4697 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4698 available in Emacs.
4699
4700 @kindex v (Summary)
4701 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4702 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4703 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4704 @lisp
4705 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4706 @end lisp
4707
4708 @menu
4709 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4710 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4711 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4712 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4713 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4714 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4715 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4716 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4717 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4718 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4719 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4720 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4721 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4722 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4723 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4724 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4725 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4726 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4727 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4728 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4729 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4730 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4731 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4732 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4733 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4734 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4735 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4736 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4737 or reselecting the current group.
4738 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4739 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4740 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4741 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4742 @end menu
4743
4744
4745 @node Summary Buffer Format
4746 @section Summary Buffer Format
4747 @cindex summary buffer format
4748
4749 @iftex
4750 @iflatex
4751 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4752 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4753 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4754 }
4755 @end iflatex
4756 @end iftex
4757
4758 @menu
4759 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4760 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4761 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4762 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4763 @end menu
4764
4765 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4766 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4767 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4768 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4769 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4770 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4771 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4772 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4773 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4774 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4775 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4776
4777 @lisp
4778 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4779 'mail-extract-address-components)
4780 @end lisp
4781
4782 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4783 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4784 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4785 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4786
4787
4788 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4789 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4790
4791 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4792 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4793 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4794 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4795 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4796
4797 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4798 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4799 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4800 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4801 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4802 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4803
4804 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4805
4806 The following format specification characters and extended format
4807 specification(s) are understood:
4808
4809 @table @samp
4810 @item N
4811 Article number.
4812 @item S
4813 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4814 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4815 @item s
4816 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4817 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4818 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4819 @item F
4820 Full @code{From} header.
4821 @item n
4822 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4823 @item f
4824 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4825 From Newsgroups}).
4826 @item a
4827 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4828 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4829 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4830 may be more thorough.
4831 @item A
4832 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4833 the @code{a} spec.
4834 @item L
4835 Number of lines in the article.
4836 @item c
4837 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4838 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4839 @item k
4840 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4841 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4842 @item I
4843 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4844 @item B
4845 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4846 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4847
4848 @example
4849 >
4850 +->
4851 | +->
4852 | | \->
4853 | | \->
4854 | \->
4855 +->
4856 \->
4857 @end example
4858
4859 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4860 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4861 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4862 line-drawing glyphs.
4863 @table @code
4864 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4865 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4866 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4867 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4868
4869 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4870 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4871 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4872 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4873
4874 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4875 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4876 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4877 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4878
4879 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4880 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4881 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4882
4883 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4884 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4885 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4886
4887 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4888 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4889 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4890
4891 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4892 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4893 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4894
4895 @end table
4896
4897 @item T
4898 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4899 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4900 @item [
4901 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4902 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4903 @item ]
4904 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4905 for adopted articles.
4906 @item >
4907 One space for each thread level.
4908 @item <
4909 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4910 @item U
4911 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4912
4913 @item R
4914 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4915 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4916 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4917
4918 @item i
4919 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4920 @item z
4921 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4922 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4923 default level. If the difference between
4924 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4925 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4926 @item V
4927 Total thread score.
4928 @item x
4929 @code{Xref}.
4930 @item D
4931 @code{Date}.
4932 @item d
4933 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4934 @item o
4935 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4936 @item M
4937 @code{Message-ID}.
4938 @item r
4939 @code{References}.
4940 @item t
4941 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4942 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4943 @item e
4944 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4945 article has any children.
4946 @item P
4947 The line number.
4948 @item O
4949 Download mark.
4950 @item *
4951 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4952 @item &user-date;
4953 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4954 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4955 @item u
4956 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4957 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4958 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4959 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4960 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4961 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4962 @end table
4963
4964 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4965 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4966 There can only be one such area.
4967
4968 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4969 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4970 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4971 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4972 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4973 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4974
4975 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4976 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4977
4978 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4979
4980
4981 @node To From Newsgroups
4982 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4983 @cindex To
4984 @cindex Newsgroups
4985
4986 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4987 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4988 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4989 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4990 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4991
4992 @enumerate
4993 @item
4994 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4995 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4996 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4997 instance:
4998
4999 @lisp
5000 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5001 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
5002 @end lisp
5003
5004 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5005 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
5006
5007 @item
5008 @findex gnus-extra-header
5009 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5010 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5011 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
5012
5013 @example
5014 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5015 @end example
5016
5017 @item
5018 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5019 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
5020 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
5021 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
5022 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
5023 headers are used instead.
5024
5025 To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5026 has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5027 @code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5028 @samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5029 customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5030 @code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
5031
5032 @end enumerate
5033
5034 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5035 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5036 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5037 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5038 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
5039 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
5040 regeneration.
5041
5042 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5043 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5044 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5045 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
5046
5047 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5048 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
5049
5050 @lisp
5051 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5052 '(To Newsgroups))
5053 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5054 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
5055 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5056 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5057 "Your Name Here")
5058 @end lisp
5059
5060 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5061 to fit your needs.)
5062
5063 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5064 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5065 support:
5066
5067 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5068 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5069 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
5070
5071 @example
5072 Newsgroups:full
5073 @end example
5074
5075 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5076 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
5077
5078
5079 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5080 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
5081
5082 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5083 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5084 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5085 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5086
5087 Here are the elements you can play with:
5088
5089 @table @samp
5090 @item G
5091 Group name.
5092 @item p
5093 Unprefixed group name.
5094 @item A
5095 Current article number.
5096 @item z
5097 Current article score.
5098 @item V
5099 Gnus version.
5100 @item U
5101 Number of unread articles in this group.
5102 @item e
5103 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5104 summary buffer.
5105 @item Z
5106 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5107 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5108 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5109 and no unselected ones.
5110 @item g
5111 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5112 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5113 @item S
5114 Subject of the current article.
5115 @item u
5116 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5117 @item s
5118 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5119 @item d
5120 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5121 @item t
5122 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5123 @item r
5124 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5125 @item E
5126 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5127 @end table
5128
5129
5130 @node Summary Highlighting
5131 @subsection Summary Highlighting
5132
5133 @table @code
5134
5135 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5136 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5137 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5138 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5139 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5140
5141 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
5142 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5143 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5144 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5145
5146 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
5147 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5148 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5149 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
5150
5151 @item gnus-summary-highlight
5152 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5153 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5154 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5155 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5156 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5157 to something like
5158 @lisp
5159 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5160 ((> score default) . bold))
5161 @end lisp
5162 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5163 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
5164 @end table
5165
5166
5167 @node Summary Maneuvering
5168 @section Summary Maneuvering
5169 @cindex summary movement
5170
5171 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5172 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
5173
5174 None of these commands select articles.
5175
5176 @table @kbd
5177 @item G M-n
5178 @itemx M-n
5179 @kindex M-n (Summary)
5180 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
5181 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5182 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5183 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5184
5185 @item G M-p
5186 @itemx M-p
5187 @kindex M-p (Summary)
5188 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
5189 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5190 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5191 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5192
5193 @item G g
5194 @kindex G g (Summary)
5195 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5196 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5197 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5198 @end table
5199
5200 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5201 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5202 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5203 to the group buffer.
5204
5205 Variables related to summary movement:
5206
5207 @table @code
5208
5209 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5210 @item gnus-auto-select-next
5211 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5212 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5213 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5214 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5215 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5216 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5217 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5218 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5219 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5220 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5221 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5222 @pxref{Group Levels}.
5223
5224 @item gnus-auto-select-same
5225 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5226 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5227 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5228 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5229 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5230 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5231
5232 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5233
5234 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5235 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5236 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5237 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5238 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5239
5240 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5241 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5242 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5243 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5244 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5245 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5246 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5247 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5248 threads.
5249
5250 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5251 the given number of lines from the top.
5252
5253 @item gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5254 @vindex gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5255 If non-@code{nil}, don't go to the next article when hitting
5256 @kbd{SPC}, and you're at the end of the article.
5257
5258 @end table
5259
5260
5261 @node Choosing Articles
5262 @section Choosing Articles
5263 @cindex selecting articles
5264
5265 @menu
5266 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5267 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5268 @end menu
5269
5270
5271 @node Choosing Commands
5272 @subsection Choosing Commands
5273
5274 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5275 and they all select and display an article.
5276
5277 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5278 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5279
5280 @table @kbd
5281 @item SPACE
5282 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5283 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5284 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5285 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5286
5287 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5288 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5289 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5290
5291 @item G n
5292 @itemx n
5293 @kindex n (Summary)
5294 @kindex G n (Summary)
5295 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5296 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5297 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5298
5299 @item G p
5300 @itemx p
5301 @kindex p (Summary)
5302 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5303 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5304 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5305
5306 @item G N
5307 @itemx N
5308 @kindex N (Summary)
5309 @kindex G N (Summary)
5310 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5311 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5312
5313 @item G P
5314 @itemx P
5315 @kindex P (Summary)
5316 @kindex G P (Summary)
5317 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5318 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5319
5320 @item G C-n
5321 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5322 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5323 Go to the next article with the same subject
5324 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5325
5326 @item G C-p
5327 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5328 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5329 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5330 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5331
5332 @item G f
5333 @itemx .
5334 @kindex G f (Summary)
5335 @kindex . (Summary)
5336 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5337 Go to the first unread article
5338 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5339
5340 @item G b
5341 @itemx ,
5342 @kindex G b (Summary)
5343 @kindex , (Summary)
5344 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5345 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5346 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5347 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5348
5349 @item G l
5350 @itemx l
5351 @kindex l (Summary)
5352 @kindex G l (Summary)
5353 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5354 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5355
5356 @item G o
5357 @kindex G o (Summary)
5358 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5359 @cindex history
5360 @cindex article history
5361 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5362 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5363 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5364 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5365 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5366 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5367
5368 @item G j
5369 @itemx j
5370 @kindex j (Summary)
5371 @kindex G j (Summary)
5372 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5373 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5374 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5375
5376 @end table
5377
5378
5379 @node Choosing Variables
5380 @subsection Choosing Variables
5381
5382 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5383
5384 @table @code
5385 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5386 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5387 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5388 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5389 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5390 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5391
5392 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5393 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5394 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5395 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5396 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5397 hook will do so.
5398
5399 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5400 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5401 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5402 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5403 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5404 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5405 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5406 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5407 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5408 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5409 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5410 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5411 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5412 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5413
5414 @end table
5415
5416
5417 @node Paging the Article
5418 @section Scrolling the Article
5419 @cindex article scrolling
5420
5421 @table @kbd
5422
5423 @item SPACE
5424 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5425 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5426 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5427 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5428 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5429
5430 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5431 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5432 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5433 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5434 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5435 what is considered uninteresting with
5436 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5437 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5438
5439 @item DEL
5440 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5441 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5442 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5443
5444 @item RET
5445 @kindex RET (Summary)
5446 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5447 Scroll the current article one line forward
5448 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5449
5450 @item M-RET
5451 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5452 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5453 Scroll the current article one line backward
5454 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5455
5456 @item A g
5457 @itemx g
5458 @kindex A g (Summary)
5459 @kindex g (Summary)
5460 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5461 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5462 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5463 given a prefix, show a completely ``raw'' article, just the way it
5464 came from the server. If given a prefix twice (i.e., @kbd{C-u C-u
5465 g'}), fetch the current article, but don't run any of the article
5466 treatment functions.
5467
5468 @cindex charset, view article with different charset
5469 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5470 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5471 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5472
5473 @lisp
5474 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5475 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5476 (2 . big5)))
5477 @end lisp
5478
5479 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5480
5481 @item A <
5482 @itemx <
5483 @kindex < (Summary)
5484 @kindex A < (Summary)
5485 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5486 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5487 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5488
5489 @item A >
5490 @itemx >
5491 @kindex > (Summary)
5492 @kindex A > (Summary)
5493 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5494 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5495
5496 @item A s
5497 @itemx s
5498 @kindex A s (Summary)
5499 @kindex s (Summary)
5500 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5501 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5502 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5503
5504 @item h
5505 @kindex h (Summary)
5506 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5507 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5508
5509 @end table
5510
5511
5512 @node Reply Followup and Post
5513 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5514
5515 @menu
5516 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5517 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5518 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5519 * Canceling and Superseding::
5520 @end menu
5521
5522
5523 @node Summary Mail Commands
5524 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5525 @cindex mail
5526 @cindex composing mail
5527
5528 Commands for composing a mail message:
5529
5530 @table @kbd
5531
5532 @item S r
5533 @itemx r
5534 @kindex S r (Summary)
5535 @kindex r (Summary)
5536 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5537 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5538 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5539 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5540 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5541
5542 @item S R
5543 @itemx R
5544 @kindex R (Summary)
5545 @kindex S R (Summary)
5546 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5547 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5548 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5549 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5550 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5551
5552 @item S w
5553 @kindex S w (Summary)
5554 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5555 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5556 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5557 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5558 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5559 present, that's used instead.
5560
5561 @item S W
5562 @kindex S W (Summary)
5563 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5564 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5565 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5566 the process/prefix convention, but only uses the headers from the
5567 first article to determine the recipients.
5568
5569 @item S L
5570 @kindex S L (Summary)
5571 @findex gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original
5572 When replying to a message from a mailing list, send a reply to that
5573 message to the mailing list, and include the original message
5574 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original}).
5575
5576 @item S v
5577 @kindex S v (Summary)
5578 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5579 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5580 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5581 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5582 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5583 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5584
5585 @item S V
5586 @kindex S V (Summary)
5587 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5588 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5589 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5590 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5591
5592 @item S B r
5593 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5594 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5595 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5596 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5597 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5598 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5599 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5600 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5601
5602 @item S B R
5603 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5604 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5605 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5606 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5607 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5608
5609 @item S o m
5610 @itemx C-c C-f
5611 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5612 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5613 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5614 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5615 Forward the current article to some other person
5616 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5617 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5618 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5619 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5620 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5621 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5622 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5623 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5624 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5625 section.
5626
5627 @item S m
5628 @itemx m
5629 @kindex m (Summary)
5630 @kindex S m (Summary)
5631 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5632 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5633 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5634 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5635 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5636
5637 @item S i
5638 @kindex S i (Summary)
5639 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5640 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5641 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5642 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5643
5644 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5645 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5646 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5647 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5648 for this to work though.
5649
5650 @item S D b
5651 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5652 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5653 @cindex bouncing mail
5654 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5655 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5656 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5657 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5658 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5659 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5660 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5661 very well fail, though.
5662
5663 @item S D r
5664 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5665 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5666 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5667 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5668 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5669 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5670 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5671 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5672 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5673 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5674
5675 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5676 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5677 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5678 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5679 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5680
5681 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5682 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5683
5684 @item S D e
5685 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5686 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5687
5688 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5689 if it were a new message before resending.
5690
5691 @item S O m
5692 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5693 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5694 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5695 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5696 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5697
5698 @item S M-c
5699 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5700 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5701 @cindex crossposting
5702 @cindex excessive crossposting
5703 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5704 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5705
5706 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5707 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5708 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5709 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5710 command understands the process/prefix convention
5711 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5712
5713 @end table
5714
5715 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5716 Manual}, for more information.
5717
5718
5719 @node Summary Post Commands
5720 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5721 @cindex post
5722 @cindex composing news
5723
5724 Commands for posting a news article:
5725
5726 @table @kbd
5727 @item S p
5728 @itemx a
5729 @kindex a (Summary)
5730 @kindex S p (Summary)
5731 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5732 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5733 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5734 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5735 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5736
5737 @item S f
5738 @itemx f
5739 @kindex f (Summary)
5740 @kindex S f (Summary)
5741 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5742 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5743 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5744
5745 @item S F
5746 @itemx F
5747 @kindex S F (Summary)
5748 @kindex F (Summary)
5749 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5750 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5751 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5752 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5753 process/prefix convention.
5754
5755 @item S n
5756 @kindex S n (Summary)
5757 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5758 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5759 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5760
5761 @item S N
5762 @kindex S N (Summary)
5763 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5764 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5765 message through mail and include the original message
5766 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5767 the process/prefix convention.
5768
5769 @item S o p
5770 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5771 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5772 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5773 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5774 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5775 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5776 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5777 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5778 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5779 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5780 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5781 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5782 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5783
5784 @item S O p
5785 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5786 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5787 @cindex digests
5788 @cindex making digests
5789 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5790 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5791 process/prefix convention.
5792
5793 @item S u
5794 @kindex S u (Summary)
5795 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5796 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5797 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5798 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5799 @end table
5800
5801 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5802 Manual}, for more information.
5803
5804
5805 @node Summary Message Commands
5806 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5807
5808 @table @kbd
5809 @item S y
5810 @kindex S y (Summary)
5811 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5812 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5813 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5814 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5815 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5816
5817 @end table
5818
5819
5820 @node Canceling and Superseding
5821 @subsection Canceling Articles
5822 @cindex canceling articles
5823 @cindex superseding articles
5824
5825 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5826 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5827
5828 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5829
5830 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5831 @kindex C (Summary)
5832 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5833 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5834 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5835 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5836 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5837 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5838
5839 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5840 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5841 question.
5842
5843 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5844 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5845 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5846
5847 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5848 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5849 message, Message Manual}).
5850
5851 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5852 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5853 your original article.
5854
5855 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5856 @kindex S (Summary)
5857 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5858 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5859 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5860 usual way.
5861
5862 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5863 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5864 have posted almost the same article twice.
5865
5866 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5867 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5868 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5869 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5870 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5871 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5872 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5873 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5874 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5875 canceled/superseded.
5876
5877 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5878
5879 @node Delayed Articles
5880 @section Delayed Articles
5881 @cindex delayed sending
5882 @cindex send delayed
5883
5884 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5885 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5886 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5887 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5888
5889 @lisp
5890 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5891 @end lisp
5892
5893 @findex gnus-delay-article
5894 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5895 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5896 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5897 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5898
5899 @itemize @bullet
5900 @item
5901 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5902 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5903 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5904 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5905
5906 @item
5907 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5908 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5909 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5910
5911 @item
5912 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5913 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5914 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5915 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5916 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5917 that means a time tomorrow.
5918 @end itemize
5919
5920 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5921 couple of variables:
5922
5923 @table @code
5924 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5925 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5926 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5927 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5928
5929 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5930 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5931 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5932 formats described above.
5933
5934 @item gnus-delay-group
5935 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5936 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5937 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5938 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5939
5940 @item gnus-delay-header
5941 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5942 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5943 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5944 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5945 @end table
5946
5947 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5948 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5949 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5950 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5951 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5952
5953 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5954 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5955 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5956 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5957 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5958 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5959 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5960
5961 @table @code
5962 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5963 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5964 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5965 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5966 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5967 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5968 argument is ignored.
5969
5970 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5971 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5972 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5973 @end table
5974
5975 When delaying an article with @kbd{C-c C-j}, Message mode will
5976 automatically add a @code{"Date"} header with the current time. In
5977 many cases you probably want the @code{"Date"} header to reflect the
5978 time the message is sent instead. To do this, you have to delete
5979 @code{Date} from @code{message-draft-headers}.
5980
5981
5982 @node Marking Articles
5983 @section Marking Articles
5984 @cindex article marking
5985 @cindex article ticking
5986 @cindex marks
5987
5988 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5989
5990 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5991 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5992 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5993
5994 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5995
5996 @ifinfo
5997 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5998 @end ifinfo
5999
6000 @menu
6001 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
6002 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6003 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6004 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6005 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6006 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6007 @end menu
6008
6009
6010 @node Unread Articles
6011 @subsection Unread Articles
6012
6013 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6014 other.
6015
6016 @table @samp
6017 @item !
6018 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6019 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
6020
6021 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6022 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6023 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6024 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6025 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6026 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6027 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
6028
6029 @item ?
6030 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6031 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
6032
6033 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6034 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6035 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6036 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6037 messages.
6038
6039 @item SPACE
6040 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
6041 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
6042
6043 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6044 @end table
6045
6046
6047 @node Read Articles
6048 @subsection Read Articles
6049 @cindex expirable mark
6050
6051 All the following marks mark articles as read.
6052
6053 @table @samp
6054
6055 @item r
6056 @vindex gnus-del-mark
6057 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6058 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
6059
6060 @item R
6061 @vindex gnus-read-mark
6062 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
6063
6064 @item O
6065 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6066 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6067 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
6068
6069 @item K
6070 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
6071 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
6072
6073 @item X
6074 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6075 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
6076
6077 @item Y
6078 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6079 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
6080
6081 @item C
6082 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6083 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
6084
6085 @item G
6086 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6087 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
6088
6089 @item Q
6090 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6091 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6092 Threading}.
6093
6094 @item M
6095 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6096 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6097 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
6098
6099 @end table
6100
6101 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6102 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
6103
6104 One more special mark, though:
6105
6106 @table @samp
6107 @item E
6108 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6109 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
6110
6111 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6112 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6113 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6114 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6115 any time.
6116 @end table
6117
6118
6119 @node Other Marks
6120 @subsection Other Marks
6121 @cindex process mark
6122 @cindex bookmarks
6123
6124 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6125 read or not.
6126
6127 @itemize @bullet
6128
6129 @item
6130 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6131 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6132 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6133 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6134 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
6135
6136 @item
6137 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
6138 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6139 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6140 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
6141
6142 @item
6143 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6144 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6145 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
6146
6147 @item
6148 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
6149 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6150 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6151
6152 @item
6153 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
6154 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6155 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6156 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
6157
6158 @item
6159 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6160 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6161 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
6162
6163 @item
6164 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6165 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6166 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6167 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6168 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6169 use.)
6170
6171 @item
6172 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6173 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6174 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6175 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6176 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6177 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
6178
6179 @item
6180 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6181 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6182 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6183 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6184 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6185 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6186 use.)
6187
6188 @item
6189 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6190 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6191 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6192 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6193 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6194
6195 @item
6196 @vindex gnus-process-mark
6197 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6198 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6199 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6200 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6201 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6202
6203 @end itemize
6204
6205 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6206 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6207 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6208
6209 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6210 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6211 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6212
6213
6214 @node Setting Marks
6215 @subsection Setting Marks
6216 @cindex setting marks
6217
6218 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6219
6220 @table @kbd
6221 @item M c
6222 @itemx M-u
6223 @kindex M c (Summary)
6224 @kindex M-u (Summary)
6225 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6226 @cindex mark as unread
6227 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6228 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6229 article as unread.
6230
6231 @item M t
6232 @itemx !
6233 @kindex ! (Summary)
6234 @kindex M t (Summary)
6235 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6236 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6237 @xref{Article Caching}.
6238
6239 @item M ?
6240 @itemx ?
6241 @kindex ? (Summary)
6242 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6243 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6244 Mark the current article as dormant
6245 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6246
6247 @item M d
6248 @itemx d
6249 @kindex M d (Summary)
6250 @kindex d (Summary)
6251 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6252 Mark the current article as read
6253 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6254
6255 @item D
6256 @kindex D (Summary)
6257 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6258 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6259 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6260
6261 @item M k
6262 @itemx k
6263 @kindex k (Summary)
6264 @kindex M k (Summary)
6265 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6266 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6267 and then select the next unread article
6268 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6269
6270 @item M K
6271 @itemx C-k
6272 @kindex M K (Summary)
6273 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6274 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6275 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6276 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6277
6278 @item M C
6279 @kindex M C (Summary)
6280 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6281 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6282 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6283
6284 @item M C-c
6285 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6286 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6287 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6288 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6289
6290 @item M H
6291 @kindex M H (Summary)
6292 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6293 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6294 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6295
6296 @item M h
6297 @kindex M h (Summary)
6298 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6299 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6300 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6301
6302 @item C-w
6303 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6304 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6305 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6306 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6307
6308 @item M V k
6309 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6310 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6311 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6312 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6313
6314 @item M e
6315 @itemx E
6316 @kindex M e (Summary)
6317 @kindex E (Summary)
6318 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6319 Mark the current article as expirable
6320 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6321
6322 @item M b
6323 @kindex M b (Summary)
6324 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6325 Set a bookmark in the current article
6326 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6327
6328 @item M B
6329 @kindex M B (Summary)
6330 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6331 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6332 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6333
6334 @item M V c
6335 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6336 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6337 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6338 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6339
6340 @item M V u
6341 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6342 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6343 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6344 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6345
6346 @item M V m
6347 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6348 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6349 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6350 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6351 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6352 @end table
6353
6354 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6355 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6356 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6357 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6358 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6359 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6360 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6361 The default is @code{t}.
6362
6363
6364 @node Generic Marking Commands
6365 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6366
6367 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6368 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6369 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6370 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6371 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6372 well.
6373
6374 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6375 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6376 command should do.
6377
6378 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6379 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6380 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6381 to list in this manual.
6382
6383 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6384 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6385 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6386 article, you could say something like:
6387
6388 @lisp
6389 @group
6390 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6391 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6392 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6393 @end group
6394 @end lisp
6395
6396 @noindent
6397 or
6398
6399 @lisp
6400 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6401 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6402 @end lisp
6403
6404
6405 @node Setting Process Marks
6406 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6407 @cindex setting process marks
6408
6409 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6410 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6411 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6412 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6413 articles into the cache. For more information,
6414 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6415
6416 @table @kbd
6417
6418 @item M P p
6419 @itemx #
6420 @kindex # (Summary)
6421 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6422 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6423 Mark the current article with the process mark
6424 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6425 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6426
6427 @item M P u
6428 @itemx M-#
6429 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6430 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6431 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6432 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6433
6434 @item M P U
6435 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6436 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6437 Remove the process mark from all articles
6438 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6439
6440 @item M P i
6441 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6442 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6443 Invert the list of process marked articles
6444 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6445
6446 @item M P R
6447 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6448 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6449 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6450 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6451
6452 @item M P G
6453 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6454 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6455 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6456 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6457
6458 @item M P r
6459 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6460 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6461 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6462
6463 @item M P g
6464 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6465 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6466 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6467
6468 @item M P t
6469 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6470 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6471 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6472 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6473
6474 @item M P T
6475 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6476 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6477 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6478 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6479
6480 @item M P v
6481 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6482 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6483 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6484 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6485
6486 @item M P s
6487 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6488 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6489 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6490
6491 @item M P S
6492 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6493 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6494 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6495 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6496
6497 @item M P a
6498 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6499 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6500 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6501
6502 @item M P b
6503 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6504 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6505 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6506 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6507
6508 @item M P k
6509 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6510 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6511 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6512 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6513
6514 @item M P y
6515 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6516 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6517 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6518 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6519
6520 @item M P w
6521 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6522 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6523 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6524 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6525
6526 @end table
6527
6528 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6529 set process marks based on article body contents.
6530
6531
6532 @node Limiting
6533 @section Limiting
6534 @cindex limiting
6535
6536 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6537 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6538 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6539 buffer.
6540
6541 Limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched from
6542 the servers. These commands don't query the server for additional
6543 articles.
6544
6545 @table @kbd
6546
6547 @item / /
6548 @itemx / s
6549 @kindex / / (Summary)
6550 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6551 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6552 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6553 matching articles.
6554
6555 @item / a
6556 @kindex / a (Summary)
6557 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6558 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6559 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6560 matching articles.
6561
6562 @item / R
6563 @kindex / R (Summary)
6564 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
6565 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
6566 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
6567 matching articles.
6568
6569 @item / A
6570 @kindex / A (Summary)
6571 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
6572 Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
6573 header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
6574 given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
6575
6576 @item / S
6577 @kindex / S (Summary)
6578 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
6579 Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
6580 threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
6581 limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
6582
6583 @item / x
6584 @kindex / x (Summary)
6585 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6586 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6587 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6588 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6589 matching articles.
6590
6591 @item / u
6592 @itemx x
6593 @kindex / u (Summary)
6594 @kindex x (Summary)
6595 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6596 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6597 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6598 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6599 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6600
6601 @item / m
6602 @kindex / m (Summary)
6603 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6604 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6605 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6606
6607 @item / t
6608 @kindex / t (Summary)
6609 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6610 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6611 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6612 articles younger than that number of days.
6613
6614 @item / n
6615 @kindex / n (Summary)
6616 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6617 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6618 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6619 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6620
6621 @item / w
6622 @kindex / w (Summary)
6623 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6624 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6625 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6626 the stack.
6627
6628 @item / .
6629 @kindex / . (Summary)
6630 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6631 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6632 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6633
6634 @item / v
6635 @kindex / v (Summary)
6636 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6637 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6638 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6639
6640 @item / p
6641 @kindex / p (Summary)
6642 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6643 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6644 group parameter predicate
6645 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6646 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6647
6648 @item / r
6649 @kindex / r (Summary)
6650 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
6651 Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
6652 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
6653 replied articles.
6654
6655 @item / E
6656 @itemx M S
6657 @kindex M S (Summary)
6658 @kindex / E (Summary)
6659 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6660 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6661 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6662
6663 @item / D
6664 @kindex / D (Summary)
6665 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6666 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6667 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6668
6669 @item / *
6670 @kindex / * (Summary)
6671 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6672 Include all cached articles in the limit
6673 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6674
6675 @item / d
6676 @kindex / d (Summary)
6677 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6678 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6679 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6680
6681 @item / M
6682 @kindex / M (Summary)
6683 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6684 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6685
6686 @item / T
6687 @kindex / T (Summary)
6688 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6689 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6690
6691 @item / c
6692 @kindex / c (Summary)
6693 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6694 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6695 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6696
6697 @item / C
6698 @kindex / C (Summary)
6699 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6700 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6701 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6702 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6703
6704 @item / b
6705 @kindex / b (Summary)
6706 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
6707 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
6708 certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
6709 prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
6710 requires selecting each article to find the matches.
6711
6712 @item / h
6713 @kindex / h (Summary)
6714 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
6715 Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
6716 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
6717
6718 @end table
6719
6720
6721 The following commands aren't limiting commands, but use the @kbd{/}
6722 prefix as well.
6723
6724 @table @kbd
6725 @item / N
6726 @kindex / N (Summary)
6727 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6728 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6729 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6730
6731 @item / o
6732 @kindex / o (Summary)
6733 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6734 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6735 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6736
6737 @end table
6738
6739
6740 @node Threading
6741 @section Threading
6742 @cindex threading
6743 @cindex article threading
6744
6745 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6746 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6747 hierarchical fashion.
6748
6749 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6750 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6751 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6752 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6753 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6754 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6755 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6756
6757 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6758
6759 @table @dfn
6760 @item root
6761 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6762
6763 @item thread
6764 A tree-like article structure.
6765
6766 @item sub-thread
6767 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6768
6769 @item loose threads
6770 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6771 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6772 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6773 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6774 called loose threads.
6775
6776 @item thread gathering
6777 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6778
6779 @item sparse threads
6780 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6781 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6782
6783 @end table
6784
6785
6786 @menu
6787 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6788 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6789 @end menu
6790
6791
6792 @node Customizing Threading
6793 @subsection Customizing Threading
6794 @cindex customizing threading
6795
6796 @menu
6797 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6798 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6799 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6800 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6801 @end menu
6802
6803
6804 @node Loose Threads
6805 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6806 @cindex <
6807 @cindex >
6808 @cindex loose threads
6809
6810 @table @code
6811 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6812 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6813 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6814 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6815 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6816 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6817
6818 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6819 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6820 There are four possible values:
6821
6822 @iftex
6823 @iflatex
6824 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6825 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6826 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6827 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6828 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6829 }
6830 @end iflatex
6831 @end iftex
6832
6833 @cindex adopting articles
6834
6835 @table @code
6836
6837 @item adopt
6838 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6839 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6840 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6841 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6842
6843 @item dummy
6844 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6845 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6846 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6847 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6848 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6849 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6850 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6851 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6852 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6853 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6854
6855 @item empty
6856 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6857 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6858 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6859 Buffer Format}).)
6860
6861 @item none
6862 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6863 display them after one another.
6864
6865 @item nil
6866 Don't gather loose threads.
6867 @end table
6868
6869 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6870 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6871 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6872 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6873 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6874 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6875 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6876 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6877 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6878 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6879 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6880
6881 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6882 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6883 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6884 Matching}).
6885
6886 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6887 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6888 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6889 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6890 simplification is used.
6891
6892 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6893 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6894 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6895 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6896
6897 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6898 @lisp
6899 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6900 (concat
6901 "\\`\\[?\\("
6902 (mapconcat
6903 'identity
6904 '("looking"
6905 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6906 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6907 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6908 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6909 ;; ...
6910 )
6911 "\\|")
6912 "\\)\\s *\\("
6913 (mapconcat 'identity
6914 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6915 "\\|")
6916 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6917 @end lisp
6918
6919 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6920 subjects.
6921
6922 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6923 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6924 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6925 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6926 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6927 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6928
6929 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6930
6931 @table @code
6932 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6933 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6934 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6935
6936 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6937 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6938 Simplify fuzzily.
6939
6940 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6941 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6942 Remove excessive whitespace.
6943
6944 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6945 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6946 Remove all whitespace.
6947 @end table
6948
6949 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6950
6951
6952 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6953 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6954 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6955 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6956 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6957 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6958 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6959 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6960
6961 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6962 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6963 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6964 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6965 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6966 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6967 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6968 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6969 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6970 cholera:
6971
6972 @table @code
6973 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6974 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6975 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6976 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6977
6978 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6979 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6980 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6981 @end table
6982
6983 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6984 something like:
6985
6986 @lisp
6987 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6988 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6989 @end lisp
6990
6991 @end table
6992
6993
6994 @node Filling In Threads
6995 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6996
6997 @table @code
6998 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6999 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
7000 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
7001 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
7002 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7003 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7004 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7005 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7006 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7007 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7008 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7009 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7010 do about that.
7011
7012 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7013 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7014 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
7015
7016 The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
7017
7018 @cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7019 This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7020 cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7021 that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7022 slow summary generation.
7023
7024 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7025 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7026 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7027 newsgroups.
7028
7029 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7030 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7031 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7032 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7033 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7034 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7035 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7036 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7037 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7038 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7039 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7040 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7041 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7042 @code{nil} by default.
7043
7044 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7045 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7046 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7047 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7048 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7049 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7050 web-based groups.
7051
7052 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7053 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7054 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
7055
7056 @end table
7057
7058
7059 @node More Threading
7060 @subsubsection More Threading
7061
7062 @table @code
7063 @item gnus-show-threads
7064 @vindex gnus-show-threads
7065 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7066 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7067 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7068 slower and more awkward.
7069
7070 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7071 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7072 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7073 generated.
7074
7075 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7076 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7077 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
7078
7079 Here's an example:
7080
7081 @lisp
7082 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7083 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7084 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7085 @end lisp
7086
7087 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7088 unread, but you get my drift.)
7089
7090
7091 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7092 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7093 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7094 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7095 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7096 threads are expunged.
7097
7098 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7099 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7100 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7101 will be hidden.
7102
7103 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7104 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7105 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7106 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7107 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7108 result in a new thread.
7109
7110 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
7111 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7112 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7113 The default is 4.
7114
7115 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7116 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7117 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7118 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7119 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7120 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7121 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7122 Setting this variable to an alternate value
7123 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7124 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
7125 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
7126
7127 @end table
7128
7129
7130 @node Low-Level Threading
7131 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
7132
7133 @table @code
7134
7135 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7136 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7137 Hook run before parsing any headers.
7138
7139 @item gnus-alter-header-function
7140 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7141 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7142 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7143 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7144 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7145 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7146 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7147 meaningful. Here's one example:
7148
7149 @lisp
7150 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7151
7152 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7153 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7154 (when (string-match
7155 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7156 (mail-header-set-id
7157 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7158 header))))
7159 @end lisp
7160
7161 @end table
7162
7163
7164 @node Thread Commands
7165 @subsection Thread Commands
7166 @cindex thread commands
7167
7168 @table @kbd
7169
7170 @item T k
7171 @itemx C-M-k
7172 @kindex T k (Summary)
7173 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7174 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7175 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7176 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7177 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7178 articles instead.
7179
7180 @item T l
7181 @itemx C-M-l
7182 @kindex T l (Summary)
7183 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7184 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7185 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7186 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7187
7188 @item T i
7189 @kindex T i (Summary)
7190 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7191 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7192 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7193
7194 @item T #
7195 @kindex T # (Summary)
7196 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7197 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
7198 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7199
7200 @item T M-#
7201 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
7202 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7203 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
7204 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7205
7206 @item T T
7207 @kindex T T (Summary)
7208 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7209 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
7210
7211 @item T s
7212 @kindex T s (Summary)
7213 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7214 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7215 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
7216
7217 @item T h
7218 @kindex T h (Summary)
7219 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7220 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
7221
7222 @item T S
7223 @kindex T S (Summary)
7224 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
7225 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
7226
7227 @item T H
7228 @kindex T H (Summary)
7229 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
7230 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
7231
7232 @item T t
7233 @kindex T t (Summary)
7234 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
7235 Re-thread the current article's thread
7236 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
7237 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
7238
7239 @item T ^
7240 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
7241 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7242 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7243 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
7244
7245 @item T M-^
7246 @kindex T M-^ (Summary)
7247 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
7248 Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
7249 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
7250
7251 @end table
7252
7253 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7254 understand the numeric prefix.
7255
7256 @table @kbd
7257
7258 @item T n
7259 @kindex T n (Summary)
7260 @itemx C-M-f
7261 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7262 @itemx M-down
7263 @kindex M-down (Summary)
7264 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7265 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
7266
7267 @item T p
7268 @kindex T p (Summary)
7269 @itemx C-M-b
7270 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7271 @itemx M-up
7272 @kindex M-up (Summary)
7273 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7274 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
7275
7276 @item T d
7277 @kindex T d (Summary)
7278 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7279 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7280
7281 @item T u
7282 @kindex T u (Summary)
7283 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7284 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7285
7286 @item T o
7287 @kindex T o (Summary)
7288 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7289 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7290 @end table
7291
7292 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7293 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7294 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7295 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7296 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7297 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7298 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7299 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7300 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7301 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7302 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7303 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7304 Matching}).
7305
7306
7307 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7308 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7309
7310 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7311 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7312 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7313 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7314 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7315 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
7316 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7317 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7318 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7319 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7320 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7321 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7322 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7323 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7324 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7325
7326 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7327 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7328 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
7329 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7330 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
7331 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7332 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7333 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7334 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7335 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7336
7337 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7338 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7339 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread. Exceptions
7340 to this rule are @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number} and
7341 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date}.
7342
7343 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7344 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7345 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7346 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7347 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7348 ascending article order.
7349
7350 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7351 by number, you could do something like:
7352
7353 @lisp
7354 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7355 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7356 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7357 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7358 @end lisp
7359
7360 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7361 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7362 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7363 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7364 which the articles arrived.
7365
7366 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7367 say something like:
7368
7369 @lisp
7370 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7371 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
7372 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7373 @end lisp
7374
7375 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7376 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7377 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7378 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7379 tickles your fancy.
7380
7381 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7382 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7383 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-date
7384 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7385 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7386 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7387 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7388 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7389 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-number
7390 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7391 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7392 variable. It is very similar to the
7393 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7394 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7395 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7396 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7397 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7398 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7399 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7400
7401 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7402 say something like:
7403
7404 @lisp
7405 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7406 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7407 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7408 @end lisp
7409
7410 You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
7411 @xref{Group Parameters}.
7412
7413
7414 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7415 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7416 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7417 @cindex article pre-fetch
7418 @cindex pre-fetch
7419
7420 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7421 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7422 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7423 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7424 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7425
7426 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7427 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7428
7429 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7430 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7431 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7432 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7433 connection is blocked.
7434
7435 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7436 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7437 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7438 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7439
7440 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7441 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7442 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7443 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7444 extra connection.
7445
7446 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7447 you really want to.
7448
7449 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7450 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7451 happen automatically.
7452
7453 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7454 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7455 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7456 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7457 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7458 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7459 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7460
7461 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7462 @findex gnus-async-unread-p
7463 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7464 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7465 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7466 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7467 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7468 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7469 article data structure as the only parameter.
7470
7471 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7472 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7473
7474 @lisp
7475 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7476 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7477 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7478 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7479 100)))
7480
7481 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7482 @end lisp
7483
7484 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7485 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7486 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7487
7488 @vindex gnus-async-post-fetch-function
7489 @findex gnus-html-prefetch-images
7490 After an article has been prefetched, this
7491 @code{gnus-async-post-fetch-function} will be called. The buffer will
7492 be narrowed to the region of the article that was fetched. A useful
7493 value would be @code{gnus-html-prefetch-images}, which will prefetch
7494 and store images referenced in the article, so that you don't have to
7495 wait for them to be fetched when you read the article. This is useful
7496 for @acronym{HTML} messages that have external images.
7497
7498 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7499 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7500 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7501 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7502
7503 @table @code
7504 @item read
7505 Remove articles when they are read.
7506
7507 @item exit
7508 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7509 @end table
7510
7511 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7512
7513 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7514 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7515 @c from the next group.
7516
7517
7518 @node Article Caching
7519 @section Article Caching
7520 @cindex article caching
7521 @cindex caching
7522
7523 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7524 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7525 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7526 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7527 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7528
7529 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7530
7531 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7532 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7533 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7534 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7535 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7536 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7537 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7538 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7539
7540 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7541 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7542 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7543 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7544 as dormant, and don't worry.
7545
7546 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7547
7548 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7549 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7550 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7551 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7552 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7553 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7554 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7555 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7556 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7557 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7558
7559 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7560 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7561 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7562 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7563 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7564 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7565 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7566 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7567 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7568 not then be downloaded by this command.
7569
7570 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7571 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7572 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7573 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7574 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7575 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7576
7577 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7578 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7579 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7580 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7581 variables, the group is not cached.
7582
7583 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7584 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7585 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7586 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7587 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7588 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7589 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7590 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7591 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7592 file.
7593
7594 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7595 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7596 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7597 where, isn't that cool?
7598
7599 @node Persistent Articles
7600 @section Persistent Articles
7601 @cindex persistent articles
7602
7603 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7604 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7605 useful in my opinion.
7606
7607 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7608 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7609 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7610 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7611 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7612 the expiry going on at the news server.
7613
7614 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7615 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7616 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7617
7618 @table @kbd
7619
7620 @item *
7621 @kindex * (Summary)
7622 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7623 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7624
7625 @item M-*
7626 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7627 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7628 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7629 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7630 article.
7631 @end table
7632
7633 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7634
7635 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7636 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7637 interested in persistent articles:
7638
7639 @lisp
7640 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7641 @end lisp
7642
7643 @node Sticky Articles
7644 @section Sticky Articles
7645 @cindex sticky articles
7646
7647 When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
7648 according to the value of the variable
7649 @code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
7650 default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
7651 has its own article buffer.
7652
7653 This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
7654 in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
7655 latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
7656 your 17 cousins to coordinate the next Christmas party.
7657
7658 That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
7659 basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
7660 select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
7661
7662 @table @kbd
7663 @item A S
7664 @kindex A S (Summary)
7665 @findex gnus-sticky-article
7666 Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
7667 name for this sticky article buffer.
7668 @end table
7669
7670 To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
7671
7672 @table @kbd
7673 @item q
7674 @kindex q (Article)
7675 @findex bury-buffer
7676 Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
7677
7678 @item k
7679 @kindex k (Article)
7680 @findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
7681 Kills this sticky article buffer.
7682 @end table
7683
7684 To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
7685
7686 @defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
7687 Kill all sticky article buffers.
7688 If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
7689 @end defun
7690
7691 @node Article Backlog
7692 @section Article Backlog
7693 @cindex backlog
7694 @cindex article backlog
7695
7696 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7697 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7698 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7699 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7700 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7701 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7702 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7703 increase memory usage some.
7704
7705 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7706 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7707 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7708 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7709 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7710 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7711 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7712
7713 The default value is 20.
7714
7715
7716 @node Saving Articles
7717 @section Saving Articles
7718 @cindex saving articles
7719
7720 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7721 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7722 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7723 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7724 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7725
7726 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7727 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7728 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7729
7730 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7731 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7732 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7733
7734 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7735 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7736 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7737 deleted before saving.
7738
7739 @table @kbd
7740
7741 @item O o
7742 @itemx o
7743 @kindex O o (Summary)
7744 @kindex o (Summary)
7745 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7746 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7747 Save the current article using the default article saver
7748 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7749
7750 @item O m
7751 @kindex O m (Summary)
7752 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7753 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7754 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7755
7756 @item O r
7757 @kindex O r (Summary)
7758 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7759 Save the current article in Rmail format
7760 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}). This is mbox since Emacs 23,
7761 Babyl in older versions.
7762
7763 @item O f
7764 @kindex O f (Summary)
7765 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7766 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7767 Save the current article in plain file format
7768 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7769
7770 @item O F
7771 @kindex O F (Summary)
7772 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7773 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7774 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7775
7776 @item O b
7777 @kindex O b (Summary)
7778 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7779 Save the current article body in plain file format
7780 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7781
7782 @item O h
7783 @kindex O h (Summary)
7784 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7785 Save the current article in mh folder format
7786 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7787
7788 @item O v
7789 @kindex O v (Summary)
7790 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7791 Save the current article in a VM folder
7792 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7793
7794 @item O p
7795 @itemx |
7796 @kindex O p (Summary)
7797 @kindex | (Summary)
7798 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7799 @vindex gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command
7800 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7801 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7802 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7803 complete headers in the piped output. The symbolic prefix @code{r} is
7804 special; it lets this command pipe a raw article including all headers.
7805 The @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} variable can be set
7806 to a string containing the default command and options (default
7807 @code{nil}).
7808
7809 @item O P
7810 @kindex O P (Summary)
7811 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7812 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7813 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7814 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7815 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7816 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7817 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7818
7819 @end table
7820
7821 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7822 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7823 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7824 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7825 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7826 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7827 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7828 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7829 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7830 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7831 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7832 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7833 files.
7834
7835
7836 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7837 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7838 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7839 functions below, or you can create your own.
7840
7841 @table @code
7842
7843 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7844 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7845 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7846 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7847 This is the default format, that used by the Rmail package. Since Emacs
7848 23, Rmail uses standard mbox format. Before this, it used the
7849 @dfn{Babyl} format. Accordingly, this command writes mbox format since
7850 Emacs 23, unless appending to an existing Babyl file. In older versions
7851 of Emacs, it always uses Babyl format. Uses the function in the
7852 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7853 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7854
7855 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7856 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7857 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7858 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7859 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7860 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7861
7862 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7863 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7864 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7865 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7866 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7867 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7868 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7869
7870 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7871 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7872 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7873 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7874 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7875 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7876
7877 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7878 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7879 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7880 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7881 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7882
7883 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7884 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7885 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7886 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7887 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7888 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7889
7890 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7891 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7892 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7893 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7894 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7895 @cindex rcvstore
7896 @cindex MH folders
7897 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7898 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7899 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7900 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7901 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7902
7903 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7904 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7905 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7906 reader to use this setting.
7907
7908 @item gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7909 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7910 Pipe the article to a shell command. This function takes optional two
7911 arguments COMMAND and RAW. Valid values for COMMAND include:
7912
7913 @itemize @bullet
7914 @item a string@*
7915 The executable command name and possibly arguments.
7916 @item @code{nil}@*
7917 You will be prompted for the command in the minibuffer.
7918 @item the symbol @code{default}@*
7919 It will be replaced with the command which the variable
7920 @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} holds or the command
7921 last used for saving.
7922 @end itemize
7923
7924 Non-@code{nil} value for RAW overrides @code{:decode} and
7925 @code{:headers} properties (see below) and the raw article including all
7926 headers will be piped.
7927 @end table
7928
7929 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7930
7931 @table @code
7932 @item :decode
7933 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7934 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7935 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7936 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file},
7937 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}, and
7938 @code{gnus-summary-save-in-pipe}.
7939
7940 @item :function
7941 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7942 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7943 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7944 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7945 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7946 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7947
7948 @item :headers
7949 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7950 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7951 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7952 headers should be saved.
7953 @end table
7954
7955 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7956 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7957 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7958 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7959 default.
7960
7961 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7962 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7963 available functions that generate names:
7964
7965 @table @code
7966
7967 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7968 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7969 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7970
7971 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7972 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7973 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7974
7975 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7976 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7977 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7978
7979 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7980 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7981 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7982
7983 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7984 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7985 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7986 @end table
7987
7988 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7989 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7990 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7991 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7992 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7993 like:
7994
7995 @lisp
7996 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7997 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7998 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7999 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
8000 @end lisp
8001
8002 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8003 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8004 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8005 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8006 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8007 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8008 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8009 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8010 called returns a string or a list of strings.
8011
8012 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8013 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8014 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8015 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
8016
8017 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8018 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8019 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8020 name.
8021
8022 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8023 lots of mail groups called things like
8024 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8025 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8026 following will do just that:
8027
8028 @lisp
8029 (defun my-save-name (group)
8030 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8031 (substring group (match-end 0))))
8032
8033 (setq gnus-split-methods
8034 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8035 (my-save-name)))
8036 @end lisp
8037
8038
8039 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8040 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8041 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8042 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8043 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8044 all the files in the top level directory
8045 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8046 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8047 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8048 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
8049
8050 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8051 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8052 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8053 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8054 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8055 for kill files.
8056
8057 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8058 a spool, you could
8059
8060 @lisp
8061 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8062 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
8063 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8064 @end lisp
8065
8066 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8067 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8068 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8069 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
8070
8071
8072 @node Decoding Articles
8073 @section Decoding Articles
8074 @cindex decoding articles
8075
8076 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8077 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
8078
8079 @menu
8080 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8081 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8082 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8083 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8084 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8085 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8086 @end menu
8087
8088 @cindex series
8089 @cindex article series
8090 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8091 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8092 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8093 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8094 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
8095
8096 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8097 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8098 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
8099
8100 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8101 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8102 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
8103
8104 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8105 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8106 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
8107
8108
8109 @node Uuencoded Articles
8110 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
8111 @cindex uudecode
8112 @cindex uuencoded articles
8113
8114 @table @kbd
8115
8116 @item X u
8117 @kindex X u (Summary)
8118 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8119 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8120 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
8121
8122 @item X U
8123 @kindex X U (Summary)
8124 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8125 Uudecodes and saves the current series
8126 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8127
8128 @item X v u
8129 @kindex X v u (Summary)
8130 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8131 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
8132
8133 @item X v U
8134 @kindex X v U (Summary)
8135 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8136 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8137 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
8138
8139 @end table
8140
8141 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8142 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8143 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8144 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8145 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8146
8147 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8148 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8149 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8150 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8151 @kbd{X u}.
8152
8153 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8154 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8155 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8156 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8157 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8158 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8159 off.
8160
8161
8162 @node Shell Archives
8163 @subsection Shell Archives
8164 @cindex unshar
8165 @cindex shell archives
8166 @cindex shared articles
8167
8168 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8169 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8170 some commands to deal with these:
8171
8172 @table @kbd
8173
8174 @item X s
8175 @kindex X s (Summary)
8176 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8177 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
8178
8179 @item X S
8180 @kindex X S (Summary)
8181 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8182 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
8183
8184 @item X v s
8185 @kindex X v s (Summary)
8186 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8187 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
8188
8189 @item X v S
8190 @kindex X v S (Summary)
8191 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8192 Unshars, views and saves the current series
8193 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8194 @end table
8195
8196
8197 @node PostScript Files
8198 @subsection PostScript Files
8199 @cindex PostScript
8200
8201 @table @kbd
8202
8203 @item X p
8204 @kindex X p (Summary)
8205 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8206 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
8207
8208 @item X P
8209 @kindex X P (Summary)
8210 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8211 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8212 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
8213
8214 @item X v p
8215 @kindex X v p (Summary)
8216 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8217 View the current PostScript series
8218 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
8219
8220 @item X v P
8221 @kindex X v P (Summary)
8222 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8223 View and save the current PostScript series
8224 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8225 @end table
8226
8227
8228 @node Other Files
8229 @subsection Other Files
8230
8231 @table @kbd
8232 @item X o
8233 @kindex X o (Summary)
8234 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8235 Save the current series
8236 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
8237
8238 @item X b
8239 @kindex X b (Summary)
8240 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
8241 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
8242 doesn't really work yet.
8243
8244 @item X Y
8245 @kindex X Y (Summary)
8246 @findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
8247 yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
8248 @end table
8249
8250
8251 @node Decoding Variables
8252 @subsection Decoding Variables
8253
8254 Adjective, not verb.
8255
8256 @menu
8257 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
8258 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
8259 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
8260 @end menu
8261
8262
8263 @node Rule Variables
8264 @subsubsection Rule Variables
8265 @cindex rule variables
8266
8267 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
8268 variables are of the form
8269
8270 @lisp
8271 (list '(regexp1 command2)
8272 '(regexp2 command2)
8273 ...)
8274 @end lisp
8275
8276 @table @code
8277
8278 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8279 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8280 @cindex sox
8281 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
8282 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
8283 say something like:
8284 @lisp
8285 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8286 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
8287 @end lisp
8288
8289 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8290 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8291 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
8292 user and default view rules.
8293
8294 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8295 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8296 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
8297 archives.
8298 @end table
8299
8300
8301 @node Other Decode Variables
8302 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
8303
8304 @table @code
8305 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8306
8307 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8308 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
8309 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
8310 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
8311 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
8312
8313 @table @code
8314
8315 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
8316 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
8317 View the file.
8318
8319 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
8320 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
8321 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
8322 @end table
8323
8324 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8325 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8326 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
8327 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
8328 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
8329 time.
8330
8331 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8332 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8333 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
8334
8335 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8336 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8337 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
8338 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
8339 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
8340 kludgy.
8341
8342 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8343 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8344 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
8345
8346 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8347 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8348 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
8349 looking for files to display.
8350
8351 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
8352 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
8353 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
8354 after viewing it.
8355
8356 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8357 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8358 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
8359 rules.
8360
8361 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8362 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8363 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8364 unpacking commands.
8365
8366 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8367 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8368 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8369 from articles.
8370
8371 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8372 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8373 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8374 decoded articles as unread.
8375
8376 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8377 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8378 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8379 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
8380
8381 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8382 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8383 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
8384
8385 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8386 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8387 @cindex metamail
8388 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8389 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8390 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8391 @code{metamail} for viewing.
8392
8393 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8394 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8395 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8396 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8397 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8398 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8399 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8400 simply dropped them.
8401
8402 @end table
8403
8404
8405 @node Uuencoding and Posting
8406 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8407
8408 @table @code
8409
8410 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8411 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8412 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8413 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8414 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8415 for you when you post the article.
8416
8417 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8418 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8419 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8420 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8421
8422 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8423 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8424 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8425 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8426 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8427 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8428 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8429
8430 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8431 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8432 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8433 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8434 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8435 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8436 Default is @code{t}.
8437
8438 @end table
8439
8440
8441 @node Viewing Files
8442 @subsection Viewing Files
8443 @cindex viewing files
8444 @cindex pseudo-articles
8445
8446 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8447 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8448 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8449 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8450 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8451 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8452 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8453
8454 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8455 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8456 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8457 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8458
8459 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8460 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8461 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8462
8463 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8464 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8465 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8466 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8467 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8468
8469 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8470 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8471 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8472 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8473 a list of parameters to that command.
8474
8475 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8476 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8477 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8478
8479 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8480 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8481 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8482
8483
8484 @node Article Treatment
8485 @section Article Treatment
8486
8487 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8488 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8489 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8490 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8491 these articles easier.
8492
8493 @menu
8494 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8495 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8496 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8497 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8498 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8499 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8500 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8501 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8502 * Article Display:: Display various stuff:
8503 X-Face, Picons, Gravatars, Smileys.
8504 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8505 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8506 @end menu
8507
8508
8509 @node Article Highlighting
8510 @subsection Article Highlighting
8511 @cindex highlighting
8512
8513 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8514 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8515
8516 @table @kbd
8517
8518 @item W H a
8519 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8520 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8521 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8522 Do much highlighting of the current article
8523 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8524 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8525
8526 @item W H h
8527 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8528 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8529 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8530 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8531 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8532 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8533 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8534 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8535 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8536 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8537 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8538 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8539
8540 @item W H c
8541 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8542 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8543 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8544
8545 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8546
8547 @table @code
8548 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8549
8550 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8551 If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
8552 25000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8553
8554 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8555 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8556 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8557
8558 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8559 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8560 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8561 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8562 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8563 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8564
8565 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8566 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8567 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8568
8569 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8570 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8571 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8572
8573 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8574 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8575 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8576 that it's a citation.
8577
8578 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8579 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8580 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8581
8582 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8583 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8584 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8585
8586 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8587 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8588 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8589 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8590
8591 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8592 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8593 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8594 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8595 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8596 is @code{t}.
8597
8598 @end table
8599
8600
8601 @item W H s
8602 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8603 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8604 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8605 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8606 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8607 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8608 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8609 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8610 default.
8611
8612 @end table
8613
8614 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8615
8616
8617 @node Article Fontisizing
8618 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8619 @cindex emphasis
8620 @cindex article emphasis
8621
8622 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8623 @kindex W e (Summary)
8624 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8625 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8626 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8627 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8628
8629 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8630 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8631 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8632 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8633 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8634 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8635 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8636 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8637 highlighting.
8638
8639 @lisp
8640 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8641 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8642 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8643 @end lisp
8644
8645 @cindex slash
8646 @cindex asterisk
8647 @cindex underline
8648 @cindex /
8649 @cindex *
8650
8651 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8652 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8653 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8654 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8655 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8656 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8657 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8658 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8659 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8660 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8661 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8662 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8663 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8664
8665 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8666 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8667 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8668 say something like:
8669
8670 @lisp
8671 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8672 @end lisp
8673
8674 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8675
8676 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8677 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8678 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8679 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8680
8681 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8682
8683
8684 @node Article Hiding
8685 @subsection Article Hiding
8686 @cindex article hiding
8687
8688 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8689 too much cruft in most articles.
8690
8691 @table @kbd
8692
8693 @item W W a
8694 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8695 @findex gnus-article-hide
8696 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8697 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8698 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8699
8700 @item W W h
8701 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8702 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8703 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8704 Headers}.
8705
8706 @item W W b
8707 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8708 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8709 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8710 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8711
8712 @item W W s
8713 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8714 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8715 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8716 Signature}.
8717
8718 @item W W l
8719 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8720 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8721 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8722 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8723 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8724 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8725 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8726 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8727
8728 @table @code
8729
8730 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8731 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8732 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8733 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8734
8735 @end table
8736
8737 @item W W P
8738 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8739 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8740 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8741 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8742
8743 @item W W B
8744 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8745 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8746 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8747 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8748 @cindex banner
8749 @cindex OneList
8750 @cindex stripping advertisements
8751 @cindex advertisements
8752 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8753 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8754 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8755 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8756 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8757 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8758 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8759 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8760 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8761 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8762 used.
8763
8764 For instance:
8765
8766 @lisp
8767 (setq gnus-article-banner-alist
8768 ((googleGroups .
8769 "^\n*--~--~---------\\(.+\n\\)+")))
8770 @end lisp
8771
8772 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8773 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8774 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8775
8776 @table @code
8777
8778 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8779 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8780 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8781 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8782 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8783 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8784 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8785 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8786 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8787 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8788 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8789
8790 @lisp
8791 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8792 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8793 @end lisp
8794
8795 @end table
8796
8797 @item W W c
8798 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8799 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8800 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8801 customizing the hiding:
8802
8803 @table @code
8804
8805 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8806 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8807 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8808 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8809 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8810 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8811 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8812 specs are valid:
8813
8814 @table @samp
8815 @item b
8816 Starting point of the hidden text.
8817 @item e
8818 Ending point of the hidden text.
8819 @item l
8820 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8821 @item n
8822 Number of lines of hidden text.
8823 @end table
8824
8825 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8826 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8827 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8828 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8829 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8830
8831 @end table
8832
8833 @item W W C-c
8834 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8835 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8836
8837 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8838 following two variables:
8839
8840 @table @code
8841 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8842 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8843 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8844 50), hide the cited text.
8845
8846 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8847 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8848 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8849 is hidden.
8850 @end table
8851
8852 @item W W C
8853 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8854 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8855 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8856 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8857 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8858 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8859
8860 @end table
8861
8862 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8863 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8864 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8865
8866 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8867 citation customization.
8868
8869 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8870 automatically.
8871
8872
8873 @node Article Washing
8874 @subsection Article Washing
8875 @cindex washing
8876 @cindex article washing
8877
8878 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8879 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8880
8881 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8882 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8883 Cleaner, perhaps.
8884
8885 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8886 articles by default.
8887
8888 @table @kbd
8889
8890 @item C-u g
8891 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8892 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8893 the server.
8894
8895 @item g
8896 Force redisplaying of the current article
8897 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8898 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8899 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8900 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8901
8902 @item W l
8903 @kindex W l (Summary)
8904 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8905 Remove page breaks from the current article
8906 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8907 delimiters.
8908
8909 @item W r
8910 @kindex W r (Summary)
8911 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8912 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8913 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8914 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8915 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8916 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8917
8918 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8919 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8920 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8921 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8922
8923 @item W m
8924 @kindex W m (Summary)
8925 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8926 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8927
8928 @item W i
8929 @kindex W i (Summary)
8930 @findex gnus-summary-idna-message
8931 Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
8932 encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
8933 unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
8934 string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
8935 (@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
8936 to work.
8937
8938 @item W t
8939 @item t
8940 @kindex W t (Summary)
8941 @kindex t (Summary)
8942 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8943 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8944 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8945
8946 @item W v
8947 @kindex W v (Summary)
8948 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8949 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8950 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8951
8952 @item W o
8953 @kindex W o (Summary)
8954 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8955 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8956
8957 @item W d
8958 @kindex W d (Summary)
8959 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8960 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8961 @cindex Smartquotes
8962 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8963 @cindex Latin 1
8964 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8965 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8966 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8967 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8968 interactively.
8969
8970 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8971 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8972 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8973 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8974
8975 @item W U
8976 @kindex W U (Summary)
8977 @findex gnus-article-treat-non-ascii
8978 @cindex Unicode
8979 @cindex Non-@acronym{ASCII}
8980 Translate many non-@acronym{ASCII} characters into their
8981 @acronym{ASCII} equivalents (@code{gnus-article-treat-non-ascii}).
8982 This is mostly useful if you're on a terminal that has a limited font
8983 and doesn't show accented characters, ``advanced'' punctuation, and the
8984 like. For instance, @samp{»} is translated into @samp{>>}, and so on.
8985
8986 @item W Y f
8987 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8988 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8989 @cindex Outlook Express
8990 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8991 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8992 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8993
8994 @item W Y u
8995 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8996 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8997 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8998 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8999 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
9000 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
9001 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
9002 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9003 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9004 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
9005
9006 @item W Y a
9007 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
9008 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9009 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9010 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
9011
9012 @item W Y c
9013 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
9014 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9015 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9016 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
9017
9018 @item W w
9019 @kindex W w (Summary)
9020 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9021 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
9022
9023 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9024 when filling.
9025
9026 @item W Q
9027 @kindex W Q (Summary)
9028 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9029 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
9030
9031 @item W C
9032 @kindex W C (Summary)
9033 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9034 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9035 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
9036
9037 @item W c
9038 @kindex W c (Summary)
9039 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
9040 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
9041 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9042 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9043 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
9044
9045 @item W q
9046 @kindex W q (Summary)
9047 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9048 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9049 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9050 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
9051 makes strings like @samp{d@'ej@`a vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9052 which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9053 done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9054 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9055 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9056
9057 @item W 6
9058 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
9059 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9060 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9061 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9062 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9063 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9064 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9065 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9066
9067 @item W Z
9068 @kindex W Z (Summary)
9069 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9070 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9071 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9072 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
9073
9074 @item W A
9075 @kindex W A (Summary)
9076 @findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9077 @cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9078 Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9079 extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9080 sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
9081
9082 @item W u
9083 @kindex W u (Summary)
9084 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9085 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9086 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9087 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9088 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
9089
9090 @item W h
9091 @kindex W h (Summary)
9092 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
9093 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9094 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9095 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
9096
9097 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9098 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9099 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9100
9101 The default is to use the function specified by
9102 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9103 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9104 @acronym{HTML}. Pre-defined functions you can use include:
9105
9106 @table @code
9107 @item shr
9108 Use Gnus simple html renderer.
9109
9110 @item gnus-w3m
9111 Use Gnus rendered based on w3m.
9112
9113 @item w3
9114 Use Emacs/W3.
9115
9116 @item w3m
9117 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
9118
9119 @item w3m-standalone
9120 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
9121
9122 @item links
9123 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
9124
9125 @item lynx
9126 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
9127
9128 @item html2text
9129 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
9130
9131 @end table
9132
9133 @item W b
9134 @kindex W b (Summary)
9135 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9136 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9137 @xref{Article Buttons}.
9138
9139 @item W B
9140 @kindex W B (Summary)
9141 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9142 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9143 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
9144
9145 @item W p
9146 @kindex W p (Summary)
9147 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9148 Verify a signed control message
9149 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9150 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9151 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9152 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9153 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9154 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
9155
9156 @item W s
9157 @kindex W s (Summary)
9158 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9159 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9160 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
9161 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
9162
9163 @item W a
9164 @kindex W a (Summary)
9165 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9166 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9167 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
9168
9169 @item W E l
9170 @kindex W E l (Summary)
9171 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9172 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9173 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
9174
9175 @item W E m
9176 @kindex W E m (Summary)
9177 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9178 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9179 lines with a single empty line.
9180 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
9181
9182 @item W E t
9183 @kindex W E t (Summary)
9184 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9185 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9186 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
9187
9188 @item W E a
9189 @kindex W E a (Summary)
9190 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9191 Do all the three commands above
9192 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
9193
9194 @item W E A
9195 @kindex W E A (Summary)
9196 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9197 Remove all blank lines
9198 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9199
9200 @item W E s
9201 @kindex W E s (Summary)
9202 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9203 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9204 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
9205
9206 @item W E e
9207 @kindex W E e (Summary)
9208 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9209 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9210 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
9211
9212 @end table
9213
9214 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
9215
9216
9217 @node Article Header
9218 @subsection Article Header
9219
9220 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
9221
9222 @table @kbd
9223
9224 @item W G u
9225 @kindex W G u (Summary)
9226 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9227 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
9228
9229 @item W G n
9230 @kindex W G n (Summary)
9231 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9232 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9233 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
9234
9235 @item W G f
9236 @kindex W G f (Summary)
9237 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9238 Fold all the message headers
9239 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
9240
9241 @item W E w
9242 @kindex W E w (Summary)
9243 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9244 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9245 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
9246
9247 @end table
9248
9249
9250 @node Article Buttons
9251 @subsection Article Buttons
9252 @cindex buttons
9253
9254 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9255 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9256 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9257 button on these references.
9258
9259 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9260 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
9261 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
9262 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
9263 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
9264
9265 @table @code
9266
9267 @item gnus-button-alist
9268 @vindex gnus-button-alist
9269 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
9270
9271 @lisp
9272 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9273 @end lisp
9274
9275 @table @var
9276
9277 @item regexp
9278 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
9279 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
9280 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
9281 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
9282 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
9283
9284 @item button-par
9285 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
9286 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
9287 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
9288
9289 @item use-p
9290 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
9291 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
9292 avoid false matches. Often variables named
9293 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
9294 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
9295
9296 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
9297
9298 @item function
9299 This function will be called when you click on this button.
9300
9301 @item data-par
9302 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
9303 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
9304
9305 @end table
9306
9307 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
9308
9309 @lisp
9310 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
9311 @end lisp
9312
9313 @item gnus-header-button-alist
9314 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
9315 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
9316 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
9317 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
9318
9319 @lisp
9320 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9321 @end lisp
9322
9323 @var{header} is a regular expression.
9324 @end table
9325
9326 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
9327
9328 @table @code
9329 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
9330 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
9331
9332 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
9333
9334 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
9335 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
9336 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
9337 default values of the variables above.
9338
9339 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
9340
9341 @item gnus-button-man-handler
9342 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9343 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
9344 argument with a string naming the man page.
9345
9346 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
9347
9348 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9349 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9350 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
9351
9352 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9353 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9354 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
9355 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
9356 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
9357 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
9358 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
9359 @code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
9360 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
9361 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
9362 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
9363 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9364
9365 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9366 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9367 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
9368 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
9369 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
9370 string is invalid.
9371
9372 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9373 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9374 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
9375 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9376
9377 @c Misc stuff
9378
9379 @item gnus-article-button-face
9380 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
9381 Face used on buttons.
9382
9383 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
9384 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
9385 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
9386
9387 @end table
9388
9389 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
9390
9391
9392 @node Article Button Levels
9393 @subsection Article button levels
9394 @cindex button levels
9395 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9396 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9397 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9398 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9399 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9400 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9401 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9402 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
9403
9404 @lisp
9405 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9406 (setq gnus-parameters
9407 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9408 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9409 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
9410 @end lisp
9411
9412 @table @code
9413
9414 @item gnus-button-browse-level
9415 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9416 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9417 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9418 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9419 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
9420
9421 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
9422 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9423 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9424 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9425 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9426 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9427 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9428 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9429 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9430 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9431 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9432 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9433 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9434
9435 @item gnus-button-man-level
9436 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
9437 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9438 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9439
9440 @item gnus-button-message-level
9441 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9442 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9443 Related variables and functions include
9444 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9445 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9446 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9447 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9448
9449 @end table
9450
9451
9452 @node Article Date
9453 @subsection Article Date
9454
9455 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9456 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9457 when the article was sent.
9458
9459 @table @kbd
9460
9461 @item W T u
9462 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9463 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9464 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9465 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9466
9467 @item W T i
9468 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9469 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9470 @cindex ISO 8601
9471 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9472 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9473
9474 @item W T l
9475 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9476 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9477 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9478
9479 @item W T p
9480 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9481 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9482 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9483 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9484
9485 @item W T s
9486 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9487 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9488 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9489 @findex format-time-string
9490 Display the date using a user-defined format
9491 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9492 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9493 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9494 for a list of possible format specs.
9495
9496 @item W T e
9497 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9498 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9499 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9500 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9501 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9502 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9503
9504 @example
9505 Date: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9506 @end example
9507
9508 This line is updated continually by default. The frequency (in
9509 seconds) is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-update-date-headers}
9510 variable.
9511
9512 If you wish to switch updating off, say:
9513
9514 @vindex gnus-article-update-date-headers
9515 @lisp
9516 (setq gnus-article-update-date-headers nil)
9517 @end lisp
9518
9519 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9520
9521 @item W T o
9522 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9523 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9524 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9525 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9526 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9527 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9528 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9529
9530 @end table
9531
9532 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9533 preferred format automatically.
9534
9535
9536 @node Article Display
9537 @subsection Article Display
9538 @cindex picons
9539 @cindex x-face
9540 @cindex smileys
9541 @cindex gravatars
9542
9543 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9544 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9545
9546 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9547 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9548
9549 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9550 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9551
9552 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9553 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9554
9555 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9556 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9557
9558 Gravatars reside on-line and are fetched from
9559 @uref{http://www.gravatar.com/} (@pxref{Gravatars}).
9560
9561 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9562 they'll be removed.
9563
9564 @table @kbd
9565 @item W D x
9566 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9567 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9568 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9569 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9570
9571 @item W D d
9572 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9573 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9574 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9575 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9576
9577 @item W D s
9578 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9579 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9580 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9581
9582 @item W D f
9583 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9584 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9585 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9586
9587 @item W D m
9588 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9589 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9590 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9591 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9592
9593 @item W D n
9594 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9595 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9596 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9597 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9598
9599 @item W D g
9600 @kindex W D g (Summary)
9601 @findex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
9602 Gravatarify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9603
9604 @item W D h
9605 @kindex W D h (Summary)
9606 @findex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
9607 Gravatarify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9608 (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9609
9610 @item W D D
9611 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9612 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9613 Remove all images from the article buffer
9614 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9615
9616 @item W D W
9617 @kindex W D W (Summary)
9618 @findex gnus-html-show-images
9619 If you're reading an @acronym{HTML} article rendered with
9620 @code{gnus-article-html}, then you can insert any blocked images in
9621 the buffer with this command.
9622 (@code{gnus-html-show-images}).
9623
9624 @end table
9625
9626
9627
9628 @node Article Signature
9629 @subsection Article Signature
9630 @cindex signatures
9631 @cindex article signature
9632
9633 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9634 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9635 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9636 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9637 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9638 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9639 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9640 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9641 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9642
9643 @lisp
9644 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9645 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9646 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9647 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9648 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9649 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9650 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9651 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9652 @end lisp
9653
9654 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9655 positives.
9656
9657 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9658 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9659 signature when displaying articles.
9660
9661 @enumerate
9662 @item
9663 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9664 that integer.
9665 @item
9666 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9667 than that number.
9668 @item
9669 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9670 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9671 @item
9672 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9673 in question is not a signature.
9674 @end enumerate
9675
9676 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9677 listed above. Here's an example:
9678
9679 @lisp
9680 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9681 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9682 @end lisp
9683
9684 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9685 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9686 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9687 signature after all.
9688
9689
9690 @node Article Miscellanea
9691 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9692
9693 @table @kbd
9694 @item A t
9695 @kindex A t (Summary)
9696 @findex gnus-article-babel
9697 Translate the article from one language to another
9698 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9699
9700 @end table
9701
9702
9703 @node MIME Commands
9704 @section MIME Commands
9705 @cindex MIME decoding
9706 @cindex attachments
9707 @cindex viewing attachments
9708
9709 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9710 instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9711
9712 @table @kbd
9713 @item b
9714 @itemx K v
9715 @kindex b (Summary)
9716 @kindex K v (Summary)
9717 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9718
9719 @item K o
9720 @kindex K o (Summary)
9721 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9722
9723 @item K O
9724 @kindex K O (Summary)
9725 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
9726 from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
9727 via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
9728
9729 @item K r
9730 @kindex K r (Summary)
9731 Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
9732
9733 @item K d
9734 @kindex K d (Summary)
9735 Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
9736 removed part.
9737
9738 @item K c
9739 @kindex K c (Summary)
9740 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9741
9742 @item K e
9743 @kindex K e (Summary)
9744 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9745
9746 @item K i
9747 @kindex K i (Summary)
9748 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9749
9750 @item K |
9751 @kindex K | (Summary)
9752 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9753 @end table
9754
9755 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9756 the same manner:
9757
9758 @table @kbd
9759 @item K H
9760 @kindex K H (Summary)
9761 @findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
9762 View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
9763 Inline images embedded in a message using the @code{cid} scheme, as they
9764 are generally considered to be safe, will be processed properly. The
9765 message header is added to the beginning of every @acronym{HTML} part
9766 unless the prefix argument is given.
9767
9768 Warning: Spammers use links to images (using the @code{http} scheme) in
9769 @acronym{HTML} articles to verify whether you have read the message. As
9770 this command passes the @acronym{HTML} content to the browser without
9771 eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should only use it for mails from
9772 trusted senders.
9773
9774 If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
9775 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
9776
9777 This command creates temporary files to pass @acronym{HTML} contents
9778 including images if any to the browser, and deletes them when exiting
9779 the group (if you want).
9780
9781 @item K b
9782 @kindex K b (Summary)
9783 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9784 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9785 parts.
9786
9787 @item K m
9788 @kindex K m (Summary)
9789 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9790 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9791 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9792 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9793 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9794
9795 @item X m
9796 @kindex X m (Summary)
9797 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9798 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9799 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9800 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9801
9802 @item M-t
9803 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9804 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9805 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9806 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9807
9808 @item W M w
9809 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9810 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9811 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9812 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9813
9814 @item W M c
9815 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9816 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9817 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9818 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9819
9820 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9821 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9822 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9823 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9824 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9825 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9826
9827 @item W M v
9828 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9829 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9830 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9831 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9832
9833 @end table
9834
9835 Relevant variables:
9836
9837 @table @code
9838 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9839 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9840 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9841 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9842 @code{nil}.
9843
9844 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9845
9846 @lisp
9847 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9848 '("text/x-vcard"))
9849 @end lisp
9850
9851 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9852 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9853 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9854 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9855 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9856 default is @code{t}.
9857
9858 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9859 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9860 @cindex uuencode
9861 @cindex yEnc
9862 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9863 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9864 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9865 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9866 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9867 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9868 for encoding in Gnus.
9869
9870 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9871 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9872 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9873 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9874 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9875 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9876 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9877 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9878
9879 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9880 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9881 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9882 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9883 displayed. This variable overrides
9884 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9885 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9886 is @code{nil}.
9887
9888 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9889 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9890 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9891
9892 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9893 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9894 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9895 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9896 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9897
9898 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9899 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9900 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9901 default value is @code{nil}.
9902
9903 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9904 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9905 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9906 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9907 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9908 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9909 save all jpegs into some directory).
9910
9911 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9912
9913 @lisp
9914 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9915 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9916 (with-temp-buffer
9917 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9918 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9919 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9920 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9921 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9922 @end lisp
9923
9924 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9925 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9926 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9927
9928 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9929 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9930 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9931
9932 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9933 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9934 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9935
9936 If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
9937 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9938 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9939 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9940 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9941
9942 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9943 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9944 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9945 overrides @code{nil} values of
9946 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9947 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9948
9949 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9950 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9951 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9952 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9953
9954 Ready-made functions include@*
9955 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9956 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9957 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9958 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9959 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9960 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9961 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9962 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9963 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9964 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9965 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9966 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9967
9968 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9969 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9970
9971 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9972 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9973 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9974
9975 @lisp
9976 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9977 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9978 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9979 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9980 @end lisp
9981
9982 @noindent
9983 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9984
9985 @end table
9986
9987
9988 @node Charsets
9989 @section Charsets
9990 @cindex charsets
9991
9992 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9993 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9994 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9995 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9996 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9997 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9998 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
9999
10000 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
10001 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
10002 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10003 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
10004
10005 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10006 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10007 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10008 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10009 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10010 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10011 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10012 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10013 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
10014
10015 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10016 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10017 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10018 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10019 quoted-printable header encoding.
10020
10021 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10022 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10023 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
10024
10025 @table @var
10026 @item test
10027 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10028 variable to query,
10029 @item header
10030 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10031 means encode all charsets),
10032 @item body-list
10033 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10034 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10035 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10036 @end table
10037
10038 @cindex Russian
10039 @cindex koi8-r
10040 @cindex koi8-u
10041 @cindex iso-8859-5
10042 @cindex coding system aliases
10043 @cindex preferred charset
10044
10045 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10046 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10047 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
10048
10049 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
10050
10051 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10052 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
10053
10054 @lisp
10055 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10056 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10057 @end lisp
10058
10059 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10060 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
10061
10062 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
10063
10064 @lisp
10065 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10066 @end lisp
10067
10068 This will almost do the right thing.
10069
10070 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10071 something like
10072
10073 @lisp
10074 (codepage-setup 1251)
10075 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
10076 @end lisp
10077
10078
10079 @node Article Commands
10080 @section Article Commands
10081
10082 @table @kbd
10083
10084 @item A P
10085 @cindex PostScript
10086 @cindex printing
10087 @kindex A P (Summary)
10088 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10089 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
10090 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10091 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10092 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10093 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
10094
10095 @item A C
10096 @vindex gnus-fetch-partial-articles
10097 @findex gnus-summary-show-complete-article
10098 If @code{<backend>-fetch-partial-articles} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
10099 fetch partial articles, if the backend it fetches them from supports
10100 it. Currently only @code{nnimap} does. If you're looking at a
10101 partial article, and want to see the complete article instead, then
10102 the @kbd{A C} command (@code{gnus-summary-show-complete-article}) will
10103 do so.
10104
10105 @end table
10106
10107
10108 @node Summary Sorting
10109 @section Summary Sorting
10110 @cindex summary sorting
10111
10112 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10113 can't really see why you'd want that.
10114
10115 @table @kbd
10116
10117 @item C-c C-s C-n
10118 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10119 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10120 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
10121
10122 @item C-c C-s C-m C-n
10123 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10124 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number
10125 Sort by most recent article number
10126 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number}).
10127
10128 @item C-c C-s C-a
10129 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10130 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10131 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
10132
10133 @item C-c C-s C-t
10134 @kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10135 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10136 Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
10137
10138 @item C-c C-s C-s
10139 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10140 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10141 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
10142
10143 @item C-c C-s C-d
10144 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10145 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10146 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
10147
10148 @item C-c C-s C-m C-d
10149 @kindex C-c C-s C-m C-d (Summary)
10150 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date
10151 Sort by most recent date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date}).
10152
10153 @item C-c C-s C-l
10154 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10155 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10156 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
10157
10158 @item C-c C-s C-c
10159 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10160 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10161 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
10162
10163 @item C-c C-s C-i
10164 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10165 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10166 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
10167
10168 @item C-c C-s C-r
10169 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10170 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10171 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
10172
10173 @item C-c C-s C-o
10174 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10175 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10176 Sort using the default sorting method
10177 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
10178 @end table
10179
10180 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10181 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10182 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10183 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10184 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10185 Commands}).
10186
10187 If a prefix argument if given, the sort order is reversed.
10188
10189
10190 @node Finding the Parent
10191 @section Finding the Parent
10192 @cindex parent articles
10193 @cindex referring articles
10194
10195 @table @kbd
10196 @item ^
10197 @kindex ^ (Summary)
10198 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10199 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10200 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10201 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10202 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10203 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10204 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10205 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10206 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
10207
10208 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10209 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10210 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10211 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
10212 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
10213 article.
10214
10215 @item A R (Summary)
10216 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10217 @kindex A R (Summary)
10218 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10219 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
10220
10221 @item A T (Summary)
10222 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10223 @kindex A T (Summary)
10224 Display the full thread where the current article appears
10225 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10226 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10227 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10228 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10229 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10230 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
10231
10232 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
10233 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
10234 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10235 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10236 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10237 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
10238
10239 @item M-^ (Summary)
10240 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10241 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
10242 @cindex Message-ID
10243 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
10244 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10245 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10246 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10247 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10248 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
10249
10250 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10251 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10252 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10253 @end table
10254
10255 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10256 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10257 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10258 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10259 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10260 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10261 necessary.
10262
10263 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10264 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10265 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10266 match.
10267
10268 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10269 then ask Google if that fails:
10270
10271 @lisp
10272 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
10273 '(current
10274 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10275 @end lisp
10276
10277 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
10278 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
10279 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
10280 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
10281 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
10282 group. @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
10283
10284 Fortunately, the special @code{nnregistry} back end is able to locate
10285 articles in any groups, regardless of their back end (@pxref{Registry
10286 Article Refer Method, fetching by @code{Message-ID} using the
10287 registry}).
10288
10289 @node Alternative Approaches
10290 @section Alternative Approaches
10291
10292 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
10293 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
10294
10295 @menu
10296 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
10297 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
10298 @end menu
10299
10300
10301 @node Pick and Read
10302 @subsection Pick and Read
10303 @cindex pick and read
10304
10305 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
10306 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
10307 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
10308 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
10309
10310 @findex gnus-pick-mode
10311 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
10312 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
10313 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
10314 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
10315 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
10316
10317 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
10318
10319 @table @kbd
10320 @item .
10321 @kindex . (Pick)
10322 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
10323 Pick the article or thread on the current line
10324 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10325 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
10326 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
10327 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
10328 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
10329 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
10330
10331 @item SPACE
10332 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
10333 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
10334 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
10335 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
10336
10337 @item u
10338 @kindex u (Pick)
10339 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
10340 Unpick the thread or article
10341 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10342 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
10343 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
10344 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
10345 the thread or article at that line.
10346
10347 @item RET
10348 @kindex RET (Pick)
10349 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
10350 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
10351 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
10352 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
10353 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
10354 will still be visible when you are reading.
10355
10356 @end table
10357
10358 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
10359 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
10360 which is mapped to the same function
10361 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
10362
10363 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
10364
10365 @lisp
10366 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
10367 @end lisp
10368
10369 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
10370 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
10371
10372 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
10373 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
10374 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
10375
10376 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
10377 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
10378 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
10379 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
10380 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
10381 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
10382 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
10383
10384
10385 @node Binary Groups
10386 @subsection Binary Groups
10387 @cindex binary groups
10388
10389 @findex gnus-binary-mode
10390 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
10391 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
10392 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
10393 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
10394 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
10395 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
10396
10397 @kindex g (Binary)
10398 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
10399 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
10400 command, when you have turned on this mode
10401 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
10402
10403 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
10404 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
10405
10406
10407 @node Tree Display
10408 @section Tree Display
10409 @cindex trees
10410
10411 @vindex gnus-use-trees
10412 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
10413 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
10414 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
10415 in the tree buffer.
10416
10417 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
10418
10419 @table @code
10420 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
10421 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
10422 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
10423
10424 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10425 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10426 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
10427 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
10428 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
10429
10430 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
10431 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
10432 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
10433 default is @code{modeline}.
10434
10435 @item gnus-tree-line-format
10436 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
10437 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
10438 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
10439 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
10440 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
10441 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
10442
10443 Valid specs are:
10444
10445 @table @samp
10446 @item n
10447 The name of the poster.
10448 @item f
10449 The @code{From} header.
10450 @item N
10451 The number of the article.
10452 @item [
10453 The opening bracket.
10454 @item ]
10455 The closing bracket.
10456 @item s
10457 The subject.
10458 @end table
10459
10460 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
10461
10462 Variables related to the display are:
10463
10464 @table @code
10465 @item gnus-tree-brackets
10466 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
10467 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10468 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
10469 @example
10470 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10471 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10472 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10473 @end example
10474 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
10475
10476 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10477 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10478 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10479 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
10480
10481 @end table
10482
10483 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10484 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10485 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10486 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10487 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10488 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10489 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10490 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10491 other windows displayed next to it.
10492
10493 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10494 at all times:
10495
10496 @lisp
10497 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10498 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10499 @end lisp
10500
10501 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
10502 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10503 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10504 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10505 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10506 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10507 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10508
10509 @end table
10510
10511 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10512
10513 @example
10514 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10515 | \[Jan]
10516 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10517 | \(***)-[Eri]
10518 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10519 \[Bjo]
10520 \[Gun]
10521 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10522 @end example
10523
10524 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10525
10526 @example
10527 @group
10528 @{***@}
10529 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10530 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10531 |--\-----\-----\ |
10532 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10533 | | |--\
10534 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10535 |
10536 [Paa]
10537 @end group
10538 @end example
10539
10540 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10541 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10542 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10543
10544 @lisp
10545 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10546 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10547 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10548 (gnus-add-configuration
10549 '(article
10550 (vertical 1.0
10551 (horizontal 0.25
10552 (summary 0.75 point)
10553 (tree 1.0))
10554 (article 1.0))))
10555 @end lisp
10556
10557 @xref{Window Layout}.
10558
10559
10560 @node Mail Group Commands
10561 @section Mail Group Commands
10562 @cindex mail group commands
10563
10564 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10565 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10566
10567 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10568 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10569
10570 @table @kbd
10571
10572 @item B e
10573 @kindex B e (Summary)
10574 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10575 @cindex expiring mail
10576 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10577 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10578 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10579 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10580
10581 @item B C-M-e
10582 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10583 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10584 @cindex expiring mail
10585 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10586 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10587 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10588 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10589
10590 @item B DEL
10591 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10592 @cindex deleting mail
10593 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10594 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10595 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10596 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10597 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10598
10599 @item B m
10600 @kindex B m (Summary)
10601 @cindex move mail
10602 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10603 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10604 Move the article from one mail group to another
10605 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10606 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10607
10608 @item B c
10609 @kindex B c (Summary)
10610 @cindex copy mail
10611 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10612 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10613 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10614 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10615 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10616
10617 @item B B
10618 @kindex B B (Summary)
10619 @cindex crosspost mail
10620 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10621 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10622 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10623 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10624 be properly updated.
10625
10626 @item B i
10627 @kindex B i (Summary)
10628 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10629 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10630 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10631 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10632
10633 @item B I
10634 @kindex B I (Summary)
10635 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10636 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10637 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10638 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10639
10640 @item B r
10641 @kindex B r (Summary)
10642 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10643 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10644 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10645 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10646 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10647 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10648 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10649 (which is the default).
10650
10651 @item B w
10652 @itemx e
10653 @kindex B w (Summary)
10654 @kindex e (Summary)
10655 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10656 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10657 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10658 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10659 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10660 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10661 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10662
10663 @item B q
10664 @kindex B q (Summary)
10665 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10666 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10667 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10668 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10669
10670 @item B t
10671 @kindex B t (Summary)
10672 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10673 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10674 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10675
10676 @item B p
10677 @kindex B p (Summary)
10678 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10679 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10680 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10681 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10682 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10683 article from your news server (or rather, from
10684 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10685 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10686 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10687 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10688 just not have arrived yet.
10689
10690 @item K E
10691 @kindex K E (Summary)
10692 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10693 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10694 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10695 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10696 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10697
10698 @end table
10699
10700 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10701 @cindex moving articles
10702 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10703 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10704 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10705 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10706 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10707 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10708 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10709
10710 @lisp
10711 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10712 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10713 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10714 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10715 @end lisp
10716
10717
10718 @node Various Summary Stuff
10719 @section Various Summary Stuff
10720
10721 @menu
10722 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10723 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10724 * Summary Generation Commands::
10725 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10726 @end menu
10727
10728 @table @code
10729 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10730 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10731 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10732 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10733 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10734 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10735
10736 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10737 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10738 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10739 current article.
10740
10741 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10742 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10743 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10744
10745 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10746 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10747 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10748 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10749 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10750 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10751 have been set.
10752
10753 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10754 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10755 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10756 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10757 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10758
10759 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10760 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10761 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10762 generated.
10763
10764 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10765 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10766 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10767 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10768 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10769 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10770 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10771 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10772 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10773 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10774
10775 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10776 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10777 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10778 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10779 list of articles to be selected.
10780
10781 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10782 the list in one particular group:
10783
10784 @lisp
10785 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10786 (if (string= group "some.group")
10787 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10788 articles))
10789 @end lisp
10790
10791 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10792 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10793 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10794 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10795 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10796 buffer is active.
10797
10798 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10799 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10800 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10801 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10802 variable will be used instead.
10803
10804 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10805 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10806 buffers. For example:
10807
10808 @lisp
10809 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10810 '(message-use-followup-to
10811 (gnus-visible-headers .
10812 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10813 @end lisp
10814
10815 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10816
10817 @end table
10818
10819
10820 @node Summary Group Information
10821 @subsection Summary Group Information
10822
10823 @table @kbd
10824
10825 @item H d
10826 @kindex H d (Summary)
10827 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10828 Give a brief description of the current group
10829 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10830 rereading the description from the server.
10831
10832 @item H h
10833 @kindex H h (Summary)
10834 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10835 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10836 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10837
10838 @item H i
10839 @kindex H i (Summary)
10840 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10841 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10842 @end table
10843
10844
10845 @node Searching for Articles
10846 @subsection Searching for Articles
10847
10848 @table @kbd
10849
10850 @item M-s
10851 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10852 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10853 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10854 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10855
10856 @item M-r
10857 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10858 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10859 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10860 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10861
10862 @item M-S
10863 @kindex M-S (Summary)
10864 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
10865 Repeat the previous search forwards
10866 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
10867
10868 @item M-R
10869 @kindex M-R (Summary)
10870 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
10871 Repeat the previous search backwards
10872 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
10873
10874 @item &
10875 @kindex & (Summary)
10876 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10877 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10878 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10879 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10880 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10881 search backward instead.
10882
10883 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10884 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10885
10886 @item M-&
10887 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10888 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10889 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10890 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10891 @end table
10892
10893 @node Summary Generation Commands
10894 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10895
10896 @table @kbd
10897
10898 @item Y g
10899 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10900 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10901 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10902
10903 @item Y c
10904 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10905 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10906 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10907 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10908
10909 @item Y d
10910 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10911 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10912 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10913 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10914
10915 @item Y t
10916 @kindex Y t (Summary)
10917 @findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
10918 Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10919 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
10920
10921 @end table
10922
10923
10924 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10925 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10926
10927 @table @kbd
10928
10929 @item A D
10930 @itemx C-d
10931 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10932 @kindex A D (Summary)
10933 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10934 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10935 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10936 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10937 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10938 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10939 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10940 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10941 fashion.
10942
10943 @vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
10944 The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
10945 article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
10946 include:
10947
10948 @table @code
10949 @item next
10950 Select the next article.
10951
10952 @item next-unread
10953 Select the next unread article.
10954
10955 @item next-noselect
10956 Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
10957
10958 @item next-unread-noselect
10959 Move the cursor to the next unread article.
10960 @end table
10961
10962 If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
10963 article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
10964
10965 @item C-M-d
10966 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10967 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10968 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10969 several documents into one biiig group
10970 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10971 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10972 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10973 command understands the process/prefix convention
10974 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10975
10976 @item C-t
10977 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10978 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10979 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10980 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10981 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10982 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10983
10984 @item =
10985 @kindex = (Summary)
10986 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10987 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10988 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10989
10990 @item C-M-e
10991 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10992 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10993 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10994 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10995
10996 @item C-M-a
10997 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10998 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10999 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11000 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
11001
11002 @end table
11003
11004
11005 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11006 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11007 @cindex summary exit
11008 @cindex exiting groups
11009
11010 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11011 group and return you to the group buffer.
11012
11013 @table @kbd
11014
11015 @item Z Z
11016 @itemx Z Q
11017 @itemx q
11018 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
11019 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
11020 @kindex q (Summary)
11021 @findex gnus-summary-exit
11022 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11023 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11024 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11025 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11026 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11027 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11028 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11029 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11030 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11031 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11032 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
11033
11034 @item Z E
11035 @itemx Q
11036 @kindex Z E (Summary)
11037 @kindex Q (Summary)
11038 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11039 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11040 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
11041
11042 @item Z c
11043 @itemx c
11044 @kindex Z c (Summary)
11045 @kindex c (Summary)
11046 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11047 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11048 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11049 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
11050
11051 @item Z C
11052 @kindex Z C (Summary)
11053 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11054 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11055 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
11056
11057 @item Z n
11058 @kindex Z n (Summary)
11059 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11060 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11061 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
11062
11063 @item Z p
11064 @kindex Z p (Summary)
11065 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11066 Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11067 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
11068
11069 @item Z R
11070 @itemx C-x C-s
11071 @kindex Z R (Summary)
11072 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11073 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11074 Exit this group, and then enter it again
11075 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11076 all articles, both read and unread.
11077
11078 @item Z G
11079 @itemx M-g
11080 @kindex Z G (Summary)
11081 @kindex M-g (Summary)
11082 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11083 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11084 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11085 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11086 articles, both read and unread.
11087
11088 @item Z N
11089 @kindex Z N (Summary)
11090 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
11091 Exit the group and go to the next group
11092 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
11093
11094 @item Z P
11095 @kindex Z P (Summary)
11096 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11097 Exit the group and go to the previous group
11098 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
11099
11100 @item Z s
11101 @kindex Z s (Summary)
11102 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11103 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11104 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11105 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11106 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11107 @end table
11108
11109 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11110 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11111 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11112 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
11113
11114 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11115 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11116 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11117 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11118 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11119 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11120 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11121 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11122 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11123 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11124 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11125 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
11126
11127 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
11128
11129 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11130 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
11131 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
11132 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11133 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11134 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11135 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11136 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11137 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
11138
11139
11140 @node Crosspost Handling
11141 @section Crosspost Handling
11142
11143 @cindex velveeta
11144 @cindex spamming
11145 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11146 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11147 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11148 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11149 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11150 heinous crime.
11151
11152 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11153 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11154 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11155 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11156 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
11157
11158 @cindex cross-posting
11159 @cindex Xref
11160 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
11161 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11162 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11163 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11164 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11165 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11166 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11167 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11168 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11169 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11170 the cross reference mechanism.
11171
11172 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
11173 @cindex overview.fmt
11174 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11175 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11176 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11177 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11178 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11179 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11180 overview files.
11181
11182 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
11183 set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11184 considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
11185
11186 C'est la vie.
11187
11188 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
11189
11190
11191 @node Duplicate Suppression
11192 @section Duplicate Suppression
11193
11194 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11195 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11196 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11197 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11198 reasons.
11199
11200 @enumerate
11201 @item
11202 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11203 is evil and not very common.
11204
11205 @item
11206 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11207 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
11208
11209 @item
11210 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11211 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
11212
11213 @item
11214 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11215 @end enumerate
11216
11217 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11218 well, but these four are the most common situations.
11219
11220 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11221 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11222 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11223 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11224 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11225 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11226 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11227 once.
11228
11229 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11230 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11231 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11232 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11233 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11234 saw the article in.
11235
11236 @table @code
11237 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11238 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11239 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
11240
11241 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11242 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11243 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11244 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11245 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11246 session are suppressed.
11247
11248 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11249 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11250 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11251 suppression list. The default is 10000.
11252
11253 @item gnus-duplicate-file
11254 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11255 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11256 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
11257 @end table
11258
11259 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11260 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
11261 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
11262 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
11263 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
11264 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
11265 to you to figure out, I think.
11266
11267 @node Security
11268 @section Security
11269
11270 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
11271 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
11272 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
11273 things to work:
11274
11275 @enumerate
11276 @item
11277 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
11278 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
11279 to GnuPG included with Emacs is called EasyPG (@pxref{Top, ,EasyPG,
11280 epa, EasyPG Assistant user's manual}), but PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg,
11281 PGG Manual}), and Mailcrypt are also supported.
11282
11283 @item
11284 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
11285 or newer is recommended.
11286
11287 @end enumerate
11288
11289 The variables that control security functionality on reading/composing
11290 messages include:
11291
11292 @table @code
11293 @item mm-verify-option
11294 @vindex mm-verify-option
11295 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
11296 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
11297 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11298
11299 @item mm-decrypt-option
11300 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
11301 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
11302 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
11303 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11304
11305 @item mm-sign-option
11306 @vindex mm-sign-option
11307 Option of creating signed parts. @code{nil}, use default signing
11308 keys; @code{guided}, ask user to select signing keys from the menu.
11309
11310 @item mm-encrypt-option
11311 @vindex mm-encrypt-option
11312 Option of creating encrypted parts. @code{nil}, use the first
11313 public-key matching the @samp{From:} header as the recipient;
11314 @code{guided}, ask user to select recipient keys from the menu.
11315
11316 @item mml1991-use
11317 @vindex mml1991-use
11318 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11319 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but @code{pgg},
11320 and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported although
11321 deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available interface in
11322 this order.
11323
11324 @item mml2015-use
11325 @vindex mml2015-use
11326 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11327 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but
11328 @code{pgg}, and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported
11329 although deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available
11330 interface in this order.
11331
11332 @end table
11333
11334 By default the buttons that display security information are not
11335 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
11336 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
11337 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
11338 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
11339 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
11340 how to customize these variables to always display security
11341 information.
11342
11343 @cindex snarfing keys
11344 @cindex importing PGP keys
11345 @cindex PGP key ring import
11346 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
11347 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
11348 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
11349 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
11350 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
11351 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
11352 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
11353 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
11354 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
11355
11356 @example
11357 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
11358 @end example
11359 @noindent
11360 This happens to also be the default action defined in
11361 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
11362
11363 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
11364 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
11365 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
11366
11367 @node Mailing List
11368 @section Mailing List
11369 @cindex mailing list
11370 @cindex RFC 2396
11371
11372 @kindex A M (summary)
11373 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
11374 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
11375 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
11376 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
11377 summary buffer.
11378
11379 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
11380
11381 @table @kbd
11382
11383 @item C-c C-n h
11384 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
11385 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
11386 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
11387
11388 @item C-c C-n s
11389 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
11390 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
11391 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
11392
11393 @item C-c C-n u
11394 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
11395 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
11396 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
11397 field exists.
11398
11399 @item C-c C-n p
11400 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
11401 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
11402 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
11403
11404 @item C-c C-n o
11405 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
11406 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
11407 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
11408
11409 @item C-c C-n a
11410 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
11411 @findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
11412 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
11413
11414 @end table
11415
11416
11417 @node Article Buffer
11418 @chapter Article Buffer
11419 @cindex article buffer
11420
11421 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
11422 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
11423 tell Gnus otherwise.
11424
11425 @menu
11426 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
11427 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
11428 * HTML:: Reading @acronym{HTML} messages.
11429 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
11430 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
11431 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
11432 @end menu
11433
11434
11435 @node Hiding Headers
11436 @section Hiding Headers
11437 @cindex hiding headers
11438 @cindex deleting headers
11439
11440 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
11441 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
11442
11443 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
11444 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
11445 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
11446 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
11447 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
11448 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
11449 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
11450 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
11451 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
11452
11453 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
11454
11455 @table @code
11456
11457 @item gnus-visible-headers
11458 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
11459 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
11460 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
11461 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
11462
11463 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
11464 the article and the subject, you'd say:
11465
11466 @lisp
11467 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
11468 @end lisp
11469
11470 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11471 remain visible.
11472
11473 @item gnus-ignored-headers
11474 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
11475 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
11476 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
11477 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
11478 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
11479
11480 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
11481 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
11482
11483 @lisp
11484 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
11485 @end lisp
11486
11487 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11488 be removed.
11489
11490 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
11491 variable will have no effect.
11492
11493 @end table
11494
11495 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
11496 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
11497 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
11498 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
11499 the headers are to be displayed.
11500
11501 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
11502 and then the subject, you might say something like:
11503
11504 @lisp
11505 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
11506 @end lisp
11507
11508 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
11509 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
11510
11511 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
11512 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
11513 You can hide further boring headers by setting
11514 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
11515 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
11516 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
11517 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11518 from sight.
11519
11520 These conditions are:
11521 @table @code
11522 @item empty
11523 Remove all empty headers.
11524 @item followup-to
11525 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11526 @code{Newsgroups} header.
11527 @item reply-to
11528 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11529 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11530 parameter is set.
11531 @item newsgroups
11532 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11533 name.
11534 @item to-address
11535 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11536 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11537 @item to-list
11538 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11539 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11540 @item cc-list
11541 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11542 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11543 @item date
11544 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11545 old.
11546 @item long-to
11547 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11548 @item many-to
11549 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
11550 @end table
11551
11552 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
11553
11554 @lisp
11555 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11556 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11557 @end lisp
11558
11559 This is also the default value for this variable.
11560
11561
11562 @node Using MIME
11563 @section Using MIME
11564 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11565
11566 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11567 while people stand around yawning.
11568
11569 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11570 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11571
11572 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11573 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11574 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11575
11576 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11577 @findex gnus-display-mime
11578 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11579 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11580 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11581 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11582
11583 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11584 @acronym{MIME} button:
11585
11586 @table @kbd
11587 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11588 @item RET (Article)
11589 @kindex RET (Article)
11590 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11591 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11592 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11593 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11594 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11595 object is displayed inline.
11596
11597 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11598 @item M-RET (Article)
11599 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11600 @itemx v (Article)
11601 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11602 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11603
11604 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11605 @item t (Article)
11606 @kindex t (Article)
11607 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11608 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11609
11610 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11611 @item C (Article)
11612 @kindex C (Article)
11613 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11614 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11615
11616 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11617 @item o (Article)
11618 @kindex o (Article)
11619 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11620 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11621
11622 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11623 @item C-o (Article)
11624 @kindex C-o (Article)
11625 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11626 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11627 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11628 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11629 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11630 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11631
11632 @findex gnus-mime-replace-part
11633 @item r (Article)
11634 @kindex r (Article)
11635 Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
11636 external body referring to the file via the message/external-body
11637 @acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
11638
11639 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11640 @item d (Article)
11641 @kindex d (Article)
11642 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11643 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11644 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11645
11646 @c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
11647
11648 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11649 @item c (Article)
11650 @kindex c (Article)
11651 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11652 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
11653 without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
11654 charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
11655 @ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11656 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11657 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11658 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11659
11660 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11661 @item p (Article)
11662 @kindex p (Article)
11663 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11664 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11665 @file{.mailcap} file.
11666
11667 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11668 @item i (Article)
11669 @kindex i (Article)
11670 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11671 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
11672 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11673 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11674 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11675 Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
11676 automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
11677 @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
11678 Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11679
11680 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11681 @item E (Article)
11682 @kindex E (Article)
11683 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11684 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11685 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11686
11687 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11688 @item e (Article)
11689 @kindex e (Article)
11690 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11691 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11692
11693 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11694 @item | (Article)
11695 @kindex | (Article)
11696 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11697
11698 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11699 @item . (Article)
11700 @kindex . (Article)
11701 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11702 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11703
11704 @end table
11705
11706 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11707 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11708 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11709
11710 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11711 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11712 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11713 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11714 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11715 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11716 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11717 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11718 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11719
11720 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11721
11722 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11723
11724
11725 @node HTML
11726 @section @acronym{HTML}
11727 @cindex @acronym{HTML}
11728
11729 If you have @code{w3m} installed on your system, Gnus can display
11730 @acronym{HTML} articles in the article buffer. There are many Gnus
11731 add-ons for doing this, using various approaches, but there's one
11732 (sort of) built-in method that's used by default.
11733
11734 For a complete overview, consult @xref{Display Customization,
11735 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. This
11736 section only describes the default method.
11737
11738 @table @code
11739 @item mm-text-html-renderer
11740 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
11741 If set to @code{gnus-article-html}, Gnus will use the built-in method,
11742 that's based on @code{w3m}.
11743
11744 @item gnus-blocked-images
11745 @vindex gnus-blocked-images
11746 External images that have @acronym{URL}s that match this regexp won't
11747 be fetched and displayed. For instance, do block all @acronym{URL}s
11748 that have the string ``ads'' in them, do the following:
11749
11750 @lisp
11751 (setq gnus-blocked-images "ads")
11752 @end lisp
11753
11754 This can also be a function to be evaluated. If so, it will be
11755 called with the group name as the parameter. The default value is
11756 @code{gnus-block-private-groups}, which will return @samp{"."} for
11757 anything that isn't a newsgroup. This means that no external images
11758 will be fetched as a result of reading mail, so that nobody can use
11759 web bugs (and the like) to track whether you've read email.
11760
11761 Also @pxref{Misc Article} for @code{gnus-inhibit-images}.
11762
11763 @item gnus-html-cache-directory
11764 @vindex gnus-html-cache-directory
11765 Gnus will download and cache images according to how
11766 @code{gnus-blocked-images} is set. These images will be stored in
11767 this directory.
11768
11769 @item gnus-html-cache-size
11770 @vindex gnus-html-cache-size
11771 When @code{gnus-html-cache-size} bytes have been used in that
11772 directory, the oldest files will be deleted. The default is 500MB.
11773
11774 @item gnus-html-frame-width
11775 @vindex gnus-html-frame-width
11776 The width to use when rendering HTML. The default is 70.
11777
11778 @item gnus-max-image-proportion
11779 @vindex gnus-max-image-proportion
11780 How big pictures displayed are in relation to the window they're in.
11781 A value of 0.7 (the default) means that they are allowed to take up
11782 70% of the width and height of the window. If they are larger than
11783 this, and Emacs supports it, then the images will be rescaled down to
11784 fit these criteria.
11785
11786 @end table
11787
11788 To use this, make sure that you have @code{w3m} and @code{curl}
11789 installed. If you have, then Gnus should display @acronym{HTML}
11790 automatically.
11791
11792
11793
11794 @node Customizing Articles
11795 @section Customizing Articles
11796 @cindex article customization
11797
11798 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11799 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11800 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11801 called automatically when you select the articles.
11802
11803 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11804 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11805 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11806 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11807
11808 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11809 for sensible values.
11810
11811 @enumerate
11812 @item
11813 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11814
11815 @item
11816 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11817
11818 @item
11819 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11820
11821 @item
11822 @code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
11823
11824 @item
11825 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
11826
11827 @item
11828 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11829 than this number.
11830
11831 @item
11832 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11833 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11834 regexps in the list.
11835
11836 @item
11837 A list where the first element is not a string:
11838
11839 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11840 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11841 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11842
11843 @lisp
11844 (or last
11845 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11846 @end lisp
11847
11848 @end enumerate
11849
11850 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11851 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11852 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11853 considered to contain just a single part.
11854
11855 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11856 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11857 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11858 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11859 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11860 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11861 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11862
11863 @ifinfo
11864 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11865 @c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11866 @c `i foo-bar'.
11867 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11868 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11869 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11870 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11871 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11872 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11873 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11874 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11875 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11876 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11877 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11878 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11879 @vindex gnus-treat-date
11880 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11881 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11882 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11883 @vindex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
11884 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
11885 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11886 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11887 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11888 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11889 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11890 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11891 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11892 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11893 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11894 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11895 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11896 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11897 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11898 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11899 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11900 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11901 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11902 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11903 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11904 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11905 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11906 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11907 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11908 @end ifinfo
11909
11910 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11911 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11912 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11913 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11914
11915 @table @code
11916 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11917 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11918
11919 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11920
11921 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11922 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11923 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11924 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11925 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
11926 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11927 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11928 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11929 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11930 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11931
11932 @xref{Article Washing}.
11933
11934 @item gnus-treat-date (head)
11935
11936 This will transform/add date headers according to the
11937 @code{gnus-article-date-headers} variable. This is a list of Date
11938 headers to display. The formats available are:
11939
11940 @table @code
11941 @item ut
11942 Universal time, aka GMT, aka ZULU.
11943
11944 @item local
11945 The user's local time zone.
11946
11947 @item english
11948 A semi-readable English sentence.
11949
11950 @item lapsed
11951 The time elapsed since the message was posted.
11952
11953 @item combined-lapsed
11954 Both the original date header and a (shortened) elapsed time.
11955
11956 @item original
11957 The original date header.
11958
11959 @item iso8601
11960 ISO8601 format, i.e., ``2010-11-23T22:05:21''.
11961
11962 @item user-defined
11963 A format done according to the @code{gnus-article-time-format}
11964 variable.
11965
11966 @end table
11967
11968 @xref{Article Date}.
11969
11970 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11971 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11972 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11973
11974 @xref{Picons}.
11975
11976 @item gnus-treat-from-gravatar (head)
11977 @item gnus-treat-mail-gravatar (head)
11978
11979 @xref{Gravatars}.
11980
11981 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11982
11983 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11984
11985 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11986 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11987 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11988
11989 @xref{Smileys}.
11990
11991 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11992 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11993
11994 @xref{X-Face}.
11995
11996 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11997 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11998
11999 @xref{Face}.
12000
12001 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12002 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12003 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12004 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12005 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12006 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12007 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12008 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12009 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12010 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12011 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12012 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12013 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12014 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12015 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12016 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12017 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12018 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12019 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12020 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
12021
12022 @xref{Article Hiding}.
12023
12024 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12025 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12026 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12027 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12028 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12029 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
12030
12031 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
12032
12033 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12034 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12035 @item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
12036 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12037 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
12038
12039 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12040 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12041 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12042 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12043 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12044 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12045 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12046 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12047
12048 @xref{Article Header}.
12049
12050
12051 @end table
12052
12053 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12054 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12055 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12056 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12057 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12058 everything.
12059
12060
12061 @node Article Keymap
12062 @section Article Keymap
12063
12064 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12065 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12066 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12067 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12068 buffer.
12069
12070 @kindex v (Article)
12071 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12072 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12073 command or better use it as a prefix key.
12074
12075 A few additional keystrokes are available:
12076
12077 @table @kbd
12078
12079 @item SPACE
12080 @kindex SPACE (Article)
12081 @findex gnus-article-next-page
12082 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12083 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12084
12085 @item DEL
12086 @kindex DEL (Article)
12087 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
12088 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12089 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
12090
12091 @item C-c ^
12092 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12093 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
12094 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12095 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12096 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
12097
12098 @item C-c C-m
12099 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12100 @findex gnus-article-mail
12101 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12102 given a prefix, include the mail.
12103
12104 @item s
12105 @kindex s (Article)
12106 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
12107 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12108 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
12109
12110 @item ?
12111 @kindex ? (Article)
12112 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12113 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12114 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
12115
12116 @item TAB
12117 @kindex TAB (Article)
12118 @findex gnus-article-next-button
12119 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12120 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
12121
12122 @item M-TAB
12123 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
12124 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
12125 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
12126
12127 @item R
12128 @kindex R (Article)
12129 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12130 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
12131 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12132 only yank the text in the region.
12133
12134 @item S W
12135 @kindex S W (Article)
12136 @findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12137 Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12138 (@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12139 active, only yank the text in the region.
12140
12141 @item F
12142 @kindex F (Article)
12143 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12144 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
12145 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12146 only yank the text in the region.
12147
12148
12149 @end table
12150
12151
12152 @node Misc Article
12153 @section Misc Article
12154
12155 @table @code
12156
12157 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
12158 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12159 @cindex article buffers, several
12160 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12161 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12162 article buffer.
12163
12164 @item gnus-widen-article-window
12165 @cindex gnus-widen-article-window
12166 If non-@code{nil}, selecting the article buffer with the @kbd{h}
12167 command will ``widen'' the article window to take the entire frame.
12168
12169 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12170 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
12171 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
12172 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12173 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
12174
12175 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12176 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12177 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12178 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12179 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12180 the contents of the article buffer.
12181
12182 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
12183 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12184 Hook called in article mode buffers.
12185
12186 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12187 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12188 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12189 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
12190
12191 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12192 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
12193 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12194 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
12195
12196 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12197 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12198 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12199 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12200 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12201 with two extensions:
12202
12203 @table @samp
12204
12205 @item w
12206 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12207 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12208 performed. The characters and their meaning:
12209
12210 @table @samp
12211
12212 @item c
12213 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
12214
12215 @item h
12216 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
12217
12218 @item p
12219 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12220 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
12221 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
12222
12223 @item s
12224 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
12225
12226 @item o
12227 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
12228
12229 @item e
12230 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasized strings in the article buffer.
12231
12232 @end table
12233
12234 @item m
12235 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
12236
12237 @end table
12238
12239 @vindex gnus-break-pages
12240
12241 @item gnus-break-pages
12242 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12243 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12244 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12245 paging will not be done.
12246
12247 @item gnus-page-delimiter
12248 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12249 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12250 (formfeed).
12251
12252 @cindex IDNA
12253 @cindex internationalized domain names
12254 @vindex gnus-use-idna
12255 @item gnus-use-idna
12256 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12257 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
12258 @samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12259 for how to compose such messages. This requires
12260 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12261 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
12262
12263 @vindex gnus-inhibit-images
12264 @item gnus-inhibit-images
12265 If this is non-@code{nil}, inhibit displaying of images inline in the
12266 article body. It is effective to images that are in articles as
12267 @acronym{MIME} parts, and images in @acronym{HTML} articles rendered
12268 when @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization,
12269 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) is
12270 @code{shr} or @code{gnus-w3m}.
12271
12272 @end table
12273
12274
12275 @node Composing Messages
12276 @chapter Composing Messages
12277 @cindex composing messages
12278 @cindex messages
12279 @cindex mail
12280 @cindex sending mail
12281 @cindex reply
12282 @cindex followup
12283 @cindex post
12284 @cindex using gpg
12285 @cindex using s/mime
12286 @cindex using smime
12287
12288 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12289 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12290 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12291 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12292 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12293 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
12294
12295 @menu
12296 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12297 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12298 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12299 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12300 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12301 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12302 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12303 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12304 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12305 @end menu
12306
12307 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12308 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
12309
12310
12311 @node Mail
12312 @section Mail
12313
12314 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
12315
12316 @table @code
12317 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12318 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12319 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12320 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12321 @code{nil} include all headers.
12322
12323 @item gnus-add-to-list
12324 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
12325 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12326 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
12327
12328 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12329 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12330 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12331 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12332 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12333 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12334 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12335 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
12336
12337 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12338 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
12339
12340 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12341 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12342 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12343 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12344 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
12345
12346 @end table
12347
12348
12349 @node Posting Server
12350 @section Posting Server
12351
12352 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12353 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
12354
12355 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
12356
12357 It can be quite complicated.
12358
12359 @vindex gnus-post-method
12360 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12361 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12362 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12363 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12364 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12365 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12366 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12367 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12368 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
12369
12370 @lisp
12371 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12372 @end lisp
12373
12374 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12375 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12376 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12377 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
12378
12379 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12380 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
12381
12382 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
12383 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
12384 for posting.
12385
12386 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
12387 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
12388
12389 @vindex message-send-mail-function
12390 When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
12391 variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
12392 value suitable for your system.
12393 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
12394 information.
12395
12396
12397 @node POP before SMTP
12398 @section POP before SMTP
12399 @cindex pop before smtp
12400 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
12401
12402 Does your @acronym{ISP} use @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
12403 authentication? This authentication method simply requires you to
12404 contact the @acronym{POP} server before sending email. To do that,
12405 put the following lines in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
12406
12407 @lisp
12408 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
12409 @end lisp
12410
12411 @noindent
12412 The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function does @acronym{POP}
12413 authentication according to the value of @code{mail-sources} without
12414 fetching mails, just before sending a mail. @xref{Mail Sources}.
12415
12416 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
12417 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
12418 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
12419 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
12420 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
12421 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
12422
12423 @lisp
12424 (setq mail-source-primary-source
12425 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12426 :password "secret"))
12427 @end lisp
12428
12429 @noindent
12430 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
12431 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
12432
12433 @lisp
12434 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
12435 (lambda ()
12436 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
12437 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12438 :password "secret")))
12439 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
12440 @end lisp
12441
12442
12443 @node Mail and Post
12444 @section Mail and Post
12445
12446 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
12447 posting:
12448
12449 @table @code
12450 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
12451 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
12452 @cindex mailing lists
12453
12454 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
12455 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
12456 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
12457 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
12458 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
12459 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
12460 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
12461 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
12462 still a pain, though.
12463
12464 @item gnus-user-agent
12465 @vindex gnus-user-agent
12466 @cindex User-Agent
12467
12468 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
12469 User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
12470 symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
12471 version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
12472 (show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
12473 configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
12474 string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
12475
12476 @end table
12477
12478 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
12479 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
12480 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
12481
12482 @cindex ispell
12483 @findex ispell-message
12484 @lisp
12485 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
12486 @end lisp
12487
12488 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
12489 you're in, you could say something like the following:
12490
12491 @lisp
12492 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
12493 (lambda ()
12494 (cond
12495 ((string-match
12496 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
12497 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
12498 (t
12499 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
12500 @end lisp
12501
12502 Modify to suit your needs.
12503
12504 @vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
12505 If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is t, different levels of
12506 citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
12507 mode buffers.
12508
12509 @node Archived Messages
12510 @section Archived Messages
12511 @cindex archived messages
12512 @cindex sent messages
12513
12514 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
12515 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
12516 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
12517 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}. The
12518 default is "sent.%Y-%m", which gives you one archive group per month.
12519
12520 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
12521 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
12522 Group Commands}).
12523
12524 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
12525 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
12526 use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
12527 actually being used it is expanded into:
12528
12529 @lisp
12530 (nnfolder "archive"
12531 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
12532 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
12533 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
12534 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
12535 @end lisp
12536
12537 @quotation
12538 @vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
12539 Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
12540 so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
12541 @code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
12542 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
12543 since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
12544 even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12545 afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
12546 mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
12547 saved method to reflect always the value of
12548 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
12549 @code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
12550 value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
12551 @end quotation
12552
12553 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
12554 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
12555 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
12556 directory chosen, you could say something like:
12557
12558 @lisp
12559 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
12560 '(nnfolder "archive"
12561 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
12562 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
12563 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
12564 @end lisp
12565
12566 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
12567 @cindex Gcc
12568 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
12569 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
12570 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
12571
12572 This variable can be used to do the following:
12573
12574 @table @asis
12575 @item a string
12576 Messages will be saved in that group.
12577
12578 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
12579 message will not be stored in the select method given by
12580 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
12581 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12582 has the default value shown above. Then setting
12583 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
12584 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
12585 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
12586 @samp{nnml:foo}.
12587
12588 @item a list of strings
12589 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
12590
12591 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
12592 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
12593
12594 @item @code{nil}
12595 No message archiving will take place.
12596 @end table
12597
12598 Let's illustrate:
12599
12600 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
12601 @lisp
12602 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
12603 @end lisp
12604
12605 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
12606 @lisp
12607 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
12608 @end lisp
12609
12610 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
12611 @lisp
12612 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12613 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
12614 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
12615 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
12616 @end lisp
12617
12618 More complex stuff:
12619 @lisp
12620 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12621 '((if (message-news-p)
12622 "misc-news"
12623 "misc-mail")))
12624 @end lisp
12625
12626 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
12627 messages in one file per month:
12628
12629 @lisp
12630 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12631 '((if (message-news-p)
12632 "misc-news"
12633 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
12634 @end lisp
12635
12636 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
12637 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
12638 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
12639 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
12640 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
12641 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
12642 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
12643 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
12644 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
12645 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
12646
12647 @table @code
12648 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12649 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12650 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
12651
12652 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12653 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12654 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12655 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12656 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12657 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12658 changed in the future.
12659
12660 @item gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12661 @vindex gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12662 Like the @code{gcc-self} group parameter, applied only for unmodified
12663 messages that @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} (@pxref{Summary Mail
12664 Commands}) resends. Non-@code{nil} value of this variable takes
12665 precedence over any existing @code{Gcc} header.
12666
12667 If this is @code{none}, no @code{Gcc} copy will be made. If this is
12668 @code{t}, messages resent will be @code{Gcc} copied to the current
12669 group. If this is a string, it specifies a group to which resent
12670 messages will be @code{Gcc} copied. If this is @code{nil}, @code{Gcc}
12671 will be done according to existing @code{Gcc} header(s), if any. If
12672 this is @code{no-gcc-self}, that is the default, resent messages will be
12673 @code{Gcc} copied to groups that existing @code{Gcc} header specifies,
12674 except for the current group.
12675
12676 @item gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12677 @vindex gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12678 @itemx gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12679 @vindex gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12680
12681 These hooks are run before/after encoding the message body of the Gcc
12682 copy of a sent message. The current buffer (when the hook is run)
12683 contains the message including the message header. Changes made to
12684 the message will only affect the Gcc copy, but not the original
12685 message. You can use these hooks to edit the copy (and influence
12686 subsequent transformations), e.g. remove MML secure tags
12687 (@pxref{Signing and encrypting}).
12688
12689 @end table
12690
12691
12692 @node Posting Styles
12693 @section Posting Styles
12694 @cindex posting styles
12695 @cindex styles
12696
12697 All them variables, they make my head swim.
12698
12699 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12700 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12701 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12702 on?
12703
12704 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
12705 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12706 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12707 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12708 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12709 variable:
12710
12711 @lisp
12712 ((".*"
12713 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12714 (organization "What me?"))
12715 ("^comp"
12716 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12717 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12718 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12719 @end lisp
12720
12721 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12722 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12723 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12724 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12725 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12726 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12727 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12728 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12729
12730 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12731 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12732 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12733 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12734 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12735 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12736 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12737 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12738 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12739 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12740 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12741 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12742 said to @dfn{match}.
12743
12744 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12745 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12746 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12747 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12748 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12749 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12750 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12751 name can be one of:
12752
12753 @itemize @bullet
12754 @item @code{signature}
12755 @item @code{signature-file}
12756 @item @code{x-face-file}
12757 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12758 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12759 @item @code{body}
12760 @end itemize
12761
12762 Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
12763 @code{message-signature-directory}.
12764
12765 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12766 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12767 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12768 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12769 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12770
12771 The attribute value can be a string, a function with zero arguments
12772 (the return value will be used), a variable (its value will be used)
12773 or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value will be
12774 used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12775 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current
12776 article are available through the @code{message-reply-headers}
12777 variable, which is a vector of the following headers: number subject
12778 from date id references chars lines xref extra.
12779
12780 In the case of a string value, if the @code{match} is a regular
12781 expression, a @samp{gnus-match-substitute-replacement} is proceed on
12782 the value to replace the positional parameters @samp{\@var{n}} by the
12783 corresponding parenthetical matches (see @xref{Replacing Match,,
12784 Replacing the Text that Matched, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
12785
12786 @vindex message-reply-headers
12787
12788 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12789 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12790 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12791
12792 @findex message-mail-p
12793 @findex message-news-p
12794
12795 So here's a new example:
12796
12797 @lisp
12798 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12799 '((".*"
12800 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12801 (name "User Name")
12802 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12803 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12804 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12805 ("^rec.humor"
12806 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12807 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12808 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12809 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12810 (signature my-news-signature))
12811 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12812 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12813 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12814 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12815 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12816 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12817 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12818 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12819 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12820 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
12821 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12822 ("nnml:.*"
12823 (From (with-current-buffer gnus-article-buffer
12824 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12825 ("^nn.+:"
12826 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12827 @end lisp
12828
12829 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12830 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12831 if you fill many roles.
12832 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12833 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12834
12835 Of particular interest in the ``work-mail'' style is the
12836 @samp{X-Message-SMTP-Method} header. It specifies how to send the
12837 outgoing email. You may want to sent certain emails through certain
12838 @acronym{SMTP} servers due to company policies, for instance.
12839 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Message Variables, message, Message Manual}.
12840
12841
12842 @node Drafts
12843 @section Drafts
12844 @cindex drafts
12845
12846 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12847 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12848 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12849 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12850 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12851
12852 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12853 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12854 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12855 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12856 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12857 group.)
12858
12859 @cindex nndraft
12860 @vindex nndraft-directory
12861 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12862 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12863 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12864 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12865 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12866 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12867
12868 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12869 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12870 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12871 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12872 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12873 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12874 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12875 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12876 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12877
12878 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12879 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12880 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12881 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12882 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12883 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12884 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12885 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12886 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12887 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12888 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12889 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12890 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12891 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12892 @c
12893 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12894 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12895 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12896
12897 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12898 @kindex D e (Draft)
12899 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12900 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12901 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12902
12903 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12904 Articles}).
12905
12906 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12907 @kindex D s (Draft)
12908 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12909 @kindex D S (Draft)
12910 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12911 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12912 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12913 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12914 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12915 in the buffer.
12916
12917 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12918 @kindex D t (Draft)
12919 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12920 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12921 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12922
12923 Finally, if you want to delete a draft, use the normal @kbd{B DEL}
12924 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
12925
12926
12927 @node Rejected Articles
12928 @section Rejected Articles
12929 @cindex rejected articles
12930
12931 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12932 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12933 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12934 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12935
12936 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12937 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12938 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12939 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12940 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12941
12942 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12943 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12944 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12945
12946 @node Signing and encrypting
12947 @section Signing and encrypting
12948 @cindex using gpg
12949 @cindex using s/mime
12950 @cindex using smime
12951
12952 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12953 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12954 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12955 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12956
12957 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12958 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12959 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12960 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12961 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12962 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12963 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12964 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12965 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12966 automatically encrypted messages.
12967
12968 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12969 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12970 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12971
12972 @table @kbd
12973
12974 @item C-c C-m s s
12975 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12976 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12977
12978 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12979
12980 @item C-c C-m s o
12981 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12982 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12983
12984 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12985
12986 @item C-c C-m s p
12987 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12988 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12989
12990 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12991
12992 @item C-c C-m c s
12993 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12994 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12995
12996 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12997
12998 @item C-c C-m c o
12999 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
13000 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
13001
13002 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13003
13004 @item C-c C-m c p
13005 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
13006 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
13007
13008 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13009
13010 @item C-c C-m C-n
13011 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
13012 @findex mml-unsecure-message
13013 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
13014
13015 @end table
13016
13017 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
13018
13019 @node Select Methods
13020 @chapter Select Methods
13021 @cindex foreign groups
13022 @cindex select methods
13023
13024 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
13025 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
13026 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
13027 personal mail group.
13028
13029 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13030 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
13031 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
13032 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13033 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13034 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
13035
13036 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13037 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
13038
13039 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13040 group as.
13041
13042 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13043 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13044 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13045 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13046 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
13047
13048 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
13049
13050 @menu
13051 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13052 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13053 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
13054 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13055 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13056 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
13057 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13058 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13059 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13060 @end menu
13061
13062
13063 @node Server Buffer
13064 @section Server Buffer
13065
13066 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13067 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13068 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13069 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13070 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13071 back end represents a virtual server.
13072
13073 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13074 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13075 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13076 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
13077
13078 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13079 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13080 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13081 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13082 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13083 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13084 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
13085
13086 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13087 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
13088
13089 @menu
13090 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13091 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13092 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13093 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13094 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13095 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13096 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
13097 @end menu
13098
13099 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13100 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13101
13102
13103 @node Server Buffer Format
13104 @subsection Server Buffer Format
13105 @cindex server buffer format
13106
13107 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
13108 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13109 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13110 variable, with some simple extensions:
13111
13112 @table @samp
13113
13114 @item h
13115 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
13116
13117 @item n
13118 The name of this server.
13119
13120 @item w
13121 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
13122
13123 @item s
13124 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
13125
13126 @item a
13127 Whether this server is agentized.
13128 @end table
13129
13130 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13131 The mode line can also be customized by using the
13132 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13133 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
13134
13135 @table @samp
13136 @item S
13137 Server name.
13138
13139 @item M
13140 Server method.
13141 @end table
13142
13143 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
13144
13145
13146 @node Server Commands
13147 @subsection Server Commands
13148 @cindex server commands
13149
13150 @table @kbd
13151
13152 @item v
13153 @kindex v (Server)
13154 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13155 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13156 command or better use it as a prefix key.
13157
13158 @item a
13159 @kindex a (Server)
13160 @findex gnus-server-add-server
13161 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
13162
13163 @item e
13164 @kindex e (Server)
13165 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
13166 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
13167
13168 @item S
13169 @kindex S (Server)
13170 @findex gnus-server-show-server
13171 Show the definition of a server (@code{gnus-server-show-server}).
13172
13173 @item SPACE
13174 @kindex SPACE (Server)
13175 @findex gnus-server-read-server
13176 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
13177
13178 @item q
13179 @kindex q (Server)
13180 @findex gnus-server-exit
13181 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
13182
13183 @item k
13184 @kindex k (Server)
13185 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
13186 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
13187
13188 @item y
13189 @kindex y (Server)
13190 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
13191 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
13192
13193 @item c
13194 @kindex c (Server)
13195 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13196 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
13197
13198 @item l
13199 @kindex l (Server)
13200 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
13201 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
13202
13203 @item s
13204 @kindex s (Server)
13205 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
13206 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13207 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13208 servers.
13209
13210 @item g
13211 @kindex g (Server)
13212 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13213 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13214 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13215 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
13216
13217 @item z
13218 @kindex z (Server)
13219 @findex gnus-server-compact-server
13220
13221 Compact all groups in the server under point
13222 (@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13223 nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13224 hence getting a correct total article count.
13225
13226 @end table
13227
13228 Some more commands for closing, disabling, and re-opening servers are
13229 listed in @ref{Unavailable Servers}.
13230
13231
13232 @node Example Methods
13233 @subsection Example Methods
13234
13235 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
13236
13237 @lisp
13238 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
13239 @end lisp
13240
13241 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
13242
13243 @lisp
13244 (nnspool "")
13245 @end lisp
13246
13247 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13248 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13249 will.
13250
13251 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13252 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
13253
13254 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13255 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13256 look like then:
13257
13258 @lisp
13259 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13260 @end lisp
13261
13262 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13263 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
13264
13265 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13266 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13267 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13268 your private mail:
13269
13270 @lisp
13271 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
13272 @end lisp
13273
13274 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13275 that.)
13276
13277 Here's the method for a public spool:
13278
13279 @lisp
13280 (nnmh "public"
13281 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13282 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
13283 @end lisp
13284
13285 @cindex proxy
13286 @cindex firewall
13287
13288 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13289 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
13290 on the firewall machine and connect with
13291 @uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13292 @acronym{NNTP} server.
13293 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13294 should probably look something like this:
13295
13296 @lisp
13297 (nntp "firewall"
13298 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
13299 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
13300 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
13301 @end lisp
13302
13303 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13304 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13305 configuration to the example above:
13306
13307 @lisp
13308 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13309 @end lisp
13310
13311 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13312 an indirect connection:
13313
13314 @lisp
13315 (setq gnus-select-method
13316 '(nntp "indirect"
13317 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13318 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13319 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13320 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13321 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13322 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
13323 @end lisp
13324
13325 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13326 provide automatic authorization, of course.
13327
13328 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13329 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
13330 netcat connection to the news server as follows:
13331
13332 @lisp
13333 (nntp "outside"
13334 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13335 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13336 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13337 @end lisp
13338
13339
13340 @node Creating a Virtual Server
13341 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
13342
13343 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13344 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
13345
13346 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13347 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13348 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
13349
13350 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
13351
13352 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13353 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13354 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13355 will contain the following:
13356
13357 @lisp
13358 (nnml "cache")
13359 @end lisp
13360
13361 Change that to:
13362
13363 @lisp
13364 (nnml "cache"
13365 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13366 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
13367 @end lisp
13368
13369 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13370 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13371 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
13372
13373
13374 @node Server Variables
13375 @subsection Server Variables
13376 @cindex server variables
13377 @cindex server parameters
13378
13379 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13380 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13381 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13382 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13383 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13384
13385 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13386 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13387 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13388 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13389 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13390 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13391 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13392 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13393 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
13394
13395 @lisp
13396 (nnml "public"
13397 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13398 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13399 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
13400 @end lisp
13401
13402 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
13403
13404 @node Servers and Methods
13405 @subsection Servers and Methods
13406
13407 Wherever you would normally use a select method
13408 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
13409 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
13410 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
13411 over.
13412
13413
13414 @node Unavailable Servers
13415 @subsection Unavailable Servers
13416
13417 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
13418 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
13419 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
13420 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
13421 actually the case or not.
13422
13423 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
13424 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
13425 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
13426 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
13427 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
13428 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
13429 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
13430 it will regard that server as ``down''.
13431
13432 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
13433 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
13434
13435 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
13436 with the following commands:
13437
13438 @table @kbd
13439
13440 @item O
13441 @kindex O (Server)
13442 @findex gnus-server-open-server
13443 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
13444 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
13445
13446 @item C
13447 @kindex C (Server)
13448 @findex gnus-server-close-server
13449 Close the connection (if any) to the server
13450 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
13451
13452 @item D
13453 @kindex D (Server)
13454 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
13455 Mark the current server as unreachable
13456 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
13457
13458 @item M-o
13459 @kindex M-o (Server)
13460 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
13461 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
13462 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
13463
13464 @item M-c
13465 @kindex M-c (Server)
13466 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
13467 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
13468 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
13469
13470 @item R
13471 @kindex R (Server)
13472 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
13473 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
13474 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
13475
13476 @item c
13477 @kindex c (Server)
13478 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13479 Copy a server and give it a new name
13480 (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}). This can be useful if you have a
13481 complex method definition, and want to use the same definition towards
13482 a different (physical) server.
13483
13484 @item L
13485 @kindex L (Server)
13486 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
13487 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
13488
13489 @end table
13490
13491
13492 @node Getting News
13493 @section Getting News
13494 @cindex reading news
13495 @cindex news back ends
13496
13497 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
13498 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
13499 or it can read from a local spool.
13500
13501 @menu
13502 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13503 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
13504 @end menu
13505
13506
13507 @node NNTP
13508 @subsection NNTP
13509 @cindex nntp
13510
13511 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
13512 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
13513 server as the, uhm, address.
13514
13515 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
13516 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
13517 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
13518 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
13519
13520 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
13521 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
13522 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
13523
13524 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
13525 server:
13526
13527 @table @code
13528
13529 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
13530 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
13531 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
13532 @cindex authinfo
13533 @cindex authentication
13534 @cindex nntp authentication
13535 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13536 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
13537 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
13538 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
13539 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
13540 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
13541 present in this hook.
13542
13543 @item nntp-authinfo-function
13544 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
13545 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13546 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
13547 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
13548 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
13549 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
13550 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
13551 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
13552 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
13553 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
13554 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
13555
13556 @enumerate
13557 @item
13558 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
13559
13560 @item
13561 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
13562
13563 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
13564 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
13565 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
13566 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
13567 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
13568 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
13569 @samp{force} is explained below.
13570
13571 @end enumerate
13572
13573 Here's an example file:
13574
13575 @example
13576 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
13577 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
13578 @end example
13579
13580 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
13581 have to be first, for instance.
13582
13583 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
13584 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
13585 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
13586 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
13587 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
13588 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
13589 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
13590
13591 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
13592 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
13593
13594 @example
13595 default force yes
13596 @end example
13597
13598 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
13599 previously mentioned.
13600
13601 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
13602
13603 @item nntp-server-action-alist
13604 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
13605 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
13606 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
13607 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
13608
13609 @lisp
13610 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
13611 '(("innd" (ding))))
13612 @end lisp
13613
13614 You probably don't want to do that, though.
13615
13616 The default value is
13617
13618 @lisp
13619 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
13620 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
13621 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
13622 @end lisp
13623
13624 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
13625 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
13626
13627 @item nntp-maximum-request
13628 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
13629 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
13630 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
13631 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
13632 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
13633 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
13634 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
13635
13636 @item nntp-connection-timeout
13637 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
13638 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
13639 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
13640 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
13641 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
13642 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
13643 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
13644 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
13645 no timeouts are done.
13646
13647 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
13648 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
13649 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
13650 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
13651 can be used.
13652
13653 @item nntp-xover-commands
13654 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
13655 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
13656 @cindex XOVER
13657 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
13658 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
13659 "XOVERVIEW")}.
13660
13661 @item nntp-nov-gap
13662 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
13663 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
13664 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
13665 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
13666 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
13667 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
13668 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
13669 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
13670 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
13671 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
13672 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
13673
13674 @item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13675 @vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13676 When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
13677 specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
13678 current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
13679 command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
13680 returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
13681 in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
13682 refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
13683 current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
13684 some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
13685 having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
13686 between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
13687 @code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
13688 to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
13689 you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
13690 value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
13691
13692 @lisp
13693 (setq gnus-select-method
13694 '(nntp "newszilla"
13695 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
13696 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
13697 @dots{}))
13698 @end lisp
13699
13700 The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
13701
13702 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
13703 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
13704 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13705
13706 @item nntp-record-commands
13707 @vindex nntp-record-commands
13708 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13709 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
13710 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13711 that doesn't seem to work.
13712
13713 @item nntp-open-connection-function
13714 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13715 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13716 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13717 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
13718 Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
13719 in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13720 indirect ones (three pre-made).
13721
13722 @item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13723 @vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13724 Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13725 reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13726 to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13727 @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13728 example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13729 @code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13730 overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13731
13732 @item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13733 @vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13734 List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13735 you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13736 not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13737 @code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13738 default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
13739
13740 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13741 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13742 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13743 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13744 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13745 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13746 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
13747
13748 @lisp
13749 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13750 @end lisp
13751
13752 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
13753 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
13754
13755 @item nntp-server-list-active-group
13756 If @code{nil}, then always use @samp{GROUP} instead of @samp{LIST
13757 ACTIVE}. This is usually slower, but on misconfigured servers that
13758 don't update their active files often, this can help.
13759
13760
13761 @end table
13762
13763 @menu
13764 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13765 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13766 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
13767 @end menu
13768
13769
13770 @node Direct Functions
13771 @subsubsection Direct Functions
13772 @cindex direct connection functions
13773
13774 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13775 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13776 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13777 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13778
13779 @table @code
13780 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
13781 @item nntp-open-network-stream
13782 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13783 remote system. If both Emacs and the server supports it, the
13784 connection will be upgraded to an encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS}
13785 connection automatically.
13786
13787 @item network-only
13788 The same as the above, but don't do automatic @acronym{STARTTLS} upgrades.
13789
13790 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13791 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
13792 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13793 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GnuTLS}
13794 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13795
13796 @lisp
13797 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13798 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13799 ;;
13800 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13801 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13802 (nntp-port-number 563)
13803 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13804 @end lisp
13805
13806 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13807 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13808 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13809 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
13810 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
13811 then define a server as follows:
13812
13813 @lisp
13814 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13815 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13816 ;;
13817 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13818 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13819 (nntp-port-number 563)
13820 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13821 @end lisp
13822
13823 @findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
13824 @item nntp-open-netcat-stream
13825 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
13826 program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
13827 the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13828 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13829 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13830 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13831
13832 @lisp
13833 (nntp "socksified"
13834 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13835 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13836 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13837 @end lisp
13838
13839 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13840 session, which is not a good idea.
13841
13842 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13843 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13844 Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
13845 @code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
13846 like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
13847 not available. The previous example would turn into:
13848
13849 @lisp
13850 (nntp "socksified"
13851 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13852 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13853 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
13854 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
13855 @end lisp
13856 @end table
13857
13858
13859 @node Indirect Functions
13860 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
13861 @cindex indirect connection functions
13862
13863 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13864 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13865 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13866 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13867 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13868 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13869
13870 @table @code
13871 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13872 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13873 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
13874 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13875 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13876
13877 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
13878
13879 @table @code
13880 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13881 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13882 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13883 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13884
13885 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13886 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13887 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13888 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13889 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13890 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
13891 @end table
13892
13893 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13894 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13895 Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
13896 to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
13897 @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
13898 line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
13899
13900 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13901
13902 @table @code
13903 @item nntp-telnet-command
13904 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13905 Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
13906 intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
13907
13908 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13909 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13910 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13911 @code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
13912
13913 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13914 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13915 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13916 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13917
13918 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13919 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13920 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13921 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
13922 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13923 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13924 host. The default is @code{nil}.
13925 @end table
13926
13927 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13928 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13929
13930 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13931 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13932 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13933 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13934
13935 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13936
13937 @table @code
13938 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
13939 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13940 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13941 @samp{telnet}.
13942
13943 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13944 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13945 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13946 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13947
13948 @item nntp-via-user-password
13949 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
13950 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13951
13952 @item nntp-via-envuser
13953 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
13954 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13955 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13956 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13957
13958 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13959 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13960 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13961 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13962
13963 @end table
13964
13965 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13966 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13967 @end table
13968
13969
13970 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13971 functions:
13972
13973 @table @code
13974
13975 @item nntp-via-user-name
13976 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
13977 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
13978
13979 @item nntp-via-address
13980 @vindex nntp-via-address
13981 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
13982
13983 @end table
13984
13985
13986 @node Common Variables
13987 @subsubsection Common Variables
13988
13989 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
13990 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
13991 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
13992 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
13993 variables individually).
13994
13995 @table @code
13996
13997 @item nntp-pre-command
13998 @vindex nntp-pre-command
13999 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
14000 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
14001 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
14002 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
14003
14004 @item nntp-address
14005 @vindex nntp-address
14006 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14007
14008 @item nntp-port-number
14009 @vindex nntp-port-number
14010 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14011 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
14012 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
14013 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
14014 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
14015 not work with named ports.
14016
14017 @item nntp-end-of-line
14018 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
14019 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
14020 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
14021 using a non native telnet connection function.
14022
14023 @item nntp-netcat-command
14024 @vindex nntp-netcat-command
14025 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
14026 @samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
14027 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14028 @samp{nc}.
14029
14030 @item nntp-netcat-switches
14031 @vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14032 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
14033 is @samp{()}.
14034
14035 @end table
14036
14037 @node News Spool
14038 @subsection News Spool
14039 @cindex nnspool
14040 @cindex news spool
14041
14042 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14043 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14044 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14045 instance.
14046
14047 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14048 anything else) as the address.
14049
14050 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14051 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14052 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14053 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
14054
14055 @table @code
14056
14057 @item nnspool-inews-program
14058 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
14059 Program used to post an article.
14060
14061 @item nnspool-inews-switches
14062 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14063 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
14064
14065 @item nnspool-spool-directory
14066 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14067 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14068 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
14069
14070 @item nnspool-nov-directory
14071 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14072 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14073 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
14074
14075 @item nnspool-lib-dir
14076 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14077 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
14078
14079 @item nnspool-active-file
14080 @vindex nnspool-active-file
14081 The name of the active file.
14082
14083 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14084 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14085 The name of the group descriptions file.
14086
14087 @item nnspool-history-file
14088 @vindex nnspool-history-file
14089 The name of the news history file.
14090
14091 @item nnspool-active-times-file
14092 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14093 The name of the active date file.
14094
14095 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14096 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14097 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14098 that it finds.
14099
14100 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14101 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14102 @cindex sed
14103 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14104 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14105 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14106 there.
14107
14108 @end table
14109
14110
14111 @node Using IMAP
14112 @section Using IMAP
14113 @cindex imap
14114
14115 The most popular mail backend is probably @code{nnimap}, which
14116 provides access to @acronym{IMAP} servers. @acronym{IMAP} servers
14117 store mail remotely, so the client doesn't store anything locally.
14118 This means that it's a convenient choice when you're reading your mail
14119 from different locations, or with different user agents.
14120
14121 @menu
14122 * Connecting to an IMAP Server:: Getting started with @acronym{IMAP}.
14123 * Customizing the IMAP Connection:: Variables for @acronym{IMAP} connection.
14124 * Client-Side IMAP Splitting:: Put mail in the correct mail box.
14125 @end menu
14126
14127
14128 @node Connecting to an IMAP Server
14129 @subsection Connecting to an IMAP Server
14130
14131 Connecting to an @acronym{IMAP} can be very easy. Type @kbd{B} in the
14132 group buffer, or (if your primary interest is reading email), say
14133 something like:
14134
14135 @example
14136 (setq gnus-select-method
14137 '(nnimap "imap.gmail.com"))
14138 @end example
14139
14140 You'll be prompted for a user name and password. If you grow tired of
14141 that, then add the following to your @file{~/.authinfo} file:
14142
14143 @example
14144 machine imap.gmail.com login <username> password <password> port imap
14145 @end example
14146
14147 That should basically be it for most users.
14148
14149
14150 @node Customizing the IMAP Connection
14151 @subsection Customizing the IMAP Connection
14152
14153 Here's an example method that's more complex:
14154
14155 @example
14156 (nnimap "imap.gmail.com"
14157 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14158 (nnimap-split-methods default)
14159 (nnimap-expunge t)
14160 (nnimap-stream ssl))
14161 @end example
14162
14163 @table @code
14164 @item nnimap-address
14165 The address of the server, like @samp{imap.gmail.com}.
14166
14167 @item nnimap-server-port
14168 If the server uses a non-standard port, that can be specified here. A
14169 typical port would be @code{"imap"} or @code{"imaps"}.
14170
14171 @item nnimap-stream
14172 How @code{nnimap} should connect to the server. Possible values are:
14173
14174 @table @code
14175 @item undecided
14176 This is the default, and this first tries the @code{ssl} setting, and
14177 then tries the @code{network} setting.
14178
14179 @item ssl
14180 This uses standard @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14181
14182 @item network
14183 Non-encrypted and unsafe straight socket connection, but will upgrade
14184 to encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} if both Emacs and the server
14185 supports it.
14186
14187 @item starttls
14188 Encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} over the normal @acronym{IMAP} port.
14189
14190 @item shell
14191 If you need to tunnel via other systems to connect to the server, you
14192 can use this option, and customize @code{nnimap-shell-program} to be
14193 what you need.
14194
14195 @end table
14196
14197 @item nnimap-authenticator
14198 Some @acronym{IMAP} servers allow anonymous logins. In that case,
14199 this should be set to @code{anonymous}.
14200
14201 @item nnimap-expunge
14202 If non-@code{nil}, expunge articles after deleting them. This is always done
14203 if the server supports UID EXPUNGE, but it's not done by default on
14204 servers that doesn't support that command.
14205
14206 @item nnimap-streaming
14207 Virtually all @acronym{IMAP} server support fast streaming of data.
14208 If you have problems connecting to the server, try setting this to
14209 @code{nil}.
14210
14211 @item nnimap-fetch-partial-articles
14212 If non-@code{nil}, fetch partial articles from the server. If set to
14213 a string, then it's interpreted as a regexp, and parts that have
14214 matching types will be fetched. For instance, @samp{"text/"} will
14215 fetch all textual parts, while leaving the rest on the server.
14216
14217 @item nnimap-record-commands
14218 If non-@code{nil}, record all @acronym{IMAP} commands in the
14219 @samp{"*imap log*"} buffer.
14220
14221 @end table
14222
14223
14224 @node Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14225 @subsection Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14226
14227 Many people prefer to do the sorting/splitting of mail into their mail
14228 boxes on the @acronym{IMAP} server. That way they don't have to
14229 download the mail they're not all that interested in.
14230
14231 If you do want to do client-side mail splitting, then the following
14232 variables are relevant:
14233
14234 @table @code
14235 @item nnimap-inbox
14236 This is the @acronym{IMAP} mail box that will be scanned for new mail.
14237
14238 @item nnimap-split-methods
14239 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-methods} (@pxref{Splitting
14240 Mail}), except the symbol @code{default}, which means that it should
14241 use the value of the @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable.
14242
14243 @item nnimap-split-fancy
14244 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
14245
14246 @item nnimap-unsplittable-articles
14247 List of flag symbols to ignore when doing splitting. That is,
14248 articles that have these flags won't be considered when splitting.
14249 The default is @samp{(%Deleted %Seen)}.
14250
14251 @end table
14252
14253 Here's a complete example @code{nnimap} backend with a client-side
14254 ``fancy'' splitting method:
14255
14256 @example
14257 (nnimap "imap.example.com"
14258 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14259 (nnimap-split-methods
14260 (| ("MailScanner-SpamCheck" "spam" "spam.detected")
14261 (to "foo@@bar.com" "foo")
14262 "undecided")))
14263 @end example
14264
14265
14266 @node Getting Mail
14267 @section Getting Mail
14268 @cindex reading mail
14269 @cindex mail
14270
14271 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
14272 course.
14273
14274 @menu
14275 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14276 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14277 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14278 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14279 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14280 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14281 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14282 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14283 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14284 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14285 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14286 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14287 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14288 @end menu
14289
14290
14291 @node Mail in a Newsreader
14292 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
14293
14294 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14295 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14296 of a culture shock.
14297
14298 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14299 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
14300
14301 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14302 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14303 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14304 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
14305
14306 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
14307
14308 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14309 deleted? How awful!
14310
14311 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14312 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14313 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14314 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14315 Mail}.
14316
14317 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14318 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14319 they want to treat a message.
14320
14321 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14322 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14323 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14324 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14325 archived somewhere else.
14326
14327 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14328 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14329 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14330 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14331 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
14332
14333 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14334 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14335 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
14336
14337 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14338 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14339 differently.
14340
14341 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14342 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14343 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14344 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14345 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
14346
14347 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14348 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14349 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14350 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14351 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14352 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14353 You Do.)
14354
14355
14356 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
14357 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14358
14359 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14360 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14361 and things will happen automatically.
14362
14363 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14364 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14365
14366 @lisp
14367 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14368 @end lisp
14369
14370 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14371 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14372 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14373 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14374 like any other group.
14375
14376 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
14377
14378 @lisp
14379 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14380 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14381 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14382 ("other" "")))
14383 @end lisp
14384
14385 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14386 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14387 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14388 last group.
14389
14390 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14391 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14392 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
14393
14394
14395 @node Splitting Mail
14396 @subsection Splitting Mail
14397 @cindex splitting mail
14398 @cindex mail splitting
14399 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
14400
14401 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
14402 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14403 to be split into groups.
14404
14405 @lisp
14406 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14407 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14408 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14409 ("mail.other" "")))
14410 @end lisp
14411
14412 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14413 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14414 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14415 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14416 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14417 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14418 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
14419
14420 @lisp
14421 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
14422 @end lisp
14423
14424 @noindent
14425 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14426 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14427
14428 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14429 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14430 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14431 mail belongs in that group.
14432
14433 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
14434 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14435 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14436 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14437 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14438 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14439 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14440 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14441 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14442 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
14443
14444 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14445 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14446 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14447 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14448 thinks should carry this mail message.
14449
14450 This variable can also be a fancy split method. For the syntax,
14451 see @ref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14452
14453 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14454 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14455 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14456 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
14457
14458 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
14459 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14460 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14461 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14462 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
14463
14464 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14465 @cindex crosspost
14466 @cindex links
14467 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14468 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14469 links. If that's the case for you, set
14470 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14471 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
14472
14473 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14474 @findex nnmail-split-history
14475 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14476 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14477 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14478 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14479 Group Commands}).
14480
14481 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14482 Header lines longer than the value of
14483 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14484 function.
14485
14486 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14487 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14488 By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14489 non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14490 articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14491 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14492 In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14493 variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14494 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14495 value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14496 string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14497 charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14498
14499 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14500 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14501 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14502 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14503 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14504 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14505 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14506 other kinds of entries.)
14507
14508 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14509 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14510 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14511 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14512 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14513 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14514 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14515 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14516 month's rent money.
14517
14518
14519 @node Mail Sources
14520 @subsection Mail Sources
14521
14522 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14523 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14524 maildir, for instance.
14525
14526 @menu
14527 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
14528 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14529 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14530 @end menu
14531
14532
14533 @node Mail Source Specifiers
14534 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14535 @cindex POP
14536 @cindex mail server
14537 @cindex procmail
14538 @cindex mail spool
14539 @cindex mail source
14540
14541 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
14542 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
14543
14544 Here's an example:
14545
14546 @lisp
14547 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
14548 @end lisp
14549
14550 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
14551 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
14552 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
14553 default values.
14554
14555 The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
14556 an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
14557 @code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
14558 @code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
14559 a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
14560 typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
14561 group might look like this:
14562
14563 @lisp
14564 (mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
14565 @end lisp
14566
14567 This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
14568 fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
14569
14570 The following mail source types are available:
14571
14572 @table @code
14573 @item file
14574 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
14575
14576 Keywords:
14577
14578 @table @code
14579 @item :path
14580 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
14581 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
14582 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
14583
14584 @item :prescript
14585 @itemx :postscript
14586 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14587 @end table
14588
14589 An example file mail source:
14590
14591 @lisp
14592 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
14593 @end lisp
14594
14595 Or using the default file name:
14596
14597 @lisp
14598 (file)
14599 @end lisp
14600
14601 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
14602 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
14603 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
14604 mail spool while moving the mail.
14605
14606 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
14607
14608 @lisp
14609 (setq mail-sources
14610 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
14611 @end lisp
14612
14613 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
14614
14615 @example
14616 #!/bin/sh
14617 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
14618 # flu@@iki.fi
14619
14620 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
14621 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
14622 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
14623 @end example
14624
14625 Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
14626 file you want to use.
14627
14628
14629 @item directory
14630 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
14631 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
14632 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
14633 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
14634 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
14635 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
14636 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
14637 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
14638 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
14639 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
14640
14641 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14642 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
14643 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
14644 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
14645
14646 Keywords:
14647
14648 @table @code
14649 @item :path
14650 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
14651 value.
14652
14653 @item :suffix
14654 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
14655 @samp{.spool}.
14656
14657 @item :predicate
14658 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
14659 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
14660 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
14661 predicate are considered.
14662
14663 @item :prescript
14664 @itemx :postscript
14665 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14666
14667 @end table
14668
14669 An example directory mail source:
14670
14671 @lisp
14672 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
14673 :suffix ".prcml")
14674 @end lisp
14675
14676 @item pop
14677 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14678
14679 Keywords:
14680
14681 @table @code
14682 @item :server
14683 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
14684 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14685
14686 @item :port
14687 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
14688 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
14689 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
14690 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
14691 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
14692
14693 @item :user
14694 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
14695 name.
14696
14697 @item :password
14698 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
14699 the user is prompted.
14700
14701 @item :program
14702 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
14703 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
14704
14705 @example
14706 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
14707 @end example
14708
14709 The valid format specifier characters are:
14710
14711 @table @samp
14712 @item t
14713 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
14714 included in this string.
14715
14716 @item s
14717 The name of the server.
14718
14719 @item P
14720 The port number of the server.
14721
14722 @item u
14723 The user name to use.
14724
14725 @item p
14726 The password to use.
14727 @end table
14728
14729 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14730 corresponding keywords.
14731
14732 @item :prescript
14733 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14734 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14735
14736 One popular way to use this is to set up an SSH tunnel to access the
14737 @acronym{POP} server. Here's an example:
14738
14739 @lisp
14740 (pop :server "127.0.0.1"
14741 :port 1234
14742 :user "foo"
14743 :password "secret"
14744 :prescript
14745 "nohup ssh -f -L 1234:pop.server:110 remote.host sleep 3600 &")
14746 @end lisp
14747
14748 @item :postscript
14749 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14750 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14751
14752 @item :function
14753 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
14754 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
14755 mail should be moved to.
14756
14757 @item :authentication
14758 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
14759 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
14760 @code{password}.
14761
14762 @end table
14763
14764 @vindex pop3-movemail
14765 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
14766 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
14767 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server}
14768 is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
14769 after fetching when using @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers
14770 maintain no state information between sessions, so what the client
14771 believes is there and what is actually there may not match up. If they
14772 do not, then you may get duplicate mails or the whole thing can fall
14773 apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
14774
14775 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14776 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
14777 name, and default fetcher:
14778
14779 @lisp
14780 (pop)
14781 @end lisp
14782
14783 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
14784
14785 @lisp
14786 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14787 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
14788 @end lisp
14789
14790 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
14791
14792 @lisp
14793 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
14794 @end lisp
14795
14796 @item maildir
14797 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
14798 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
14799 contains exactly one mail.
14800
14801 Keywords:
14802
14803 @table @code
14804 @item :path
14805 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
14806 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
14807 @file{~/Maildir/}.
14808 @item :subdirs
14809 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
14810 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
14811
14812 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
14813 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
14814 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
14815 @c below.
14816
14817 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
14818 from locking problems).
14819
14820 @end table
14821
14822 Two example maildir mail sources:
14823
14824 @lisp
14825 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
14826 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
14827 @end lisp
14828
14829 @lisp
14830 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
14831 :subdirs ("new"))
14832 @end lisp
14833
14834 @item imap
14835 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
14836 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
14837 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
14838 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
14839 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{Using IMAP}, for more information.
14840
14841 Keywords:
14842
14843 @table @code
14844 @item :server
14845 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
14846 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14847
14848 @item :port
14849 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
14850 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14851
14852 @item :user
14853 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
14854 name.
14855
14856 @item :password
14857 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
14858 prompted.
14859
14860 @item :stream
14861 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
14862 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
14863 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
14864 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
14865
14866 @item :authentication
14867 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
14868 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
14869 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
14870 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
14871
14872 @item :program
14873 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
14874 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
14875 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
14876
14877 @example
14878 ssh %s imapd
14879 @end example
14880
14881 Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
14882 don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
14883 specifier characters are:
14884
14885 @table @samp
14886 @item s
14887 The name of the server.
14888
14889 @item l
14890 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
14891
14892 @item p
14893 The port number of the server.
14894 @end table
14895
14896 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14897 corresponding keywords.
14898
14899 @item :mailbox
14900 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
14901 which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail.
14902
14903 @item :predicate
14904 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
14905 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
14906 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
14907 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
14908 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
14909 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
14910
14911 @item :fetchflag
14912 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
14913 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
14914 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
14915 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
14916
14917 @item :dontexpunge
14918 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
14919 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
14920
14921 @end table
14922
14923 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
14924
14925 @lisp
14926 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
14927 :stream kerberos4
14928 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
14929 @end lisp
14930
14931 @item group
14932 Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
14933 @xref{Group Parameters}.
14934
14935 @end table
14936
14937 @table @dfn
14938 @item Common Keywords
14939 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
14940
14941 Keywords:
14942
14943 @table @code
14944 @item :plugged
14945 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
14946 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
14947 example:
14948
14949 @lisp
14950 (setq mail-sources
14951 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
14952 :suffix ""
14953 :plugged t)))
14954 @end lisp
14955
14956 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
14957 useful when you use local mail and news.
14958
14959 @end table
14960 @end table
14961
14962 @subsubsection Function Interface
14963
14964 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
14965 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
14966 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
14967 consider the following mail-source setting:
14968
14969 @lisp
14970 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
14971 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
14972 @end lisp
14973
14974 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
14975 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
14976 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
14977 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
14978 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
14979
14980 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
14981
14982
14983 @node Mail Source Customization
14984 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
14985
14986 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
14987 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
14988 variables.
14989
14990 @table @code
14991 @item mail-source-crash-box
14992 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
14993 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
14994 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
14995
14996 @cindex Incoming*
14997 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
14998 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
14999 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
15000 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15001 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
15002 (the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15003 set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
15004 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
15005 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{10} in alpha Gnusae
15006 and @code{2} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
15007
15008 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15009 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15010 If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15011 files. This variable only applies when
15012 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
15013
15014 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
15015 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15016 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15017
15018 @item mail-source-directory
15019 @vindex mail-source-directory
15020 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15021 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15022 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15023 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
15024
15025 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15026 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15027 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15028 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15029 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15030 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15031 number.
15032
15033 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
15034 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
15035 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is @code{#o600}.
15036
15037 @item mail-source-movemail-program
15038 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15039 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15040 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
15041
15042 @end table
15043
15044
15045 @node Fetching Mail
15046 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
15047
15048 @vindex mail-sources
15049 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15050 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15051 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
15052
15053 If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15054 fetch mail by themselves.
15055
15056 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15057 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
15058
15059 @lisp
15060 (setq mail-sources
15061 '((file)
15062 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15063 :password "secret")))
15064 @end lisp
15065
15066 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
15067
15068 @lisp
15069 (setq mail-sources
15070 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15071 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15072 :user "user-name"
15073 :port "pop3"
15074 :password "secret")))
15075 @end lisp
15076
15077
15078 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15079 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15080 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15081 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15082 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15083 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
15084
15085
15086
15087 @node Mail Back End Variables
15088 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
15089
15090 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15091 mail back ends.
15092
15093 @table @code
15094 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15095 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15096 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15097 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
15098
15099 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
15100 @item nnmail-split-hook
15101 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15102 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15103 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15104 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15105 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15106 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15107 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15108 in the buffer will show up in any files.
15109 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15110 to this hook.
15111
15112 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15113 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15114 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15115 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15116 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15117 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15118 starting to handle the new mail) and
15119 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15120 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15121 default file modes the new mail files get:
15122
15123 @lisp
15124 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15125 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o700)))
15126
15127 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15128 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o775)))
15129 @end lisp
15130
15131 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15132 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15133 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15134 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15135 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15136 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15137 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
15138
15139 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
15140 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15141 @findex delete-file
15142 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
15143
15144 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15145 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15146 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15147 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15148 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
15149
15150 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15151 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15152 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15153 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15154 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
15155
15156 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15157 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15158 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
15159
15160 @end table
15161
15162
15163 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
15164 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15165 @cindex mail splitting
15166 @cindex fancy mail splitting
15167
15168 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15169 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
15170 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15171 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15172 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15173 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15174
15175 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15176
15177 @lisp
15178 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15179 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15180 ;; @r{from real errors.}
15181 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15182 "mail.misc"))
15183 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15184 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15185 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15186 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15187 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15188 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15189 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15190 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15191 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15192 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15193 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15194 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15195 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15196 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15197 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15198 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15199 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15200 "misc.misc")
15201 @end lisp
15202
15203 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15204 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15205 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
15206
15207 @table @code
15208
15209 @item group
15210 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15211 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
15212
15213 @c Don't fold this line.
15214 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15215 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15216 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15217 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15218 @var{split}.
15219
15220 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15221 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15222 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15223 @var{split} is processed.
15224
15225 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15226 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15227 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15228 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15229
15230 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15231 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15232 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15233 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15234 stored in one or more groups.
15235
15236 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15237 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15238 process all @var{split}s in the list.
15239
15240 @item junk
15241 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15242 this message. Use with extreme caution.
15243
15244 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15245 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15246 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15247 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
15248
15249 @cindex body split
15250 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15251 body of the messages:
15252
15253 @lisp
15254 (defun split-on-body ()
15255 (save-excursion
15256 (save-restriction
15257 (widen)
15258 (goto-char (point-min))
15259 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15260 "string.group"))))
15261 @end lisp
15262
15263 The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15264 @var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15265 after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
15266 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
15267 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15268 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15269 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
15270
15271 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15272 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15273 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15274 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15275 should return a split.
15276
15277 @item nil
15278 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
15279
15280 @end table
15281
15282 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
15283
15284 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15285 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15286 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15287 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15288 for example,
15289
15290 @example
15291 (any "joe" "joemail")
15292 @end example
15293
15294 @noindent
15295 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15296 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15297 of the following three ways:
15298
15299 @enumerate
15300 @item
15301 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15302 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15303 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15304 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15305 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15306 @code{nil}.
15307
15308 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
15309
15310 @item
15311 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15312 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15313 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15314 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15315 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
15316
15317 @item
15318 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15319 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15320 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15321 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15322 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15323 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15324 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15325 @end enumerate
15326
15327 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15328 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15329 they are expanded as specified by the variable
15330 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15331 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15332 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15333 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
15334
15335 @table @code
15336 @item from
15337 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15338 @item to
15339 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15340 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15341 @item any
15342 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
15343 @end table
15344
15345 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15346 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15347 when all this splitting is performed.
15348
15349 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15350 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15351 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
15352
15353 @example
15354 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15355 @end example
15356
15357 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15358 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
15359
15360 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
15361 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15362 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15363 groupings 1 through 9.
15364
15365 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15366 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15367 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15368 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15369 groups when users send to an address using different case
15370 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
15371 is @code{t}.
15372
15373 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15374 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15375 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15376 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15377 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15378 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15379 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15380 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15381 it once per thread.
15382
15383 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15384 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15385 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15386 using the colon feature, like so:
15387 @lisp
15388 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15389 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15390 nnmail-split-fancy
15391 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15392 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15393 ))
15394 @end lisp
15395
15396 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15397 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15398 in the file specified by the variable
15399 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15400 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15401 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15402 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15403 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15404 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15405 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15406 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15407 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15408 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15409 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15410 300 kBytes in size.)
15411 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15412 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15413 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15414 messages goes into the new group.
15415
15416 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15417 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15418 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15419 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15420 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15421 ``outgoing'' group.
15422
15423
15424 @node Group Mail Splitting
15425 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
15426 @cindex mail splitting
15427 @cindex group mail splitting
15428
15429 @findex gnus-group-split
15430 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15431 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15432 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15433 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15434 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15435 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15436 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15437 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
15438
15439 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15440 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15441 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15442 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
15443
15444 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15445 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15446 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15447 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15448 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15449 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15450 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
15451
15452 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15453 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15454 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15455 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15456 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15457 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15458 @code{gnus-group-split}.
15459
15460 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15461 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15462 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15463 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15464 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15465 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15466 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15467 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15468 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15469 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15470 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15471 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15472 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
15473
15474 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15475 been defined:
15476
15477 @example
15478 nnml:mail.bar:
15479 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15480 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15481 nnml:mail.foo:
15482 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15483 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15484 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15485 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15486 nnml:mail.others:
15487 ((split-spec . catch-all))
15488 @end example
15489
15490 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15491 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15492 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
15493
15494 @lisp
15495 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15496 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15497 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15498 "mail.others")
15499 @end lisp
15500
15501 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15502 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15503 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15504 splits like this:
15505
15506 @lisp
15507 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
15508 @end lisp
15509
15510 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
15511 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
15512 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
15513 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
15514 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
15515 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
15516 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
15517 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
15518 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
15519
15520 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
15521 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
15522 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
15523 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
15524 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
15525 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
15526 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
15527 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
15528 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
15529
15530 @findex gnus-group-split-update
15531 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
15532 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
15533 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
15534 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
15535 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
15536
15537 @lisp
15538 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
15539 @end lisp
15540
15541 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
15542 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
15543 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
15544 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
15545 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
15546 value.
15547
15548 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
15549 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
15550 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
15551 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
15552
15553 @node Incorporating Old Mail
15554 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
15555 @cindex incorporating old mail
15556 @cindex import old mail
15557
15558 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
15559 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
15560 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
15561 your mail groups.
15562
15563 Doing so can be quite easy.
15564
15565 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
15566 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
15567 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
15568 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
15569 your @code{nnml} groups.
15570
15571 Here's how:
15572
15573 @enumerate
15574 @item
15575 Go to the group buffer.
15576
15577 @item
15578 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
15579 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15580
15581 @item
15582 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
15583
15584 @item
15585 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
15586 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
15587
15588 @item
15589 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
15590 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
15591 @end enumerate
15592
15593 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
15594 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
15595 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
15596 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
15597 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
15598
15599 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
15600 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
15601 using the new mail back end.
15602
15603
15604 @node Expiring Mail
15605 @subsection Expiring Mail
15606 @cindex article expiry
15607 @cindex expiring mail
15608
15609 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
15610 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
15611 different approach to mail reading.
15612
15613 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
15614 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
15615 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
15616 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
15617 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
15618 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
15619 course.
15620
15621 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
15622 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
15623 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
15624 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
15625 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
15626 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
15627 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
15628 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
15629 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
15630
15631 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-marks
15632 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
15633 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
15634 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
15635 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
15636 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
15637 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
15638 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} (and so on) are considered
15639 expirable. @code{gnus-auto-expirable-marks} has the full list of
15640 these marks.
15641
15642 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
15643 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
15644 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
15645 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
15646 into its own group.)
15647
15648 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
15649 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
15650 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
15651 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
15652 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
15653 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
15654 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
15655 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
15656 scoring.
15657
15658 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15659 Groups that match the regular expression
15660 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
15661 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
15662 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
15663
15664 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
15665 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
15666 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
15667 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
15668 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15669
15670 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
15671 @lisp
15672 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
15673 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
15674 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
15675 @end lisp
15676
15677 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
15678 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
15679 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
15680 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
15681 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
15682
15683 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
15684 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
15685
15686 @lisp
15687 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15688 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
15689 @end lisp
15690
15691 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
15692 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
15693
15694 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
15695 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
15696 don't really mix very well.
15697
15698 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
15699 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
15700 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
15701 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
15702 days.
15703
15704 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
15705 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
15706 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
15707 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
15708 everywhere else:
15709
15710 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15711 @lisp
15712 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15713 (lambda (group)
15714 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
15715 31)
15716 ((string= group "mail.junk")
15717 1)
15718 ((string= group "important")
15719 'never)
15720 (t
15721 6))))
15722 @end lisp
15723
15724 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
15725 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
15726
15727 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
15728 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
15729 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
15730 @code{never}.
15731
15732 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
15733 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
15734
15735 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
15736 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
15737 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
15738 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
15739 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
15740 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
15741 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
15742 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
15743 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
15744 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
15745 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
15746 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
15747 name or @code{delete}.
15748
15749 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
15750 @lisp
15751 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
15752 @end lisp
15753
15754 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15755 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15756 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
15757 expire mail to groups according to the variable
15758 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
15759
15760 @lisp
15761 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15762 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15763 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
15764 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
15765 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
15766 @end lisp
15767
15768 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
15769 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
15770 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
15771 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
15772 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
15773 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
15774
15775 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
15776 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
15777 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
15778 easier for procmail users.
15779
15780 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
15781 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
15782 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
15783 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
15784 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
15785 caution. Even more dangerous is the
15786 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
15787 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
15788 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
15789 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
15790 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
15791 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
15792 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
15793 with! So there!
15794
15795 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
15796
15797 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
15798 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
15799 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
15800 auto-expire turned on.
15801
15802 @vindex gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable
15803 The expirable marks of articles will be removed when copying or moving
15804 them to a group in which auto-expire is not turned on. This is for
15805 preventing articles from being expired unintentionally. On the other
15806 hand, to a group that has turned auto-expire on, the expirable marks of
15807 articles that are copied or moved will not be changed by default. I.e.,
15808 when copying or moving to such a group, articles that were expirable
15809 will be left expirable and ones that were not expirable will not be
15810 marked as expirable. So, even though in auto-expire groups, some
15811 articles will never get expired (unless you read them again). If you
15812 don't side with that behavior that unexpirable articles may be mixed
15813 into auto-expire groups, you can set
15814 @code{gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable} to a
15815 non-@code{nil} value. In that case, articles that have been read will
15816 be marked as expirable automatically when being copied or moved to a
15817 group that has auto-expire turned on. The default value is @code{nil}.
15818
15819
15820 @node Washing Mail
15821 @subsection Washing Mail
15822 @cindex mail washing
15823 @cindex list server brain damage
15824 @cindex incoming mail treatment
15825
15826 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
15827 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
15828 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
15829 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
15830 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
15831 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
15832
15833 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
15834 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
15835 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
15836 laugh.
15837
15838 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
15839 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
15840 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
15841 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
15842
15843 @table @code
15844 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15845 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15846 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
15847 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
15848 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
15849
15850 @table @code
15851 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15852 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15853 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
15854 Emacs running on MS machines.
15855
15856 @end table
15857
15858 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15859 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15860 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
15861 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
15862
15863 @table @code
15864 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15865 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15866 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
15867 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
15868
15869 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
15870 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
15871 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
15872 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
15873 into a feature by documenting it.)
15874
15875 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15876 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15877 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
15878 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
15879 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
15880 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
15881 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
15882 @code{\\(..\\)}.
15883
15884 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
15885 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
15886
15887 @lisp
15888 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
15889 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
15890 @end lisp
15891
15892 This can also be done non-destructively with
15893 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
15894
15895 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
15896 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
15897 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
15898
15899 @item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15900 @findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15901 @c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
15902 @cindex Eudora
15903 @cindex Pegasus
15904 Some mail user agents (e.g. Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
15905 @code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
15906 function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
15907 contain a line matching the regular expression
15908 @code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
15909
15910 @end table
15911
15912 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15913 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15914 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
15915 include:
15916
15917 @table @code
15918 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
15919 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
15920 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
15921
15922 @end table
15923 @end table
15924
15925
15926 @node Duplicates
15927 @subsection Duplicates
15928
15929 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
15930 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
15931 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
15932 @cindex duplicate mails
15933 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
15934 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
15935 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
15936 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
15937 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
15938 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
15939 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
15940 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
15941 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
15942 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
15943 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
15944 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
15945 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
15946
15947 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
15948 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
15949 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
15950 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
15951
15952 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
15953 @code{nil}.
15954
15955 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
15956 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
15957 methods:
15958
15959 @lisp
15960 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
15961 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
15962 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
15963 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
15964 (any mail "mail.misc")
15965 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15966 [...] ))
15967 @end lisp
15968 @noindent
15969 Or something like:
15970 @lisp
15971 (setq nnmail-split-methods
15972 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
15973 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15974 [...]))
15975 @end lisp
15976
15977 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
15978 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
15979 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
15980 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
15981 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
15982
15983
15984 @node Not Reading Mail
15985 @subsection Not Reading Mail
15986
15987 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
15988 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
15989 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
15990
15991 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
15992 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
15993 mail, which should help.
15994
15995 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15996 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
15997 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
15998 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15999 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16000 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
16001 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old (pre-Emacs
16002 23) Rmail file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
16003 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16004 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16005 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
16006
16007 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16008 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16009 incoming mail.
16010
16011
16012 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
16013 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
16014
16015 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16016 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16017 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
16018
16019 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16020 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16021 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16022 Spool}).
16023
16024 @menu
16025 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
16026 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
16027 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16028 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16029 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
16030 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16031 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16032 @end menu
16033
16034
16035
16036 @node Unix Mail Box
16037 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16038 @cindex nnmbox
16039 @cindex unix mail box
16040
16041 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16042 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16043 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16044 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16045 which group it belongs in.
16046
16047 Virtual server settings:
16048
16049 @table @code
16050 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
16051 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16052 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16053 @file{~/mbox}.
16054
16055 @item nnmbox-active-file
16056 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16057 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16058 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
16059
16060 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16061 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16062 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16063 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16064 @end table
16065
16066
16067 @node Babyl
16068 @subsubsection Babyl
16069 @cindex nnbabyl
16070
16071 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16072 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16073 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box to store mail.
16074 @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each mail article to say which
16075 group it belongs in.
16076
16077 Virtual server settings:
16078
16079 @table @code
16080 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16081 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16082 The name of the Babyl file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
16083
16084 @item nnbabyl-active-file
16085 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16086 The name of the active file for the Babyl file. The default is
16087 @file{~/.rmail-active}
16088
16089 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16090 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16091 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16092 @code{t}
16093 @end table
16094
16095
16096 @node Mail Spool
16097 @subsubsection Mail Spool
16098 @cindex nnml
16099 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16100
16101 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16102 format. It should be used with some caution.
16103
16104 @vindex nnml-directory
16105 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16106 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16107 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16108 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16109
16110 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16111 care of all that.
16112
16113 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16114 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16115 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16116 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16117 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16118 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16119 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16120 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
16121
16122 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16123 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16124 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16125 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
16126
16127 Virtual server settings:
16128
16129 @table @code
16130 @item nnml-directory
16131 @vindex nnml-directory
16132 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16133 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16134 is @file{~/Mail}).
16135
16136 @item nnml-active-file
16137 @vindex nnml-active-file
16138 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16139 @file{~/Mail/active}.
16140
16141 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
16142 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16143 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16144 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
16145
16146 @item nnml-get-new-mail
16147 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16148 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16149 @code{t}.
16150
16151 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
16152 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16153 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16154 default is @code{nil}.
16155
16156 @item nnml-nov-file-name
16157 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16158 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
16159
16160 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16161 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16162 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
16163
16164 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
16165 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16166 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
16167 files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16168 (@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16169 If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16170 as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16171 to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16172 equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
16173
16174 @item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16175 @vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16176 Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16177 bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16178 if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
16179
16180 @end table
16181
16182 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16183 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16184 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16185 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16186 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16187 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16188 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16189 Commands}).
16190
16191
16192 @node MH Spool
16193 @subsubsection MH Spool
16194 @cindex nnmh
16195 @cindex mh-e mail spool
16196
16197 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16198 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16199 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16200 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16201 for.
16202
16203 Virtual server settings:
16204
16205 @table @code
16206 @item nnmh-directory
16207 @vindex nnmh-directory
16208 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16209 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16210 @file{~/Mail})
16211
16212 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
16213 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16214 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16215 @code{t}.
16216
16217 @item nnmh-be-safe
16218 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
16219 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16220 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16221 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16222 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16223 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16224 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16225 @end table
16226
16227
16228 @node Maildir
16229 @subsubsection Maildir
16230 @cindex nnmaildir
16231 @cindex maildir
16232
16233 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16234 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16235 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16236 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16237 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16238 within a maildir.
16239
16240 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16241 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16242 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16243 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16244 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16245 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16246 that appear as group in Gnus.
16247
16248 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16249 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16250 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
16251
16252 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16253 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16254 another, and you will keep your marks.
16255
16256 Virtual server settings:
16257
16258 @table @code
16259 @item directory
16260 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16261 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16262 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16263 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16264 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16265 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16266 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16267 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16268 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16269 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
16270
16271 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16272 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16273 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16274 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16275 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16276 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16277 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16278 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16279 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16280 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16281 value.
16282
16283 @item target-prefix
16284 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16285 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16286 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16287 closed.
16288
16289 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16290 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16291 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16292 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16293 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16294 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16295 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16296 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16297 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
16298
16299 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16300 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16301 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16302 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16303 symlinks pointing to them will be).
16304
16305 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16306 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16307 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16308 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16309 @code{force} argument.
16310
16311 @item directory-files
16312 This should be a function with the same interface as
16313 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16314 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16315 parameter is optional; the default is
16316 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16317 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16318 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
16319 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16320 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16321 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
16322
16323 @item get-new-mail
16324 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16325 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16326 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16327 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16328 value is @code{nil}.
16329
16330 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16331 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16332 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16333 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16334 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16335 @end table
16336
16337 @subsubsection Group parameters
16338
16339 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16340 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16341 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16342 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16343 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16344 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16345 another back end.
16346
16347 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16348 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16349 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16350 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16351 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16352 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16353 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16354 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16355 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
16356
16357 @table @code
16358 @item expire-age
16359 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16360 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16361 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16362 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16363 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16364 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16365 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16366 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
16367 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16368 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16369 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16370 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16371 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
16372
16373 @item expire-group
16374 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16375 @example
16376 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16377 @end example
16378 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16379 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16380 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16381 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16382 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16383 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16384 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16385 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16386 article. So that form can refer to
16387 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16388 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16389 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16390 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
16391
16392 @item read-only
16393 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16394 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16395 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16396 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16397 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16398 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16399 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16400 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16401 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16402 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16403 contain extra copies of the articles.
16404
16405 @item directory-files
16406 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16407 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16408 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16409 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
16410
16411 @item distrust-Lines:
16412 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16413 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16414 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
16415
16416 @item always-marks
16417 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16418 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16419 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16420 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16421 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16422 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16423
16424 @item never-marks
16425 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16426 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16427 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16428 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16429 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16430 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16431 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16432
16433 @item nov-cache-size
16434 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16435 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16436 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16437 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16438 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16439 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16440 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16441 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16442 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16443 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16444 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
16445 @end table
16446
16447 @subsubsection Article identification
16448 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16449 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16450 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16451 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16452 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16453 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16454 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16455 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16456 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16457 request the article in the summary buffer.
16458
16459 @subsubsection NOV data
16460 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16461 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16462 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16463 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16464 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16465 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16466 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16467 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16468 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16469 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16470 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
16471
16472 @subsubsection Article marks
16473 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16474 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16475 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16476 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16477 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16478 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16479 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16480 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
16481
16482 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16483 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16484 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16485 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16486 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16487 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16488 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16489 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16490 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
16491
16492
16493 @node Mail Folders
16494 @subsubsection Mail Folders
16495 @cindex nnfolder
16496 @cindex mbox folders
16497 @cindex mail folders
16498
16499 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
16500 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
16501 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
16502 numbers and arrival dates.
16503
16504 Virtual server settings:
16505
16506 @table @code
16507 @item nnfolder-directory
16508 @vindex nnfolder-directory
16509 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
16510 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
16511 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
16512
16513 @item nnfolder-active-file
16514 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
16515 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
16516
16517 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16518 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16519 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16520 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
16521
16522 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
16523 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16524 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
16525 default is @code{t}
16526
16527 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16528 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16529 @cindex backup files
16530 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
16531 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
16532 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
16533 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
16534
16535 @lisp
16536 (defun turn-off-backup ()
16537 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
16538
16539 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
16540 @end lisp
16541
16542 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16543 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16544 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
16545 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
16546 extract some information from it before removing it.
16547
16548 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16549 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16550 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16551 default is @code{nil}.
16552
16553 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16554 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16555 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
16556
16557 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
16558 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
16559 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
16560 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16561
16562 @end table
16563
16564
16565 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
16566 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
16567 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
16568 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
16569 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
16570 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
16571 though.
16572
16573 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
16574 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
16575
16576 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
16577 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
16578 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
16579 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
16580 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
16581
16582 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
16583 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
16584 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
16585 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
16586 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
16587 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
16588 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
16589 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
16590 via NFS).
16591
16592 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
16593 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
16594 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
16595 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
16596
16597 @table @code
16598 @item nnmbox
16599
16600 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
16601 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
16602 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
16603 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
16604 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
16605 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
16606 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
16607 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
16608 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
16609 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
16610 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
16611 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
16612 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
16613 what's where.
16614
16615 @item nnbabyl
16616
16617 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
16618 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
16619 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
16620 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
16621 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
16622 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
16623 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
16624 Rmail was Emacs's first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
16625 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
16626 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
16627 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
16628 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
16629 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
16630 course, and is still maintained within Emacs. Since Emacs 23, it
16631 uses standard mbox format rather than Babyl.
16632
16633 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
16634 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
16635 look at your mail.
16636
16637 @item nnml
16638
16639 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
16640 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
16641 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
16642 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
16643 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
16644 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
16645 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
16646 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
16647 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
16648 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
16649 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
16650 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
16651 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
16652 provided by the active file and overviews.
16653
16654 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
16655 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
16656 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
16657 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
16658 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
16659 wins big.
16660
16661 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
16662 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
16663 tiny files.
16664
16665 @item nnmh
16666
16667 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
16668 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
16669 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
16670 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
16671 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
16672 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
16673 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
16674
16675 @item nnfolder
16676
16677 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
16678 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
16679 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
16680 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
16681 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
16682 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
16683 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
16684 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
16685 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
16686
16687 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
16688 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
16689 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
16690 friendly mail back end all over.
16691
16692 @item nnmaildir
16693
16694 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
16695 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
16696 mail back ends.
16697
16698 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
16699 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
16700 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
16701 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
16702 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}.
16703 (Use @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this
16704 slows you down or takes up very much space, a non-block-structured
16705 file system.
16706
16707 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
16708 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
16709 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
16710 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
16711 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
16712 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
16713 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
16714 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
16715 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
16716 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
16717 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
16718
16719 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
16720 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
16721 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
16722 else, and still have your marks.
16723
16724 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
16725 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
16726 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
16727 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
16728 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
16729 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
16730 removed in the future.
16731
16732 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
16733 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
16734 on your file system.
16735
16736 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
16737 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
16738
16739 @end table
16740
16741
16742 @node Browsing the Web
16743 @section Browsing the Web
16744 @cindex web
16745 @cindex browsing the web
16746 @cindex www
16747 @cindex http
16748
16749 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
16750 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
16751 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
16752 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
16753 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
16754 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
16755 even know what a news group is.
16756
16757 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
16758 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
16759 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
16760 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
16761 you mad in the end.
16762
16763 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
16764 to do it instead?
16765
16766 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
16767 interfaces to these sources.
16768
16769 @menu
16770 * Archiving Mail::
16771 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
16772 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
16773 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
16774 @end menu
16775
16776 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
16777 alternatives to work.
16778
16779 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
16780 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
16781 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
16782 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
16783 though, you should be ok.
16784
16785 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
16786 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
16787 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
16788 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
16789 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
16790
16791 @node Archiving Mail
16792 @subsection Archiving Mail
16793 @cindex archiving mail
16794 @cindex backup of mail
16795
16796 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
16797 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
16798 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
16799 marks is fairly simple.
16800
16801 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
16802 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
16803 though.)
16804
16805 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
16806 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
16807 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
16808 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
16809 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
16810 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
16811 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
16812 before you restore the data.
16813
16814 @node Web Searches
16815 @subsection Web Searches
16816 @cindex nnweb
16817 @cindex Google
16818 @cindex dejanews
16819 @cindex gmane
16820 @cindex Usenet searches
16821 @cindex searching the Usenet
16822
16823 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
16824 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
16825 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
16826 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
16827 searches without having to use a browser.
16828
16829 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
16830 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
16831 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
16832 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
16833 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
16834
16835 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
16836 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
16837 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
16838 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
16839 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
16840 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
16841 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
16842 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
16843 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
16844 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
16845 group as read.
16846
16847 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
16848 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
16849 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'@^etre} is to
16850 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
16851 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
16852 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
16853
16854 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
16855 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
16856 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
16857
16858 Virtual server variables:
16859
16860 @table @code
16861 @item nnweb-type
16862 @vindex nnweb-type
16863 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
16864 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
16865 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
16866
16867 @item nnweb-search
16868 @vindex nnweb-search
16869 The search string to feed to the search engine.
16870
16871 @item nnweb-max-hits
16872 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
16873 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
16874 999.
16875
16876 @item nnweb-type-definition
16877 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
16878 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
16879 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
16880 present:
16881
16882 @table @code
16883 @item article
16884 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
16885 understands.
16886
16887 @item map
16888 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
16889
16890 @item search
16891 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
16892
16893 @item address
16894 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
16895 to.
16896
16897 @item id
16898 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
16899 @end table
16900
16901 @end table
16902
16903
16904 @node RSS
16905 @subsection RSS
16906 @cindex nnrss
16907 @cindex RSS
16908
16909 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16910 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16911 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16912 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
16913 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
16914
16915 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16916 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16917
16918 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16919 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16920 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16921 group names.
16922
16923 @kindex G R (Group)
16924 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16925 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16926 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16927 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
16928
16929 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16930 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16931 subscribe to groups.
16932
16933 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
16934 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
16935 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
16936 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
16937 variable or other. Also @xref{Non-ASCII Group Names}, for more
16938 information.
16939
16940 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
16941 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
16942 and a @samp{text/html} part.
16943
16944 @cindex OPML
16945 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
16946 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
16947 Markup Language).
16948
16949 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
16950 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
16951 file.
16952 @end defun
16953
16954 @defun nnrss-opml-export
16955 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
16956 @acronym{OPML} format.
16957 @end defun
16958
16959 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
16960
16961 @table @code
16962 @item nnrss-directory
16963 @vindex nnrss-directory
16964 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
16965 @file{~/News/rss/}.
16966
16967 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
16968 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
16969 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
16970 data files. The default is the value of
16971 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
16972 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
16973
16974 @item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
16975 @vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
16976 Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
16977 e.g. to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
16978 a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
16979 is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
16980 variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
16981 @code{'(slash:comments)}.
16982
16983 @item nnrss-use-local
16984 @vindex nnrss-use-local
16985 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
16986 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
16987 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
16988 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
16989 download script using @command{wget}.
16990 @end table
16991
16992 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
16993 the summary buffer.
16994
16995 @lisp
16996 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
16997 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
16998
16999 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
17000 (let ((descr
17001 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17002 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17003 @end lisp
17004
17005 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17006 summary buffer.
17007
17008 @lisp
17009 (require 'browse-url)
17010
17011 (defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
17012 (interactive "p")
17013 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17014 (mail-header-extra
17015 (gnus-data-header
17016 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17017 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17018 (if url
17019 (progn
17020 (browse-url (cdr url))
17021 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17022 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
17023
17024 (eval-after-load "gnus"
17025 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17026 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17027 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17028 @end lisp
17029
17030 Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
17031 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17032 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17033 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17034 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17035 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17036 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17037 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17038 @code{nnrss} groups:
17039
17040 @lisp
17041 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17042 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17043 '(add-to-list
17044 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17045 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17046 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
17047
17048 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17049 (add-to-list
17050 'gnus-parameters
17051 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17052 @end lisp
17053
17054
17055 @node Customizing W3
17056 @subsection Customizing W3
17057 @cindex W3
17058 @cindex html
17059 @cindex url
17060 @cindex Netscape
17061
17062 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
17063 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
17064 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
17065 users.
17066
17067 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
17068 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
17069 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
17070
17071 @lisp
17072 (eval-after-load "w3"
17073 '(progn
17074 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
17075 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
17076 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
17077 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
17078 (browse-url url)
17079 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
17080 @end lisp
17081
17082 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
17083 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
17084 follow the link.
17085
17086
17087 @node Other Sources
17088 @section Other Sources
17089
17090 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17091 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17092 newsgroups.
17093
17094 @menu
17095 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17096 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17097 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17098 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
17099 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
17100 @end menu
17101
17102
17103 @node Directory Groups
17104 @subsection Directory Groups
17105 @cindex nndir
17106 @cindex directory groups
17107
17108 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17109 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17110 names, of course.
17111
17112 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17113 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17114 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17115 back end to read directories. Big deal.
17116
17117 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17118 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17119 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17120 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17121 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17122
17123 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17124
17125 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17126 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17127 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17128 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17129
17130
17131 @node Anything Groups
17132 @subsection Anything Groups
17133 @cindex nneething
17134
17135 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17136 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17137 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17138 true.
17139
17140 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17141 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17142 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17143 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17144 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17145 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17146 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17147 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
17148 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17149 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17150 elements.
17151
17152 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17153 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17154 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17155 in the article buffer, just as usual.
17156
17157 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17158 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17159 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17160 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17161
17162 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17163 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17164 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17165 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17166 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17167 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17168 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17169 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17170
17171 Some variables:
17172
17173 @table @code
17174 @item nneething-map-file-directory
17175 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17176 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17177 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17178
17179 @item nneething-exclude-files
17180 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
17181 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17182 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17183
17184 @item nneething-include-files
17185 @vindex nneething-include-files
17186 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17187 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17188
17189 @item nneething-map-file
17190 @vindex nneething-map-file
17191 Name of the map files.
17192 @end table
17193
17194
17195 @node Document Groups
17196 @subsection Document Groups
17197 @cindex nndoc
17198 @cindex documentation group
17199 @cindex help group
17200
17201 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17202 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17203
17204 @table @code
17205 @cindex Babyl
17206 @item babyl
17207 The Babyl format.
17208
17209 @cindex mbox
17210 @cindex Unix mbox
17211 @item mbox
17212 The standard Unix mbox file.
17213
17214 @cindex MMDF mail box
17215 @item mmdf
17216 The MMDF mail box format.
17217
17218 @item news
17219 Several news articles appended into a file.
17220
17221 @cindex rnews batch files
17222 @item rnews
17223 The rnews batch transport format.
17224
17225 @item nsmail
17226 Netscape mail boxes.
17227
17228 @item mime-parts
17229 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17230
17231 @item standard-digest
17232 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17233
17234 @item mime-digest
17235 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17236
17237 @item lanl-gov-announce
17238 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17239
17240 @cindex git commit messages
17241 @item git
17242 @code{git} commit messages.
17243
17244 @cindex forwarded messages
17245 @item rfc822-forward
17246 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17247
17248 @item outlook
17249 The Outlook mail box.
17250
17251 @item oe-dbx
17252 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17253
17254 @item exim-bounce
17255 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17256
17257 @item forward
17258 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17259
17260 @item rfc934
17261 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17262
17263 @item mailman
17264 A mailman digest.
17265
17266 @item clari-briefs
17267 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17268
17269 @item slack-digest
17270 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17271
17272 @item mail-in-mail
17273 The last resort.
17274 @end table
17275
17276 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17277 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17278 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17279 file is.
17280
17281 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17282 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17283 group. And that's it.
17284
17285 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17286 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17287 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17288 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17289 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17290 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17291 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17292 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17293 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17294 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17295
17296 Virtual server variables:
17297
17298 @table @code
17299 @item nndoc-article-type
17300 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17301 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17302 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17303 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17304 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17305 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17306
17307 @item nndoc-post-type
17308 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17309 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17310 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17311 and @code{news}.
17312 @end table
17313
17314 @menu
17315 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17316 @end menu
17317
17318
17319 @node Document Server Internals
17320 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17321
17322 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17323 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17324 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17325 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17326
17327 First, here's an example document type definition:
17328
17329 @example
17330 (mmdf
17331 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17332 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17333 @end example
17334
17335 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17336 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17337 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17338 types can be defined with very few settings:
17339
17340 @table @code
17341 @item first-article
17342 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17343 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17344 totally ignored.
17345
17346 @item article-begin
17347 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17348 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17349 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17350 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17351
17352 @item article-begin-function
17353 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17354 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17355
17356 @item head-begin
17357 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17358 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17359 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17360
17361 @item head-begin-function
17362 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17363 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17364
17365 @item head-end
17366 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17367 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17368
17369 @item body-begin
17370 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17371 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17372 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17373
17374 @item body-begin-function
17375 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17376 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17377
17378 @item body-end
17379 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17380 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17381 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17382
17383 @item body-end-function
17384 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17385 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17386
17387 @item file-begin
17388 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17389 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17390
17391 @item file-end
17392 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17393 regexp will be totally ignored.
17394
17395 @end table
17396
17397 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17398 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17399 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17400 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17401 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17402
17403 @table @code
17404 @item prepare-body-function
17405 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17406 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17407 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17408
17409 @item article-transform-function
17410 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17411 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17412 body of the article.
17413
17414 @item generate-head-function
17415 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17416 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17417 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17418 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17419
17420 @item generate-article-function
17421 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17422 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17423 parameter when requesting all articles.
17424
17425 @item dissection-function
17426 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17427 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17428 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17429 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17430 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17431 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17432
17433 @end table
17434
17435 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17436 digests:
17437
17438 @example
17439 (standard-digest
17440 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17441 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17442 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17443 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17444 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17445 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17446 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17447 (subtype digest guess))
17448 @end example
17449
17450 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17451 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17452 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17453 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17454 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17455
17456 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17457 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17458 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17459 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17460 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17461 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17462 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17463 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17464 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17465 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17466 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17467 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17468
17469
17470 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17471 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17472 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17473 @cindex gateways
17474
17475 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17476 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17477 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17478
17479 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17480 used to post with.
17481
17482 Server variables:
17483
17484 @table @code
17485 @item nngateway-address
17486 @vindex nngateway-address
17487 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17488
17489 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17490 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17491 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17492 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17493 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17494 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17495 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17496 gateway address.
17497
17498 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17499 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17500 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17501
17502 @example
17503 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17504 @end example
17505
17506 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17507
17508 @example
17509 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17510 @end example
17511
17512 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17513
17514 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17515 @table @code
17516
17517 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17518 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17519 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17520
17521 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17522
17523 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17524 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17525 @code{nngateway-address}.
17526 @end table
17527
17528 @end table
17529
17530 Here's an example:
17531
17532 @lisp
17533 (setq gnus-post-method
17534 '(nngateway
17535 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17536 (nngateway-header-transformation
17537 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17538 @end lisp
17539
17540 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17541
17542 @lisp
17543 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17544 @end lisp
17545
17546
17547 @node The Empty Backend
17548 @subsection The Empty Backend
17549 @cindex nnnil
17550
17551 @code{nnnil} is a backend that can be used as a placeholder if you
17552 have to specify a backend somewhere, but don't really want to. The
17553 classical example is if you don't want to have a primary select
17554 methods, but want to only use secondary ones:
17555
17556 @lisp
17557 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnnil ""))
17558 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17559 '((nnimap "foo")
17560 (nnml "")))
17561 @end lisp
17562
17563
17564 @node Combined Groups
17565 @section Combined Groups
17566
17567 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17568 groups.
17569
17570 @menu
17571 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17572 @end menu
17573
17574
17575 @node Virtual Groups
17576 @subsection Virtual Groups
17577 @cindex nnvirtual
17578 @cindex virtual groups
17579 @cindex merging groups
17580
17581 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17582 other groups.
17583
17584 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17585 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17586 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17587
17588 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17589 regexp to match component groups.
17590
17591 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17592 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17593 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17594 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17595 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17596 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17597 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17598 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17599
17600 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17601 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17602
17603 @lisp
17604 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17605 @end lisp
17606
17607 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17608 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17609
17610 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17611 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17612 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17613 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17614
17615 @example
17616 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17617 @end example
17618
17619 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17620 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17621 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17622
17623 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17624 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17625 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17626 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17627 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17628
17629 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17630 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17631 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17632
17633 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17634 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17635 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17636 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17637 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17638 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17639 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17640 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17641 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17642 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17643 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17644
17645 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17646 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17647 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17648 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17649 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17650 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17651 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17652
17653 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17654 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17655
17656 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17657 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17658 inherited.
17659
17660
17661 @node Email Based Diary
17662 @section Email Based Diary
17663 @cindex diary
17664 @cindex email based diary
17665 @cindex calendar
17666
17667 This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17668 and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17669 sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17670 reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17671 Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17672 namely, as event reminders.
17673
17674 Here is a typical scenario:
17675
17676 @itemize @bullet
17677 @item
17678 You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17679 to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17680 @item
17681 So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17682 @item
17683 You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17684 @item
17685 From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
17686 is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17687 appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17688 @item
17689 Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17690 of the night you're gonna have.
17691 @item
17692 Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
17693 message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
17694 @end itemize
17695
17696 The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
17697 (that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
17698 real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
17699 explained in the sections below.
17700
17701 @menu
17702 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
17703 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
17704 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
17705 @end menu
17706
17707
17708 @node The NNDiary Back End
17709 @subsection The NNDiary Back End
17710 @cindex nndiary
17711 @cindex the nndiary back end
17712
17713 @code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
17714 Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
17715 @code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
17716 the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
17717 directory per group.
17718
17719 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
17720 @code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
17721 of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
17722 Timestamp} to see how it's done.
17723
17724 @menu
17725 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
17726 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
17727 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
17728 @end menu
17729
17730 @node Diary Messages
17731 @subsubsection Diary Messages
17732 @cindex nndiary messages
17733 @cindex nndiary mails
17734
17735 @code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
17736 presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
17737 @code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
17738 @code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
17739 @code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
17740 @code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
17741 crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
17742
17743 @itemize @bullet
17744 @item
17745 For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
17746 either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
17747 (separated by a comma).
17748 @item
17749 A field is either an integer, or a range.
17750 @item
17751 A range is two integers separated by a dash.
17752 @item
17753 Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
17754 @code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
17755 for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
17756 @item
17757 As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
17758 mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
17759 that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
17760 @item
17761 The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
17762 value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
17763 values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
17764 zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
17765 list of available time zone values, see the variable
17766 @code{nndiary-headers}.
17767 @end itemize
17768
17769 As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
17770 for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
17771 21:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
17772 what to do then):
17773
17774 @example
17775 X-Diary-Minute: 0
17776 X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
17777 X-Diary-Dom: 1
17778 X-Diary-Month: *
17779 X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
17780 X-Diary-Dow: 1
17781 X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
17782 @end example
17783
17784 @node Running NNDiary
17785 @subsubsection Running NNDiary
17786 @cindex running nndiary
17787 @cindex nndiary operation modes
17788
17789 @code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
17790 and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
17791 mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
17792 from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
17793 as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
17794 mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
17795
17796 One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
17797 ``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
17798 sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
17799 messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
17800 being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
17801 the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
17802 (which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
17803 mode.
17804
17805 In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
17806 things to do:
17807
17808 @itemize @bullet
17809 @item
17810 Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
17811 line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17812
17813 @lisp
17814 (setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
17815 @end lisp
17816 @item
17817 You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
17818 headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
17819 Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
17820 multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
17821 source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
17822
17823 As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
17824 @file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
17825
17826 @example
17827 :0 HD :
17828 * ^X-Diary
17829 .nndiary
17830 @end example
17831 @end itemize
17832
17833 Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
17834 that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
17835
17836 @defvar nndiary-mail-sources
17837 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17838 @code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
17839 @code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
17840 @end defvar
17841
17842 @defvar nndiary-split-methods
17843 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17844 @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
17845 @end defvar
17846
17847 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
17848 (something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
17849 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
17850
17851 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
17852 @file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
17853 autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
17854 also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
17855 diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
17856
17857 @node Customizing NNDiary
17858 @subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
17859 @cindex customizing nndiary
17860 @cindex nndiary customization
17861
17862 Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
17863 The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
17864 browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
17865 two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
17866
17867 @defvar nndiary-reminders
17868 This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
17869 appointments (e.g. 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
17870 before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
17871 diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
17872 mail.
17873 @end defvar
17874
17875 @defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
17876 Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
17877 default).
17878 @end defvar
17879
17880
17881 @node The Gnus Diary Library
17882 @subsection The Gnus Diary Library
17883 @cindex gnus-diary
17884 @cindex the gnus diary library
17885
17886 Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
17887 so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
17888 @code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
17889 useful things for you.
17890
17891 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17892
17893 @lisp
17894 (require 'gnus-diary)
17895 @end lisp
17896
17897 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
17898 (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
17899 (sorry if you used them before).
17900
17901
17902 @menu
17903 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
17904 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
17905 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
17906 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
17907 @end menu
17908
17909 @node Diary Summary Line Format
17910 @subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
17911 @cindex diary summary buffer line
17912 @cindex diary summary line format
17913
17914 Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
17915 something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
17916 the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
17917 see the event's date.
17918
17919 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
17920 summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
17921 for the next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
17922 while @code{d} corresponds to an approximate remaining time until the
17923 next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
17924
17925 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
17926 @code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
17927 expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
17928
17929 @example
17930 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
17931 @end example
17932
17933 In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
17934 following line to your diary groups'parameters:
17935
17936 @lisp
17937 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
17938 @end lisp
17939
17940 However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
17941 Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
17942 with the following user options:
17943
17944 @defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
17945 Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
17946 Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
17947 diary groups'parameters.
17948 @end defvar
17949
17950 @defvar gnus-diary-time-format
17951 Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
17952 used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
17953 @end defvar
17954
17955 @defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
17956 Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
17957 times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
17958 format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
17959 you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
17960 @end defvar
17961
17962 @node Diary Articles Sorting
17963 @subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
17964 @cindex diary articles sorting
17965 @cindex diary summary lines sorting
17966 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
17967 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
17968 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
17969
17970 @code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
17971 Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
17972 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
17973 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
17974 your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
17975
17976 @code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
17977 @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
17978 buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
17979 default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
17980 Parameters}).
17981
17982 @node Diary Headers Generation
17983 @subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
17984 @cindex diary headers generation
17985 @findex gnus-diary-check-message
17986
17987 @code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
17988 @code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
17989 headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
17990 required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
17991 needed.
17992
17993 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
17994 moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
17995 automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
17996 @code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
17997 process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
17998
17999 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18000 all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18001 you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18002 instance.
18003
18004 @node Diary Group Parameters
18005 @subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18006 @cindex diary group parameters
18007
18008 When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18009 automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18010 summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18011 diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18012 @code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18013 to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18014 on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18015 automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
18016
18017 @node Sending or Not Sending
18018 @subsection Sending or Not Sending
18019
18020 Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18021 mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
18022
18023 @itemize @bullet
18024 @item
18025 @code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
18026 messages for real. This means for instance that you can give
18027 appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18028 sending the diary message to them as well.
18029 @item
18030 However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18031 can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18032 message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18033 comes in very handy for private appointments.
18034 @end itemize
18035
18036 @node Gnus Unplugged
18037 @section Gnus Unplugged
18038 @cindex offline
18039 @cindex unplugged
18040 @cindex agent
18041 @cindex Gnus agent
18042 @cindex Gnus unplugged
18043
18044 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18045 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18046 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18047 read news. Believe it or not.
18048
18049 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18050 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18051 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18052 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18053 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
18054
18055 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18056 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18057 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18058 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18059 reading news on a machine.
18060
18061 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18062 fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
18063 by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
18064
18065 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
18066
18067 @menu
18068 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18069 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18070 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18071 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18072 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18073 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18074 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18075 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
18076 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18077 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18078 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18079 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18080 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18081 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18082 @end menu
18083
18084
18085 @node Agent Basics
18086 @subsection Agent Basics
18087
18088 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
18089
18090 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18091 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18092 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18093 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
18094
18095 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18096 connected to the net continuously.
18097
18098 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18099 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
18100
18101 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18102 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18103 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18104 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18105 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
18106
18107 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18108 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18109 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18110 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18111 they're kinda like plugged always).
18112
18113 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18114 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18115 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18116 the culprit.
18117
18118 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18119 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18120 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18121 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18122 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
18123
18124 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
18125
18126 @itemize @bullet
18127
18128 @item
18129 @findex gnus-unplugged
18130 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18131 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18132 already fetched while in this mode.
18133
18134 @item
18135 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18136 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18137 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18138 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18139 Source Specifiers}).
18140
18141 @item
18142 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18143 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18144 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18145 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18146 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
18147
18148 @item
18149 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18150 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18151 then you read the news offline.
18152
18153 @item
18154 And then you go to step 2.
18155 @end itemize
18156
18157 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18158 the Agent.
18159
18160 @itemize @bullet
18161
18162 @item
18163 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18164 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18165 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18166 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18167 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18168 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
18169 no servers are agentized.
18170
18171 @item
18172 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18173 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18174 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18175 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
18176
18177 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18178 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18179 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18180 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18181 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18182 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18183 configure them.
18184
18185 @item
18186 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18187 @end itemize
18188
18189
18190 @node Agent Categories
18191 @subsection Agent Categories
18192
18193 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18194 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18195 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18196 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18197 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18198 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18199 you're interested in the articles anyway.
18200
18201 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18202 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18203 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18204 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18205 buffer for creating and managing categories.
18206
18207 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18208 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18209 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18210 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18211 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18212 sink.
18213
18214 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18215 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18216 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18217 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18218 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18219 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18220 your settings.
18221
18222 @menu
18223 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18224 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18225 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18226 @end menu
18227
18228
18229 @node Category Syntax
18230 @subsubsection Category Syntax
18231
18232 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18233 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18234 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18235 listed below.
18236
18237 @cindex Agent Parameters
18238 @table @code
18239 @item agent-groups
18240 The list of groups that are in this category.
18241
18242 @item agent-predicate
18243 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18244 are eligible for downloading; and
18245
18246 @item agent-score
18247 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18248 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18249 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
18250
18251 @item agent-enable-expiration
18252 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18253 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18254 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18255 only groups that should not be expired.
18256
18257 @item agent-days-until-old
18258 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18259 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
18260
18261 @item agent-low-score
18262 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
18263
18264 @item agent-high-score
18265 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
18266
18267 @item agent-short-article
18268 an integer that overrides the value of
18269 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
18270
18271 @item agent-long-article
18272 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
18273
18274 @item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
18275 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18276 undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
18277 faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
18278 undownloaded faces.
18279 @end table
18280
18281 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18282 created.
18283
18284 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18285 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18286 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18287 category.
18288
18289 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18290 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18291 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18292 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
18293
18294 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18295 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18296 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
18297
18298 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18299 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18300 operators sprinkled in between.
18301
18302 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18303
18304 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18305 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18306
18307 @lisp
18308 short
18309 @end lisp
18310
18311 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18312 short (for some value of ``short'').
18313
18314 Here's a more complex predicate:
18315
18316 @lisp
18317 (or high
18318 (and
18319 (not low)
18320 (not long)))
18321 @end lisp
18322
18323 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18324 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18325 drift.
18326
18327 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18328 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18329 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18330
18331 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18332 you want to do, you can write your own.
18333
18334 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18335 bound to the value determined by calling
18336 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18337 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18338 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18339 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18340 predicate to individual groups.
18341
18342 @table @code
18343 @item short
18344 True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18345 lines; default 100.
18346
18347 @item long
18348 True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18349 lines; default 200.
18350
18351 @item low
18352 True if the article has a download score less than
18353 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18354
18355 @item high
18356 True if the article has a download score greater than
18357 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18358
18359 @item spam
18360 True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18361 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18362 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18363
18364 @item true
18365 Always true.
18366
18367 @item false
18368 Always false.
18369 @end table
18370
18371 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18372 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18373 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18374 useful values.
18375
18376 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18377 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
18378 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18379 something along the lines of the following:
18380
18381 @lisp
18382 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18383 "Say whether an article is old."
18384 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18385 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18386 @end lisp
18387
18388 with the predicate then defined as:
18389
18390 @lisp
18391 (not my-article-old-p)
18392 @end lisp
18393
18394 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18395 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18396 wherever.
18397
18398 @lisp
18399 (require 'gnus-agent)
18400 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18401 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18402 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18403 @end lisp
18404
18405 and simply specify your predicate as:
18406
18407 @lisp
18408 (not old)
18409 @end lisp
18410
18411 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18412 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18413 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18414 just don't give a damn.
18415
18416 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18417 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18418 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18419 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18420 parameters like so:
18421
18422 @lisp
18423 (agent-predicate . short)
18424 @end lisp
18425
18426 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18427 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18428 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18429
18430 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18431
18432 @lisp
18433 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18434 @end lisp
18435
18436 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18437 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18438 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18439
18440
18441 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18442 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18443 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18444 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18445 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18446 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18447
18448 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18449 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18450 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18451 if it's to be specific to that group.
18452
18453 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18454 three forms:
18455
18456 @enumerate
18457 @item
18458 Score rule
18459
18460 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18461 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18462
18463 example:
18464
18465 @itemize @bullet
18466 @item
18467 Category specification
18468
18469 @lisp
18470 (("from"
18471 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18472 ("lines"
18473 (500 -100 nil <)))
18474 @end lisp
18475
18476 @item
18477 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18478
18479 @lisp
18480 (agent-score ("from"
18481 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18482 ("lines"
18483 (500 -100 nil <)))
18484 @end lisp
18485
18486 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18487 @end itemize
18488
18489 @item
18490 Agent score file
18491
18492 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18493 keywords stated above.
18494
18495 example:
18496
18497 @itemize @bullet
18498 @item
18499 Category specification
18500
18501 @lisp
18502 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18503 @end lisp
18504
18505 or perhaps
18506
18507 @lisp
18508 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18509 @end lisp
18510
18511 @item
18512 Group Parameter specification
18513
18514 @lisp
18515 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18516 @end lisp
18517
18518 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18519 about parenthesis?
18520 @end itemize
18521
18522 @item
18523 Use @code{normal} score files
18524
18525 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18526 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18527 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18528 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18529
18530 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18531 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18532 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18533 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18534
18535 @itemize @bullet
18536 @item
18537 Category Specification
18538
18539 @lisp
18540 file
18541 @end lisp
18542
18543 @item
18544 Group Parameter specification
18545
18546 @lisp
18547 (agent-score . file)
18548 @end lisp
18549 @end itemize
18550 @end enumerate
18551
18552 @node Category Buffer
18553 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18554
18555 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18556 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18557 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18558
18559 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18560
18561 @table @kbd
18562 @item q
18563 @kindex q (Category)
18564 @findex gnus-category-exit
18565 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18566
18567 @item e
18568 @kindex e (Category)
18569 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18570 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18571 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18572
18573 @item k
18574 @kindex k (Category)
18575 @findex gnus-category-kill
18576 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18577
18578 @item c
18579 @kindex c (Category)
18580 @findex gnus-category-copy
18581 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18582
18583 @item a
18584 @kindex a (Category)
18585 @findex gnus-category-add
18586 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18587
18588 @item p
18589 @kindex p (Category)
18590 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18591 Edit the predicate of the current category
18592 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18593
18594 @item g
18595 @kindex g (Category)
18596 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18597 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18598 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18599
18600 @item s
18601 @kindex s (Category)
18602 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18603 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18604 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18605
18606 @item l
18607 @kindex l (Category)
18608 @findex gnus-category-list
18609 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18610 @end table
18611
18612
18613 @node Category Variables
18614 @subsubsection Category Variables
18615
18616 @table @code
18617 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18618 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18619 Hook run in category buffers.
18620
18621 @item gnus-category-line-format
18622 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18623 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18624 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18625
18626 @table @samp
18627 @item c
18628 The name of the category.
18629
18630 @item g
18631 The number of groups in the category.
18632 @end table
18633
18634 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18635 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18636 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18637
18638 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18639 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18640 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18641
18642 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18643 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18644 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18645
18646 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18647 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18648 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18649 0.
18650
18651 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18652 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18653 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18654 0.
18655
18656 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18657 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18658 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18659 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18660 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18661 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18662 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18663 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18664 read.
18665 Default 7.
18666
18667 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18668 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18669 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18670 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18671 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18672 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18673 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18674
18675 @end table
18676
18677
18678 @node Agent Commands
18679 @subsection Agent Commands
18680 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18681 @kindex J j (Agent)
18682
18683 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18684 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18685 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18686
18687
18688 @menu
18689 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18690 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18691 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18692 @end menu
18693
18694
18695
18696
18697 @node Group Agent Commands
18698 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18699
18700 @table @kbd
18701 @item J u
18702 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18703 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18704 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18705 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18706
18707 @item J c
18708 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18709 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18710 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18711
18712 @item J s
18713 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18714 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18715 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18716 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18717
18718 @item J S
18719 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18720 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18721 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18722 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18723
18724 @item J a
18725 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18726 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18727 Add the current group to an Agent category
18728 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18729 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18730
18731 @item J r
18732 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18733 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18734 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18735 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18736 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18737
18738 @item J Y
18739 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18740 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18741 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18742
18743
18744 @end table
18745
18746
18747 @node Summary Agent Commands
18748 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18749
18750 @table @kbd
18751 @item J #
18752 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18753 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18754 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18755
18756 @item J M-#
18757 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18758 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18759 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18760 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18761
18762 @cindex %
18763 @item @@
18764 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18765 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18766 Toggle whether to download the article
18767 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18768 default.
18769
18770 @item J c
18771 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18772 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18773 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18774
18775 @item J S
18776 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18777 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18778 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18779 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18780
18781 @item J s
18782 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18783 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
18784 Download all processable articles in this group.
18785 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
18786
18787 @item J u
18788 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18789 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18790 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18791 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18792
18793 @end table
18794
18795
18796 @node Server Agent Commands
18797 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18798
18799 @table @kbd
18800 @item J a
18801 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18802 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18803 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18804 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18805
18806 @item J r
18807 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18808 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18809 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18810 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18811
18812 @end table
18813
18814
18815 @node Agent Visuals
18816 @subsection Agent Visuals
18817
18818 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18819 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18820 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18821 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18822 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18823 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18824 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18825 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18826 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18827 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18828
18829 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18830 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18831 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18832 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18833 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18834 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18835 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18836 articles will be available when unplugged.
18837
18838 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18839 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18840 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18841 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18842 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18843 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18844 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18845 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18846
18847 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18848 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18849 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18850 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18851 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18852 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18853 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18854 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18855 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18856
18857 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18858 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18859 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18860 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18861 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
18862 users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
18863 database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
18864 to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
18865 of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
18866 normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
18867
18868 If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
18869 undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
18870 group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
18871 parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
18872 a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
18873 (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18874
18875 The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
18876 can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
18877 even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
18878 is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
18879 This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
18880 fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
18881 the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
18882 expiring'' articles.
18883
18884 @node Agent as Cache
18885 @subsection Agent as Cache
18886
18887 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18888 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18889 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18890 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18891 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18892 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18893 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18894 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18895 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18896
18897 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18898 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18899 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18900 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18901 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18902
18903 @node Agent Expiry
18904 @subsection Agent Expiry
18905
18906 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18907 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18908 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18909 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18910 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18911 @cindex agent expiry
18912 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18913 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
18914
18915 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18916 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18917 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18918 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18919 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18920 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18921 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18922 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18923
18924 Note that other functions might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you
18925 to keep the agent synchronized with the group.
18926
18927 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18928 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18929
18930 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18931 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18932 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18933 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18934 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18935 be kept indefinitely.
18936
18937 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18938 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18939 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18940 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18941
18942 @node Agent Regeneration
18943 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18944
18945 @cindex agent regeneration
18946 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18947 @cindex regeneration
18948
18949 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18950 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18951 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18952 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18953 internal inconsistencies.
18954
18955 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18956 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18957 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18958 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18959 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18960 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18961
18962 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18963 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18964 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18965 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18966 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18967 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18968
18969 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18970 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18971 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
18972 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
18973 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
18974 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
18975 agent as unread.
18976
18977 @node Agent and flags
18978 @subsection Agent and flags
18979
18980 The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
18981 nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc) on the server. Sadly,
18982 the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
18983 the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
18984 Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
18985 to the flags in its own files.
18986
18987 When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
18988 changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
18989 server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
18990
18991 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18992 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
18993 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
18994 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
18995 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
18996 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
18997
18998 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
18999 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19000 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19001 in the group buffer.
19002
19003 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19004 all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
19005 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19006 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
19007 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19008 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19009 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19010 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
19011
19012 @node Agent and IMAP
19013 @subsection Agent and IMAP
19014
19015 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19016 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19017 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19018 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
19019
19020 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19021 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
19022
19023 @itemize @bullet
19024
19025 @item
19026 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
19027
19028 @item
19029 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
19030
19031 @end itemize
19032
19033 @node Outgoing Messages
19034 @subsection Outgoing Messages
19035
19036 By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
19037 and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
19038 You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
19039
19040 You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
19041 (see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
19042 news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
19043
19044 You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
19045 commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
19046 group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
19047 Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
19048 mail at any time.
19049
19050 If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
19051 about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
19052 ask you to confirm your action (see
19053 @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
19054
19055 @node Agent Variables
19056 @subsection Agent Variables
19057
19058 @table @code
19059 @item gnus-agent
19060 @vindex gnus-agent
19061 Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
19062 the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
19063 automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
19064 back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
19065
19066 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
19067 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
19068
19069
19070 @item gnus-agent-directory
19071 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
19072 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19073 @file{~/News/agent/}.
19074
19075 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
19076 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19077 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19078 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19079 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19080 by default.
19081
19082 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19083 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19084 Hook run when connecting to the network.
19085
19086 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19087 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19088 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
19089
19090 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19091 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19092 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
19093
19094 @item gnus-agent-cache
19095 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
19096 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
19097 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
19098 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
19099
19100 @item gnus-agent-go-online
19101 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19102 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19103 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19104 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19105 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19106 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19107 online status.
19108
19109 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19110 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19111 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19112 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19113 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19114 read. The default is @code{t}.
19115
19116 @item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19117 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19118 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19119 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19120 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19121 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19122 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19123
19124 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19125 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19126 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19127 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19128 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19129 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19130 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19131 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19132 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19133 over and over again.
19134
19135 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19136 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19137 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19138 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19139 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19140 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19141 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19142 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19143 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19144 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19145 However, all articles parsed prior to losing the connection will be
19146 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19147 see any cycling.
19148
19149 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
19150 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19151 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19152 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19153 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19154 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19155 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19156 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19157 is only valid if the Agent is used.
19158
19159 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19160 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19161 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19162 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19163 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19164 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
19165
19166 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19167 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19168 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19169 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19170 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
19171
19172 @item gnus-agent-queue-mail
19173 @vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
19174 When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
19175 queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
19176 will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
19177 mail. The default is @code{t}.
19178
19179 @item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19180 @vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19181 When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
19182 prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
19183 @kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
19184
19185 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19186 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19187 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19188 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19189 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19190 which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19191 to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19192 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19193 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19194 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
19195 start Gnus. The default is @samp{nil}.
19196
19197 @end table
19198
19199
19200 @node Example Setup
19201 @subsection Example Setup
19202
19203 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19204 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19205 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
19206
19207 @lisp
19208 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19209 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19210 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
19211
19212 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19213 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19214 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
19215
19216 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19217 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19218
19219 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19220 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19221 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
19222 @end lisp
19223
19224 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19225 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19226 gnus}.
19227
19228 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19229 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19230 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19231 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19232 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19233 once.
19234
19235 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19236 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19237 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19238 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19239 back all the killed groups.)
19240
19241 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19242 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19243 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
19244
19245
19246 @node Batching Agents
19247 @subsection Batching Agents
19248 @findex gnus-agent-batch
19249
19250 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19251 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19252 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
19253
19254 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19255 following incantation:
19256
19257 @example
19258 #!/bin/sh
19259 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19260 @end example
19261
19262
19263 @node Agent Caveats
19264 @subsection Agent Caveats
19265
19266 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19267 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19268 may ask:
19269
19270 @table @dfn
19271 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
19272
19273 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19274 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19275 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
19276
19277 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19278 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
19279
19280 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
19281
19282 @end table
19283
19284 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19285 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19286 locally stored articles.
19287
19288
19289 @node Scoring
19290 @chapter Scoring
19291 @cindex scoring
19292
19293 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19294 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19295 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19296 attention!
19297
19298 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19299 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19300 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19301 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19302 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
19303
19304 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19305 before generating the summary buffer.
19306
19307 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19308 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19309 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
19310
19311 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19312 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19313 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19314 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
19315
19316 @menu
19317 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19318 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19319 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19320 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19321 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19322 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19323 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19324 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19325 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19326 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19327 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19328 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19329 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19330 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19331 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19332 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19333 @end menu
19334
19335
19336 @node Summary Score Commands
19337 @section Summary Score Commands
19338 @cindex score commands
19339
19340 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19341 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19342 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19343 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19344 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
19345
19346 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19347 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
19348 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
19349 score file the current one.
19350
19351 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19352
19353 @table @kbd
19354
19355 @item V s
19356 @kindex V s (Summary)
19357 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19358 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19359
19360 @item V S
19361 @kindex V S (Summary)
19362 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19363 Display the score of the current article
19364 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19365
19366 @item V t
19367 @kindex V t (Summary)
19368 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19369 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19370 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19371 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19372 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19373 score file and edit it.
19374
19375 @item V w
19376 @kindex V w (Summary)
19377 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19378 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19379
19380 @item V R
19381 @kindex V R (Summary)
19382 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19383 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19384 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19385 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19386 effect you're having.
19387
19388 @item V c
19389 @kindex V c (Summary)
19390 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19391 Make a different score file the current
19392 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19393
19394 @item V e
19395 @kindex V e (Summary)
19396 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19397 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19398 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19399 File Editing}).
19400
19401 @item V f
19402 @kindex V f (Summary)
19403 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19404 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19405 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19406
19407 @item V F
19408 @kindex V F (Summary)
19409 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19410 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19411 after editing score files.
19412
19413 @item V C
19414 @kindex V C (Summary)
19415 @findex gnus-score-customize
19416 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19417 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19418
19419 @end table
19420
19421 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19422
19423 @table @kbd
19424
19425 @item V m
19426 @kindex V m (Summary)
19427 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19428 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19429 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19430
19431 @item V x
19432 @kindex V x (Summary)
19433 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19434 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19435 expunge all articles below this score
19436 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19437 @end table
19438
19439 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19440 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19441 them.)
19442
19443 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19444 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19445
19446 @enumerate
19447 @item
19448 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19449 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19450 @item
19451 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19452 keys are available:
19453 @table @kbd
19454
19455 @item a
19456 Score on the author name.
19457
19458 @item s
19459 Score on the subject line.
19460
19461 @item x
19462 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19463
19464 @item r
19465 Score on the @code{References} line.
19466
19467 @item d
19468 Score on the date.
19469
19470 @item l
19471 Score on the number of lines.
19472
19473 @item i
19474 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19475
19476 @item e
19477 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19478 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19479
19480 @item f
19481 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19482 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19483 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19484
19485 @item b
19486 Score on the body.
19487
19488 @item h
19489 Score on the head.
19490
19491 @item t
19492 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19493 files.)
19494
19495 @end table
19496
19497 @item
19498 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19499 what headers you are scoring on.
19500
19501 @table @code
19502
19503 @item strings
19504
19505 @table @kbd
19506
19507 @item e
19508 Exact matching.
19509
19510 @item s
19511 Substring matching.
19512
19513 @item f
19514 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19515
19516 @item r
19517 Regexp matching
19518 @end table
19519
19520 @item date
19521 @table @kbd
19522
19523 @item b
19524 Before date.
19525
19526 @item a
19527 After date.
19528
19529 @item n
19530 This date.
19531 @end table
19532
19533 @item number
19534 @table @kbd
19535
19536 @item <
19537 Less than number.
19538
19539 @item =
19540 Equal to number.
19541
19542 @item >
19543 Greater than number.
19544 @end table
19545 @end table
19546
19547 @item
19548 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19549 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19550 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19551 file.
19552 @table @kbd
19553
19554 @item t
19555 Temporary score entry.
19556
19557 @item p
19558 Permanent score entry.
19559
19560 @item i
19561 Immediately scoring.
19562 @end table
19563
19564 @item
19565 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19566 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19567 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19568
19569 @end enumerate
19570
19571 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19572 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19573 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19574 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19575
19576 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19577 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19578 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19579 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19580 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19581
19582 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19583 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19584 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19585 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19586 current score file.
19587
19588 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19589 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19590 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19591
19592
19593 @node Group Score Commands
19594 @section Group Score Commands
19595 @cindex group score commands
19596
19597 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19598
19599 @table @kbd
19600
19601 @item W e
19602 @kindex W e (Group)
19603 @findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
19604 Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
19605 a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
19606
19607 @item W f
19608 @kindex W f (Group)
19609 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19610 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19611 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19612 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19613
19614 @end table
19615
19616 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19617
19618 @findex gnus-batch-score
19619 @cindex batch scoring
19620 @example
19621 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19622 @end example
19623
19624
19625 @node Score Variables
19626 @section Score Variables
19627 @cindex score variables
19628
19629 @table @code
19630
19631 @item gnus-use-scoring
19632 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19633 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19634 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19635
19636 @item gnus-kill-killed
19637 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19638 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19639 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19640 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19641 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19642 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19643 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19644
19645 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19646 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19647 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19648 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19649 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19650
19651 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19652 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19653 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19654 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19655
19656 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19657 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19658 @cindex score cache
19659 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19660 score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
19661 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19662 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19663 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19664 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19665 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19666 be cached.
19667
19668 @item gnus-save-score
19669 @vindex gnus-save-score
19670 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19671 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19672 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19673
19674 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19675 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19676 across group visits.
19677
19678 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19679 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19680 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19681 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19682 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19683 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19684 manually entered data.
19685
19686 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19687 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19688 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19689
19690 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19691 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19692 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19693 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19694 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19695 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19696
19697 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19698 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19699 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19700 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19701
19702 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19703 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19704 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19705 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19706
19707 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19708 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19709 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19710 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19711
19712 Predefined functions available are:
19713 @table @code
19714
19715 @item gnus-score-find-single
19716 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19717 Only apply the group's own score file.
19718
19719 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19720 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19721 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19722 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19723 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19724 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19725 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19726 then a regexp match is done.
19727
19728 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19729 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19730
19731 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19732 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19733 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19734 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19735
19736 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19737 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19738 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19739 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19740 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19741 server.
19742
19743 @end table
19744 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19745 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19746 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19747 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19748 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19749 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19750 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19751 Phu.
19752
19753 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19754 overall score file, you could use the value
19755 @example
19756 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19757 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19758 @end example
19759
19760 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19761 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19762 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19763 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19764 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19765
19766 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19767 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19768 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19769 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19770 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19771 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19772 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19773 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19774
19775 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19776 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19777 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19778
19779 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19780 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19781 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19782 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19783 threading---according to the current value of
19784 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19785 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19786 simplified in this manner.
19787
19788 @end table
19789
19790
19791 @node Score File Format
19792 @section Score File Format
19793 @cindex score file format
19794
19795 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19796 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19797 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19798
19799 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19800
19801 @lisp
19802 (("from"
19803 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19804 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19805 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19806 ("subject"
19807 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19808 ("xref"
19809 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19810 ("lines"
19811 (2 -100 nil <))
19812 (mark 0)
19813 (expunge -1000)
19814 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19815 (read-only nil)
19816 (orphan -10)
19817 (adapt t)
19818 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19819 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19820 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19821 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19822 (eval (ding)))
19823 @end lisp
19824
19825 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19826 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19827
19828 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19829 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19830 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19831
19832 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19833
19834 @table @code
19835
19836 @item STRING
19837 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19838 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19839 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19840 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19841 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19842 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19843 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19844 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19845 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19846 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19847 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19848 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19849 to articles that matches these score entries.
19850
19851 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19852 score entry has one to four elements.
19853 @enumerate
19854
19855 @item
19856 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19857 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19858 integer.
19859
19860 @item
19861 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19862 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19863 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19864 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19865 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19866 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19867
19868 @item
19869 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19870 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19871 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19872 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19873 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19874
19875 @item
19876 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19877 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19878 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19879 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19880 @table @dfn
19881
19882 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19883 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19884 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19885 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19886 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19887 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19888 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19889 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19890 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19891 instead, if you feel like.
19892
19893 @item Extra
19894 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19895 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19896 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19897 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19898 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19899 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19900 overviews:
19901
19902 @lisp
19903 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19904 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19905 @end lisp
19906
19907 @item Lines, Chars
19908 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19909 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19910
19911 These predicates are true if
19912
19913 @example
19914 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19915 @end example
19916
19917 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19918 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19919 following form:
19920
19921 @lisp
19922 (< header-value 4)
19923 @end lisp
19924
19925 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19926 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19927 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19928 it's not. I think.)
19929
19930 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19931 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19932 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19933 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19934
19935 @item Date
19936 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19937 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19938 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19939 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19940 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19941 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19942 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19943
19944 @cindex ISO8601
19945 @cindex date
19946 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19947 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19948 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19949 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19950 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19951 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19952 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19953 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19954 whole family, eh?)
19955
19956 @item Head, Body, All
19957 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19958 header uses.
19959
19960 @item Followup
19961 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19962 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19963 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19964 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19965 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19966 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19967 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19968 files.)
19969
19970 @item Thread
19971 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
19972 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
19973 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
19974 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
19975 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
19976 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
19977 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
19978 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
19979 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
19980 nondeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
19981 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
19982 @end table
19983 @end enumerate
19984
19985 @cindex score file atoms
19986 @item mark
19987 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19988 lower than this number will be marked as read.
19989
19990 @item expunge
19991 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19992 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
19993
19994 @item mark-and-expunge
19995 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19996 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
19997 summary buffer.
19998
19999 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
20000 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20001 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20002 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20003 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20004
20005 @item files
20006 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20007 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20008 this one was.
20009
20010 @item exclude-files
20011 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20012 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20013 other.
20014
20015 @item eval
20016 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}ed. This element will be
20017 ignored when handling global score files.
20018
20019 @item read-only
20020 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20021 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20022 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20023 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
20024
20025 @item orphan
20026 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20027 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20028 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20029 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
20030
20031 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
20032
20033 @example
20034 (orphan -500)
20035 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20036 @end example
20037
20038 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20039 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20040 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{c y}) the
20041 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20042 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
20043
20044 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
20045 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20046 scoring rules exist.
20047
20048 @item adapt
20049 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20050 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20051 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20052 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20053 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20054 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20055 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20056 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20057 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20058 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20059 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20060 it.
20061
20062 @item adapt-file
20063 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20064 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20065 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20066 file for a number of groups.
20067
20068 @item local
20069 @cindex local variables
20070 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20071 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20072 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20073 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20074 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20075 be evaluated.
20076 @end table
20077
20078
20079 @node Score File Editing
20080 @section Score File Editing
20081
20082 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20083 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20084 with a mode for that.
20085
20086 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20087 additional commands:
20088
20089 @table @kbd
20090
20091 @item C-c C-c
20092 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20093 @findex gnus-score-edit-exit
20094 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20095 (@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
20096
20097 @item C-c C-d
20098 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20099 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20100 Insert the current date in numerical format
20101 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20102 you were wondering.
20103
20104 @item C-c C-p
20105 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20106 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20107 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20108 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20109 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20110 you.
20111
20112 @end table
20113
20114 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
20115
20116 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20117 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
20118
20119 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20120 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
20121
20122
20123 @node Adaptive Scoring
20124 @section Adaptive Scoring
20125 @cindex adaptive scoring
20126
20127 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20128 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20129 stupidity, to be precise.
20130
20131 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20132 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20133 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20134 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20135 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20136 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20137 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20138 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20139 variable to @code{(word line)}.
20140
20141 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20142 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20143 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20144 might look something like this:
20145
20146 @lisp
20147 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20148 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20149 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20150 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20151 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20152 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20153 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20154 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20155 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20156 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20157 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20158 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20159 @end lisp
20160
20161 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20162 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20163 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20164 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20165 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20166 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20167 entries.
20168
20169 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20170 will be applied to each article.
20171
20172 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20173 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20174 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20175 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20176
20177 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20178 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20179 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20180 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20181
20182 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20183 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20184 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20185 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20186
20187 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20188 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20189 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20190 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20191 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20192 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
20193
20194 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20195 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20196 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
20197
20198 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20199 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20200 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
20201
20202 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20203 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20204 let you use different rules in different groups.
20205
20206 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20207 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20208 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20209 is @file{ADAPT}.
20210
20211 @vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
20212 Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
20213 human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
20214 default) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
20215
20216 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20217 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20218 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20219 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20220 the length of the match is less than
20221 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20222 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20223 this problem.
20224
20225 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20226 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20227 headers. If you adapt on words, the
20228 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20229 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
20230
20231 @lisp
20232 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20233 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20234 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20235 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20236 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20237 @end lisp
20238
20239 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20240 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20241 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20242 score with 30 points.
20243
20244 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20245 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20246 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20247 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20248 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
20249
20250 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20251 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20252 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20253 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20254 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
20255
20256 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20257 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20258 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20259 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
20260
20261 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20262 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20263 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20264 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
20265
20266 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20267 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20268 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20269 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20270 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
20271
20272 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20273 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20274 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
20275
20276 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20277 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20278 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20279 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
20280
20281
20282 @node Home Score File
20283 @section Home Score File
20284
20285 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20286 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20287 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20288 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
20289
20290 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20291 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20292 could perhaps use the same home score file.
20293
20294 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
20295 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20296 be:
20297
20298 @enumerate
20299 @item
20300 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20301 groups.
20302
20303 @item
20304 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20305 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20306 parameter.
20307
20308 @item
20309 A list. The elements in this list can be:
20310
20311 @enumerate
20312 @item
20313 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20314 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
20315
20316 @item
20317 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20318 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20319 name of the group as the parameter.
20320
20321 @item
20322 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20323 @end enumerate
20324
20325 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20326 for matches.
20327
20328 @end enumerate
20329
20330 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
20331
20332 @lisp
20333 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20334 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20335 @end lisp
20336
20337 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20338 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
20339
20340 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20341 @lisp
20342 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20343 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20344 @end lisp
20345
20346 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20347 Other functions include
20348
20349 @table @code
20350 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
20351 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20352 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20353 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
20354
20355 @end table
20356
20357 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20358 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20359 their own home score files:
20360
20361 @lisp
20362 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20363 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20364 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20365 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20366 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20367 @end lisp
20368
20369 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20370 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20371 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20372 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20373 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20374
20375 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20376 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20377 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20378 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20379 precedence over this variable.
20380
20381
20382 @node Followups To Yourself
20383 @section Followups To Yourself
20384
20385 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20386 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20387 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20388 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20389 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20390 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20391
20392 @table @code
20393
20394 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20395 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20396 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20397 article.
20398
20399 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20400 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20401 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20402 your own article.
20403 @end table
20404
20405 @vindex message-sent-hook
20406 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20407 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20408 @lisp
20409 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20410 @end lisp
20411
20412
20413 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20414 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20415 mine:
20416
20417 @example
20418 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20419 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20420 @end example
20421
20422 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20423 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20424 myself:
20425
20426 @lisp
20427 ("references"
20428 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20429 1000 nil r))
20430 @end lisp
20431
20432 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20433 is system-dependent.
20434
20435
20436 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20437 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20438 @cindex scoring on other headers
20439
20440 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20441 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20442 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20443 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20444 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20445
20446 @vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
20447 You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
20448 variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
20449 @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
20450 the group matches the regexp. If it is t, slow scoring on it is
20451 inhibited for all groups.
20452
20453 Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
20454 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20455 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20456 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20457 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20458
20459 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20460
20461 @lisp
20462 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20463 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20464 @end lisp
20465
20466 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20467 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20468 time if you have much mail.
20469
20470 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20471 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20472
20473 See? Simple.
20474
20475
20476 @node Scoring Tips
20477 @section Scoring Tips
20478 @cindex scoring tips
20479
20480 @table @dfn
20481
20482 @item Crossposts
20483 @cindex crossposts
20484 @cindex scoring crossposts
20485 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20486 the @code{Xref} header.
20487 @lisp
20488 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20489 @end lisp
20490
20491 @item Multiple crossposts
20492 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20493 more than, say, 3 groups:
20494 @lisp
20495 ("xref"
20496 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20497 -1000 nil r))
20498 @end lisp
20499
20500 @item Matching on the body
20501 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20502 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20503 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20504 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20505 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20506 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20507 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20508 the matches.
20509
20510 @item Marking as read
20511 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20512 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20513 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20514 @lisp
20515 ((mark -100))
20516 @end lisp
20517 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20518
20519 @item Negated character classes
20520 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20521 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20522 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20523 @end table
20524
20525
20526 @node Reverse Scoring
20527 @section Reverse Scoring
20528 @cindex reverse scoring
20529
20530 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20531 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20532 like this in your score file:
20533
20534 @lisp
20535 (("subject"
20536 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20537 (mark 1)
20538 (expunge 1))
20539 @end lisp
20540
20541 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20542 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20543
20544
20545 @node Global Score Files
20546 @section Global Score Files
20547 @cindex global score files
20548
20549 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20550 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20551 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20552
20553 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20554 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20555 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20556
20557 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20558 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20559 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20560 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20561 files are applicable to which group.
20562
20563 To use the score file
20564 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20565 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20566 say this:
20567
20568 @lisp
20569 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20570 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20571 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20572 @end lisp
20573
20574 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20575 @noindent
20576 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20577 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20578 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20579 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20580
20581 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20582 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20583
20584 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20585 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20586 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20587 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20588 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20589 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20590
20591 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20592 head:
20593
20594 @itemize @bullet
20595
20596 @item
20597 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20598 @item
20599 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20600 @item
20601 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20602 @item
20603 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20604 lowered out of existence.
20605 @item
20606 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20607 articles completely.
20608
20609 @item
20610 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20611 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20612 old articles for a long time.
20613 @end itemize
20614
20615 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20616 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20617 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20618 holding our breath yet?
20619
20620
20621 @node Kill Files
20622 @section Kill Files
20623 @cindex kill files
20624
20625 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20626 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20627 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20628
20629 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20630 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20631 files into score files.
20632
20633 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20634 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20635 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20636 that isn't a very good idea.
20637
20638 Normal kill files look like this:
20639
20640 @lisp
20641 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20642 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20643 (gnus-expunge "X")
20644 @end lisp
20645
20646 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20647 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20648
20649 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20650 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20651 interpreting it.
20652
20653 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20654
20655 @table @kbd
20656
20657 @item M-k
20658 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20659 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20660 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20661
20662 @item M-K
20663 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20664 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20665 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20666 @end table
20667
20668 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20669
20670 @table @kbd
20671
20672 @item M-k
20673 @kindex M-k (Group)
20674 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20675 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20676
20677 @item M-K
20678 @kindex M-K (Group)
20679 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20680 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20681 @end table
20682
20683 Kill file variables:
20684
20685 @table @code
20686 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20687 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20688 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20689 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20690 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20691 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20692 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20693
20694 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20695 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20696 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20697 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20698 kills.
20699
20700 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20701 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20702 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20703 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20704 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20705 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20706 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20707 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20708 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20709
20710 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20711 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20712 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20713
20714 @end table
20715
20716
20717 @node Converting Kill Files
20718 @section Converting Kill Files
20719 @cindex kill files
20720 @cindex converting kill files
20721
20722 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20723 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20724 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20725 by hand.
20726
20727 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Emacs by default.
20728 You can fetch it from the contrib directory of the Gnus distribution or
20729 from
20730 @uref{http://heim.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20731
20732 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20733 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20734 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20735 before.
20736
20737
20738 @node Advanced Scoring
20739 @section Advanced Scoring
20740
20741 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20742 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20743 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20744 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20745 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20746
20747 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20748 scoring patterns.
20749
20750 @menu
20751 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20752 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20753 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20754 @end menu
20755
20756
20757 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20758 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20759
20760 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20761 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20762 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20763 non-@code{nil} value.
20764
20765 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20766 operator, and various match operators.
20767
20768 Logical operators:
20769
20770 @table @code
20771 @item &
20772 @itemx and
20773 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20774 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20775 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20776 @code{true}.
20777
20778 @item |
20779 @itemx or
20780 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20781 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20782 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20783
20784 @item !
20785 @itemx not
20786 @itemx ¬
20787 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20788 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20789
20790 @end table
20791
20792 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20793 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20794 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20795 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20796 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20797 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20798 the ancestry you want to go.
20799
20800 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20801 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20802 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20803 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20804 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20805
20806
20807 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20808 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20809
20810 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20811 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20812 of parentheses.
20813
20814 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20815 when he's talking about Gnus:
20816
20817 @example
20818 @group
20819 ((&
20820 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20821 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20822 1000)
20823 @end group
20824 @end example
20825
20826 Quite simple, huh?
20827
20828 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20829
20830 @example
20831 ((&
20832 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20833 (|
20834 ("subject" "Gnus")
20835 ("lines" 100 >)))
20836 1000)
20837 @end example
20838
20839 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20840 really don't want to read what he's written:
20841
20842 @example
20843 ((&
20844 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20845 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20846 -100000)
20847 @end example
20848
20849 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20850 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20851 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20852 very interesting:
20853
20854 @example
20855 ((&
20856 (1-
20857 (&
20858 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20859 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20860 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20861 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20862 1000)
20863 @end example
20864
20865 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20866 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20867 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20868 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20869
20870 @example
20871 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20872 -200)
20873 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20874 200)
20875 @end example
20876
20877 The possibilities are endless.
20878
20879 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20880 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20881
20882 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20883 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20884 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20885 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20886 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20887 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20888 @samp{subject}) first.
20889
20890 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20891 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20892 something like:
20893
20894 @example
20895 ...
20896 (1-
20897 (1-
20898 ("from" "lars")))
20899 ...
20900 @end example
20901
20902 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20903 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20904
20905 @example
20906 (1-
20907 (&
20908 ("from" "Lars")
20909 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20910 @end example
20911
20912 than it is to say:
20913
20914 @example
20915 (&
20916 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20917 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20918 @end example
20919
20920
20921 @node Score Decays
20922 @section Score Decays
20923 @cindex score decays
20924 @cindex decays
20925
20926 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20927 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20928 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20929 use them in any sensible way.
20930
20931 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20932 @findex gnus-decay-score
20933 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20934 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20935 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20936 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20937 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20938 If @code{gnus-decay-scores} is a regexp, only score files matching this
20939 regexp are treated. E.g. you may set it to @samp{\\.ADAPT\\'} if only
20940 @emph{adaptive} score files should be decayed. The decay itself if
20941 performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function} function, which is
20942 @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the definition of that
20943 function:
20944
20945 @lisp
20946 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20947 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20948 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20949 (let ((n (- score
20950 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20951 (min (abs score)
20952 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20953 (* (abs score)
20954 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20955 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20956 ;; XEmacs's floor can handle only the floating point
20957 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20958 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20959 (string-to-number
20960 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20961 (floor n))))
20962 @end lisp
20963
20964 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20965 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20966 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20967 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20968
20969 @enumerate
20970 @item
20971 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
20972
20973 @item
20974 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
20975
20976 @item
20977 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
20978 score.
20979 @end enumerate
20980
20981 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
20982 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
20983 the new score, which should be an integer.
20984
20985 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
20986 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
20987
20988 @node Searching
20989 @chapter Searching
20990 @cindex searching
20991
20992 FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
20993 comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
20994 as well.
20995
20996 This chapter describes tools for searching groups and servers for
20997 articles matching a query and then retrieving those articles. Gnus
20998 provides a simpler mechanism for searching through articles in a summary buffer
20999 to find those matching a pattern. @xref{Searching for Articles}.
21000
21001 @menu
21002 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
21003 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
21004 @end menu
21005
21006 @node nnir
21007 @section nnir
21008 @cindex nnir
21009
21010 This section describes how to use @code{nnir} to search for articles
21011 within gnus.
21012
21013 @menu
21014 * What is nnir?:: What does @code{nnir} do?
21015 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
21016 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up @code{nnir}.
21017 @end menu
21018
21019 @node What is nnir?
21020 @subsection What is nnir?
21021
21022 @code{nnir} is a Gnus interface to a number of tools for searching
21023 through mail and news repositories. Different backends (like
21024 @code{nnimap} and @code{nntp}) work with different tools (called
21025 @dfn{engines} in @code{nnir} lingo), but all use the same basic search
21026 interface.
21027
21028 The @code{nnimap} and @code{gmane} search engines should work with no
21029 configuration. Other engines require a local index that needs to be
21030 created and maintained outside of Gnus.
21031
21032
21033 @node Basic Usage
21034 @subsection Basic Usage
21035
21036 In the group buffer typing @kbd{G G} will search the group on the
21037 current line by calling @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. This prompts
21038 for a query string, creates an ephemeral @code{nnir} group containing
21039 the articles that match this query, and takes you to a summary buffer
21040 showing these articles. Articles may then be read, moved and deleted
21041 using the usual commands.
21042
21043 The @code{nnir} group made in this way is an @code{ephemeral} group, and
21044 some changes are not permanent: aside from reading, moving, and
21045 deleting, you can't act on the original article. But there is an
21046 alternative: you can @emph{warp} to the original group for the article
21047 on the current line with @kbd{A W}, aka
21048 @code{gnus-warp-to-article}. Even better, the function
21049 @code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}, bound by default in summary buffers to
21050 @kbd{A T}, will first warp to the original group before it works its
21051 magic and includes all the articles in the thread. From here you can
21052 read, move and delete articles, but also copy them, alter article marks,
21053 whatever. Go nuts.
21054
21055 You say you want to search more than just the group on the current line?
21056 No problem: just process-mark the groups you want to search. You want
21057 even more? Calling for an nnir search with the cursor on a topic heading
21058 will search all the groups under that heading.
21059
21060 Still not enough? OK, in the server buffer
21061 @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group} (now bound to @kbd{G}) will search all
21062 groups from the server on the current line. Too much? Want to ignore
21063 certain groups when searching, like spam groups? Just customize
21064 @code{nnir-ignored-newsgroups}.
21065
21066 One more thing: individual search engines may have special search
21067 features. You can access these special features by giving a prefix-arg
21068 to @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. If you are searching multiple
21069 groups with different search engines you will be prompted for the
21070 special search features for each engine separately.
21071
21072
21073 @node Setting up nnir
21074 @subsection Setting up nnir
21075
21076 To set up nnir you may need to do some prep work. Firstly, you may need
21077 to configure the search engines you plan to use. Some of them, like
21078 @code{imap} and @code{gmane}, need no special configuration. Others,
21079 like @code{namazu} and @code{swish}, require configuration as described
21080 below. Secondly, you need to associate a search engine with a server or
21081 a backend.
21082
21083 If you just want to use the @code{imap} engine to search @code{nnimap}
21084 servers, and the @code{gmane} engine to search @code{gmane} then you
21085 don't have to do anything. But you might want to read the details of the
21086 query language anyway.
21087
21088 @menu
21089 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
21090 * The imap Engine:: Imap configuration and usage.
21091 * The gmane Engine:: Gmane configuration and usage.
21092 * The swish++ Engine:: Swish++ configuration and usage.
21093 * The swish-e Engine:: Swish-e configuration and usage.
21094 * The namazu Engine:: Namazu configuration and usage.
21095 * The hyrex Engine:: Hyrex configuration and usage.
21096 * Customizations:: User customizable settings.
21097 @end menu
21098
21099 @node Associating Engines
21100 @subsubsection Associating Engines
21101
21102
21103 When searching a group, @code{nnir} needs to know which search engine to
21104 use. You can configure a given server to use a particular engine by
21105 setting the server variable @code{nnir-search-engine} to the engine
21106 name. For example to use the @code{namazu} engine to search the server
21107 named @code{home} you can use
21108
21109 @lisp
21110 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
21111 '((nnml "home"
21112 (nnimap-address "localhost")
21113 (nnir-search-engine namazu))))
21114 @end lisp
21115
21116 Alternatively you might want to use a particular engine for all servers
21117 with a given backend. For example, you might want to use the @code{imap}
21118 engine for all servers using the @code{nnimap} backend. In this case you
21119 can customize the variable @code{nnir-method-default-engines}. This is
21120 an alist of pairs of the form @code{(backend . engine)}. By default this
21121 variable is set to use the @code{imap} engine for all servers using the
21122 @code{nnimap} backend, and the @code{gmane} backend for @code{nntp}
21123 servers. (Don't worry, the @code{gmane} search engine won't actually try
21124 to search non-gmane @code{nntp} servers.) But if you wanted to use
21125 @code{namazu} for all your servers with an @code{nnimap} backend you
21126 could change this to
21127
21128 @lisp
21129 '((nnimap . namazu)
21130 (nntp . gmane))
21131 @end lisp
21132
21133 @node The imap Engine
21134 @subsubsection The imap Engine
21135
21136 The @code{imap} engine requires no configuration.
21137
21138 Queries using the @code{imap} engine follow a simple query language.
21139 The search is always case-insensitive and supports the following
21140 features (inspired by the Google search input language):
21141
21142 @table @samp
21143
21144 @item Boolean query operators
21145 AND, OR, and NOT are supported, and parentheses can be used to control
21146 operator precedence, e.g. (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux. Note that
21147 operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21148 recognized. Also preceding a term with a - sign is equivalent to NOT
21149 term.
21150
21151 @item Automatic AND queries
21152 If you specify multiple words then they will be treated as an AND
21153 expression intended to match all components.
21154
21155 @item Phrase searches
21156 If you wrap your query in double-quotes then it will be treated as a
21157 literal string.
21158
21159 @end table
21160
21161 By default the whole message will be searched. The query can be limited
21162 to a specific part of a message by using a prefix-arg. After inputting
21163 the query this will prompt (with completion) for a message part.
21164 Choices include ``Whole message'', ``Subject'', ``From'', and
21165 ``To''. Any unrecognized input is interpreted as a header name. For
21166 example, typing @kbd{Message-ID} in response to this prompt will limit
21167 the query to the Message-ID header.
21168
21169 Finally selecting ``Imap'' will interpret the query as a raw
21170 @acronym{IMAP} search query. The format of such queries can be found in
21171 RFC3501.
21172
21173 If you don't like the default of searching whole messages you can
21174 customize @code{nnir-imap-default-search-key}. For example to use
21175 @acronym{IMAP} queries by default
21176
21177 @lisp
21178 (setq nnir-imap-default-search-key "Imap")
21179 @end lisp
21180
21181 @node The gmane Engine
21182 @subsubsection The gmane Engine
21183
21184 The @code{gmane} engine requires no configuration.
21185
21186 Gmane queries follow a simple query language:
21187
21188 @table @samp
21189 @item Boolean query operators
21190 AND, OR, NOT (or AND NOT), and XOR are supported, and brackets can be
21191 used to control operator precedence, e.g. (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux.
21192 Note that operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21193 recognized.
21194
21195 @item Required and excluded terms
21196 + and - can be used to require or exclude terms, e.g. football -american
21197
21198 @item Unicode handling
21199 The search engine converts all text to utf-8, so searching should work
21200 in any language.
21201
21202 @item Stopwords
21203 Common English words (like 'the' and 'a') are ignored by default. You
21204 can override this by prefixing such words with a + (e.g. +the) or
21205 enclosing the word in quotes (e.g. "the").
21206
21207 @end table
21208
21209 The query can be limited to articles by a specific author using a
21210 prefix-arg. After inputting the query this will prompt for an author
21211 name (or part of a name) to match.
21212
21213 @node The swish++ Engine
21214 @subsubsection The swish++ Engine
21215
21216 FIXME: Say something more here.
21217
21218 Documentation for swish++ may be found at the swish++ sourceforge page:
21219 @uref{http://swishplusplus.sourceforge.net}
21220
21221 @table @code
21222
21223 @item nnir-swish++-program
21224 The name of the swish++ executable. Defaults to @code{search}
21225
21226 @item nnir-swish++-additional-switches
21227 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21228 swish++. @code{nil} by default.
21229
21230 @item nnir-swish++-remove-prefix
21231 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish++ in order
21232 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21233
21234 @end table
21235
21236 @node The swish-e Engine
21237 @subsubsection The swish-e Engine
21238
21239 FIXME: Say something more here.
21240
21241 Documentation for swish-e may be found at the swish-e homepage
21242 @uref{http://swish-e.org}
21243
21244 @table @code
21245
21246 @item nnir-swish-e-program
21247 The name of the swish-e search program. Defaults to @code{swish-e}.
21248
21249 @item nnir-swish-e-additional-switches
21250 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21251 swish-e. @code{nil} by default.
21252
21253 @item nnir-swish-e-remove-prefix
21254 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish-e in order
21255 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21256
21257 @end table
21258
21259 @node The namazu Engine
21260 @subsubsection The namazu Engine
21261
21262 Using the namazu engine requires creating and maintaining index files.
21263 One directory should contain all the index files, and nnir must be told
21264 where to find them by setting the @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory}
21265 variable.
21266
21267 To work correctly the @code{nnir-namazu-remove-prefix} variable must
21268 also be correct. This is the prefix to remove from each file name
21269 returned by Namazu in order to get a proper group name (albeit with `/'
21270 instead of `.').
21271
21272 For example, suppose that Namazu returns file names such as
21273 @samp{/home/john/Mail/mail/misc/42}. For this example, use the
21274 following setting: @code{(setq nnir-namazu-remove-prefix
21275 "/home/john/Mail/")} Note the trailing slash. Removing this prefix from
21276 the directory gives @samp{mail/misc/42}. @code{nnir} knows to remove
21277 the @samp{/42} and to replace @samp{/} with @samp{.} to arrive at the
21278 correct group name @samp{mail.misc}.
21279
21280 Extra switches may be passed to the namazu search command by setting the
21281 variable @code{nnir-namazu-additional-switches}. It is particularly
21282 important not to pass any any switches to namazu that will change the
21283 output format. Good switches to use include `--sort', `--ascending',
21284 `--early' and `--late'. Refer to the Namazu documentation for further
21285 information on valid switches.
21286
21287 Mail must first be indexed with the `mknmz' program. Read the documentation
21288 for namazu to create a configuration file. Here is an example:
21289
21290 @cartouche
21291 @example
21292 package conf; # Don't remove this line!
21293
21294 # Paths which will not be indexed. Don't use `^' or `$' anchors.
21295 $EXCLUDE_PATH = "spam|sent";
21296
21297 # Header fields which should be searchable. case-insensitive
21298 $REMAIN_HEADER = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21299
21300 # Searchable fields. case-insensitive
21301 $SEARCH_FIELD = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21302
21303 # The max length of a word.
21304 $WORD_LENG_MAX = 128;
21305
21306 # The max length of a field.
21307 $MAX_FIELD_LENGTH = 256;
21308 @end example
21309 @end cartouche
21310
21311 For this example, mail is stored in the directories @samp{~/Mail/mail/},
21312 @samp{~/Mail/lists/} and @samp{~/Mail/archive/}, so to index them go to
21313 the index directory set in @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory} and issue
21314 the following command:
21315
21316 @example
21317 mknmz --mailnews ~/Mail/archive/ ~/Mail/mail/ ~/Mail/lists/
21318 @end example
21319
21320 For maximum searching efficiency you might want to have a cron job run
21321 this command periodically, say every four hours.
21322
21323 @node The hyrex Engine
21324 @subsubsection The hyrex Engine
21325 This engine is obsolete.
21326
21327 @node Customizations
21328 @subsubsection Customizations
21329
21330 @table @code
21331
21332 @item nnir-method-default-engines
21333 Alist of server backend - search engine pairs. The default associations
21334 are
21335 @example
21336 (nnimap . imap)
21337 (nntp . gmane)
21338 @end example
21339
21340 @item nnir-ignored-newsgroups
21341 A regexp to match newsgroups in the active file that should be skipped
21342 when searching all groups on a server.
21343
21344 @item nnir-summary-line-format
21345 The format specification to be used for lines in an nnir summary buffer.
21346 All the items from `gnus-summary-line-format' are available, along with
21347 three items unique to nnir summary buffers:
21348
21349 @example
21350 %Z Search retrieval score value (integer)
21351 %G Article original full group name (string)
21352 %g Article original short group name (string)
21353 @end example
21354
21355 If nil (the default) this will use @code{gnus-summary-line-format}.
21356
21357 @item nnir-retrieve-headers-override-function
21358 If non-nil, a function that retrieves article headers rather than using
21359 the gnus built-in function. This function takes an article list and
21360 group as arguments and populates the `nntp-server-buffer' with the
21361 retrieved headers. It should then return either 'nov or 'headers
21362 indicating the retrieved header format. Failure to retrieve headers
21363 should return @code{nil}
21364
21365 If this variable is nil, or if the provided function returns nil for a
21366 search result, @code{gnus-retrieve-headers} will be called instead."
21367
21368
21369 @end table
21370
21371
21372 @node nnmairix
21373 @section nnmairix
21374
21375 @cindex mairix
21376 @cindex nnmairix
21377 This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
21378 @code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
21379 Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
21380 bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
21381
21382 @menu
21383 * About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
21384 * nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
21385 * What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
21386 * Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
21387 * Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
21388 * nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
21389 * Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
21390 * nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
21391 * nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
21392 @end menu
21393
21394 @c FIXME: The markup in this section might need improvement.
21395 @c E.g. adding @samp, @var, @file, @command, etc.
21396 @c Cf. (info "(texinfo)Indicating")
21397
21398 @node About mairix
21399 @subsection About mairix
21400
21401 Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
21402 mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
21403 GPL. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
21404 runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
21405 be found at
21406 @uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
21407
21408 Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
21409 swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
21410 has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
21411 can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
21412 thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
21413 necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
21414 done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
21415 therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
21416 up.
21417
21418 For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
21419 @code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
21420 end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
21421 results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
21422 which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
21423 made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
21424 mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
21425 for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
21426 searches.
21427
21428 @node nnmairix requirements
21429 @subsection nnmairix requirements
21430
21431 Mairix searches local mail---that means, mairix absolutely must have
21432 direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
21433 server (e.g. an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
21434 access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g. via ssh.
21435
21436 Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
21437 ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You must use
21438 one of these back ends for using @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like
21439 @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or @code{nnmh}, won't work.
21440
21441 If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
21442 you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
21443 @code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
21444 files, so just change to MH or Maildir already... However, if you're
21445 really, really passionate about using mbox, you might want to look into
21446 the package @file{mairix.el}, which comes with Emacs 23.
21447
21448 @node What nnmairix does
21449 @subsection What nnmairix does
21450
21451 The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
21452 either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
21453 database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
21454 several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g. to quickly
21455 search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
21456 display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
21457 mails are in different folders.
21458
21459 Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
21460 to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
21461 containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
21462 even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID. If you check for
21463 new mail in these folders (e.g. by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
21464 automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
21465
21466 You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
21467 creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
21468 then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
21469 does not---at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
21470 strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
21471 claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
21472 the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
21473 its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g. if you
21474 use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
21475 about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
21476 group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
21477
21478 @code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end---it's actually more like
21479 a wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores
21480 the searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three
21481 different mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml},
21482 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix
21483 binary so that the search results are stored in folders named
21484 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
21485 present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}.
21486 You can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail,
21487 but if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail
21488 groups alongside your other mail, you can also create e.g. a new
21489 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml} server exclusively for mairix, but then
21490 make sure those servers do not accidentally receive your new mail
21491 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). A special case exists if you want to use
21492 mairix remotely on an IMAP server with @code{nnimap}---here the mairix
21493 folders and your other mail must be on the same @code{nnimap} back end.
21494
21495 @node Setting up mairix
21496 @subsection Setting up mairix
21497
21498 First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
21499
21500 Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
21501 (at least) the following entries:
21502
21503 @example
21504 # Your Maildir/MH base folder
21505 base=~/Maildir
21506 @end example
21507
21508 This is the base folder for your mails. All the following directories
21509 are relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix}
21510 with @code{nnimap}, this base directory has to point to the mail
21511 directory where the @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
21512
21513 @example
21514 maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
21515 mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
21516 mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
21517 @end example
21518
21519 This specifies all your mail folders and mbox files (relative to the
21520 base directory!) you want to index with mairix. Note that the
21521 @code{nnml} back end saves mails in MH format, so you have to put those
21522 directories in the @code{mh} line. See the example at the end of this
21523 section and mairixrc's man-page for further details.
21524
21525 @example
21526 omit=zz_mairix-*
21527 @end example
21528
21529 @vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
21530 This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
21531 search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
21532 variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
21533
21534 @example
21535 mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
21536 database= ... location of database file ...
21537 @end example
21538
21539 The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
21540 search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
21541 with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
21542
21543 To summarize, here is my shortened @file{.mairixrc} file as an example:
21544
21545 @example
21546 base=~/Maildir
21547 maildir=.personal:.work:.logcheck:.sent
21548 mh=../Mail/nnml/*...
21549 mbox=../mboxmail/mailarchive_year*
21550 mformat=maildir
21551 omit=zz_mairix-*
21552 database=~/.mairixdatabase
21553 @end example
21554
21555 In this case, the base directory is @file{~/Maildir}, where all my Maildir
21556 folders are stored. As you can see, the folders are separated by
21557 colons. If you wonder why every folder begins with a dot: this is
21558 because I use Dovecot as @acronym{IMAP} server, which again uses
21559 @code{Maildir++} folders. For testing nnmairix, I also have some
21560 @code{nnml} mail, which is saved in @file{~/Mail/nnml}. Since this has
21561 to be specified relative to the @code{base} directory, the @code{../Mail}
21562 notation is needed. Note that the line ends in @code{*...}, which means
21563 to recursively scan all files under this directory. Without the three
21564 dots, the wildcard @code{*} will not work recursively. I also have some
21565 old mbox files with archived mail lying around in @file{~/mboxmail}.
21566 The other lines should be obvious.
21567
21568 See the man page for @code{mairixrc} for details and further options,
21569 especially regarding wildcard usage, which may be a little different
21570 than you are used to.
21571
21572 Now simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
21573 Note that this may take a few minutes, but every following index will do
21574 the updates incrementally and hence is very fast.
21575
21576 @node Configuring nnmairix
21577 @subsection Configuring nnmairix
21578
21579 In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
21580 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
21581 necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
21582 server. You will have to specify the following:
21583
21584 @itemize @bullet
21585
21586 @item
21587 The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server---choose whatever you
21588 want.
21589
21590 @item
21591 The name of the @strong{back end server} where mairix should store its
21592 searches. This must be a full server name, like @code{nnml:mymail}.
21593 Just hit @kbd{TAB} to see the available servers. Currently, servers
21594 which are accessed through @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and
21595 @code{nnml} are supported. As explained above, for locally stored
21596 mails, this can be an existing server where you store your mails.
21597 However, you can also create e.g. a new @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml}
21598 server exclusively for @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods
21599 (@pxref{Finding the News}). If you use a secondary @code{nnml} server
21600 just for mairix, make sure that you explicitly set the server variable
21601 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}, or you might lose mail
21602 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an
21603 @acronym{IMAP} server, you have to choose the corresponding
21604 @code{nnimap} server here.
21605
21606 @item
21607 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
21608 The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
21609 be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
21610 SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g. on your
21611 @acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
21612 mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
21613 @code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
21614
21615 @item
21616 The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
21617 where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e. all searches which
21618 are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
21619 like.
21620
21621 @item
21622 If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
21623 asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e. with hidden maildir
21624 folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
21625 @samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
21626 server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
21627
21628 @end itemize
21629
21630 @node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21631 @subsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21632
21633 In group mode:
21634
21635 @table @kbd
21636
21637 @item G b c
21638 @kindex G b c (Group)
21639 @findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
21640 Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
21641 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
21642 this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
21643
21644 @item G b s
21645 @kindex G b s (Group)
21646 @findex nnmairix-search
21647 Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
21648 results are put into the default search group which is automatically
21649 displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
21650
21651 @item G b m
21652 @kindex G b m (Group)
21653 @findex nnmairix-widget-search
21654 Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
21655 comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
21656 group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
21657
21658 @item G b i
21659 @kindex G b i (Group)
21660 @findex nnmairix-search-interactive
21661 Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
21662 only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
21663
21664 @item G b g
21665 @kindex G b g (Group)
21666 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group
21667 Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
21668 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
21669 automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
21670 @kbd{M-g}.
21671
21672 @item G b q
21673 @kindex G b q (Group)
21674 @findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
21675 Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
21676 (@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
21677
21678 @item G b t
21679 @kindex G b t (Group)
21680 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
21681 Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
21682 i.e. if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
21683 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
21684
21685 @item G b u
21686 @kindex G b u (Group)
21687 @findex nnmairix-update-database
21688 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
21689 Calls mairix binary for updating the database
21690 (@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
21691 and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
21692 @code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
21693 options).
21694
21695 @item G b r
21696 @kindex G b r (Group)
21697 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
21698 Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
21699 marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
21700
21701 @item G b d
21702 @kindex G b d (Group)
21703 @findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
21704 Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
21705 (@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
21706 you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
21707
21708 @item G b a
21709 @kindex G b a (Group)
21710 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
21711 Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
21712 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
21713 behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
21714 update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
21715 mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
21716 upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
21717 lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
21718 entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
21719
21720 @item G b p
21721 @kindex G b p (Group)
21722 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
21723 Toggle marks propagation for this group
21724 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
21725 marks}).
21726
21727 @item G b o
21728 @kindex G b o (Group)
21729 @findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
21730 Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
21731 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
21732
21733 @end table
21734
21735 In summary mode:
21736
21737 @table @kbd
21738
21739 @item $ m
21740 @kindex $ m (Summary)
21741 @findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
21742 Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
21743 message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
21744 (@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
21745
21746 @item $ g
21747 @kindex $ g (Summary)
21748 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
21749 Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
21750 message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
21751 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
21752
21753 @item $ t
21754 @kindex $ t (Summary)
21755 @findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
21756 Searches thread for the current article
21757 (@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
21758 shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
21759 current article and enabled threads.
21760
21761 @item $ f
21762 @kindex $ f (Summary)
21763 @findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
21764 Searches all messages from sender of the current article
21765 (@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
21766 calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
21767
21768 @item $ o
21769 @kindex $ o (Summary)
21770 @findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
21771 (Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
21772 originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that
21773 e.g. replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
21774 parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
21775 function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
21776 article file name as a fallback method.
21777
21778 @item $ u
21779 @kindex $ u (Summary)
21780 @findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
21781 Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
21782 (@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
21783 tips and tricks}).
21784
21785 @end table
21786
21787 @node Propagating marks
21788 @subsection Propagating marks
21789
21790 First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
21791 propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
21792 the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
21793
21794 @uref{http://www.randomsample.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
21795
21796 You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
21797 is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
21798 marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
21799 fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
21800 be useful to you.
21801
21802 With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
21803 alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
21804 example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
21805 into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
21806 @samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
21807 all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
21808 create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
21809 can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
21810 implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
21811 groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
21812
21813 There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
21814 @samp{david@@foobar.com}; it will now show up in two groups, the
21815 ``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
21816 search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
21817 enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
21818 marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group---in the ``real''
21819 mail group it will be still shown as unread.
21820
21821 You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
21822 tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
21823 created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
21824 @code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
21825 shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
21826 even more cumbersome.
21827
21828 Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
21829 automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
21830 @emph{marks propagation} is about.
21831
21832 Marks propagation is inactive by default. You can activate it for a
21833 certain @code{nnmairix} group with
21834 @code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
21835 p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
21836 search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
21837 temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
21838 this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
21839
21840 With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
21841 group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
21842 you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
21843 magically be set for the original article, too.
21844
21845 A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
21846
21847 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
21848 Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
21849 not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
21850 dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
21851 will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
21852 via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
21853 details).
21854
21855 Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
21856 article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first use
21857 the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
21858 fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
21859 marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
21860 set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
21861 the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
21862
21863 @vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
21864 If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
21865 original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix
21866 search for determining the file name of the article. This, of course, is
21867 way slower than the registry---if you set hundreds or even thousands of
21868 marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation by
21869 setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to t.
21870
21871 Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e. if you
21872 tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
21873 article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
21874 reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
21875 immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
21876 @code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
21877 not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
21878 groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
21879 maildir as its file format.
21880
21881 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
21882 If you work with this setup, just set
21883 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
21884 happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again. One
21885 problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
21886 usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
21887 groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on the
21888 back end using @kbd{G b d}.
21889
21890 @node nnmairix tips and tricks
21891 @subsection nnmairix tips and tricks
21892
21893 @itemize
21894 @item
21895 Checking Mail
21896
21897 @findex nnmairix-update-groups
21898 I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
21899 have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
21900 Levels}).
21901
21902 I use the following to check for mails:
21903
21904 @lisp
21905 (defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
21906 (interactive "P")
21907 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
21908 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
21909 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
21910 (gnus-group-list-groups))
21911
21912 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
21913 @end lisp
21914
21915 Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
21916 server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
21917 details.
21918
21919 @item
21920 Example: search group for ticked articles
21921
21922 For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
21923 articles always stay unread:
21924
21925 Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g. @samp{important}), use
21926 @samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
21927
21928 Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
21929 activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
21930
21931 So far so good---but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
21932 group? There are two options: You may simply use
21933 @code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
21934 tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
21935 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
21936 comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
21937 also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
21938 e.g. by marking an article as read.
21939
21940 When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
21941 article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
21942 mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
21943 for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
21944 snippet and the doc string for details.
21945
21946 @item
21947 Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
21948
21949 As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
21950 the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
21951 see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
21952 should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
21953 usually get @emph{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
21954 @code{nnml}, i.e. you will suddenly see groups of the form
21955 @samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
21956 simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
21957 auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
21958 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
21959 Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
21960 for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
21961
21962 @lisp
21963 (setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
21964 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
21965 @end lisp
21966
21967 @end itemize
21968
21969 @node nnmairix caveats
21970 @subsection nnmairix caveats
21971
21972 @itemize
21973 @item
21974 You can create a secondary @code{nnml} server just for nnmairix, but then
21975 you have to explicitly set the corresponding server variable
21976 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}. Otherwise, new mail might get
21977 put into this secondary server (and would never show up again). Here's
21978 an example server definition:
21979
21980 @lisp
21981 (nnml "mairix" (nnml-directory "mairix") (nnml-get-new-mail nil))
21982 @end lisp
21983
21984 (The @code{nnmaildir} back end also has a server variable
21985 @code{get-new-mail}, but its default value is @code{nil}, so you don't
21986 have to explicitly set it if you use a @code{nnmaildir} server just for
21987 mairix.)
21988
21989 @item
21990 If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
21991 @code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
21992 @code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}; this is the default). Be
21993 @emph{extra careful} if you use
21994 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}; mails which are split
21995 into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as you
21996 check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
21997
21998 @item
21999 Therefore: @emph{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
22000 groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
22001
22002 @item
22003 If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
22004 @code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
22005
22006 @item
22007 mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
22008
22009 @item
22010 @code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
22011 completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
22012 called---it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
22013 back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
22014 don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
22015 own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
22016 folders.
22017
22018 @item
22019 All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
22020 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
22021 is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
22022 it is gone for good.
22023
22024 @item
22025 @findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
22026 If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
22027 ``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
22028 delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
22029 @code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
22030 save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
22031 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
22032 @code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
22033 @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
22034
22035 @item
22036 The following only applies if you @emph{don't} use the mentioned patch
22037 for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
22038
22039 A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
22040 comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
22041 @samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
22042 file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
22043 update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
22044 mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
22045 while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
22046 @samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
22047 after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
22048 non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
22049 ``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
22050 to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
22051
22052 @end itemize
22053
22054 @iftex
22055 @iflatex
22056 @chapter Message
22057 @include message.texi
22058 @chapter Emacs MIME
22059 @include emacs-mime.texi
22060 @chapter Sieve
22061 @include sieve.texi
22062 @chapter EasyPG
22063 @include epa.texi
22064 @chapter SASL
22065 @include sasl.texi
22066 @end iflatex
22067 @end iftex
22068
22069 @node Various
22070 @chapter Various
22071
22072 @menu
22073 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
22074 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
22075 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
22076 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
22077 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
22078 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
22079 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
22080 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
22081 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
22082 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
22083 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
22084 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
22085 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
22086 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
22087 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
22088 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
22089 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
22090 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
22091 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
22092 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
22093 @end menu
22094
22095
22096 @node Process/Prefix
22097 @section Process/Prefix
22098 @cindex process/prefix convention
22099
22100 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
22101 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
22102
22103 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
22104 command to be performed on.
22105
22106 It goes like this:
22107
22108 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
22109 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
22110 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
22111 with the current one.
22112
22113 @vindex transient-mark-mode
22114 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
22115 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
22116
22117 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
22118 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
22119 the process mark.
22120
22121 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
22122 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
22123
22124 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
22125 are avoided.
22126
22127 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
22128 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
22129 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
22130 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
22131
22132 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
22133 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
22134 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
22135 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
22136 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
22137 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
22138 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
22139 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
22140
22141 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
22142 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
22143 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
22144 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
22145 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
22146
22147
22148 @node Interactive
22149 @section Interactive
22150 @cindex interaction
22151
22152 @table @code
22153
22154 @item gnus-novice-user
22155 @vindex gnus-novice-user
22156 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
22157 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
22158 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
22159 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
22160 default.
22161
22162 @item gnus-expert-user
22163 @vindex gnus-expert-user
22164 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
22165 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing,
22166 no matter how strange. For example, quitting Gnus, exiting a group
22167 without an update, catching up with a group, deleting expired
22168 articles, and replying by mail to a news message will not require
22169 confirmation.
22170
22171 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
22172 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
22173 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
22174 is @code{t} by default.
22175
22176 @item gnus-interactive-exit
22177 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
22178 If non-@code{nil}, require a confirmation when exiting Gnus. If
22179 @code{quiet}, update any active summary buffers automatically without
22180 querying. The default value is @code{t}.
22181 @end table
22182
22183
22184 @node Symbolic Prefixes
22185 @section Symbolic Prefixes
22186 @cindex symbolic prefixes
22187
22188 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
22189 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
22190 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
22191 rule of 900 to the current article.
22192
22193 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
22194 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
22195 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
22196 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
22197 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
22198 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
22199 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
22200
22201 @kindex M-i (Summary)
22202 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
22203 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
22204 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
22205 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
22206 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
22207 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
22208 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
22209 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
22210
22211 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
22212 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
22213 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
22214
22215 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
22216 Interactive}.
22217
22218
22219 @node Formatting Variables
22220 @section Formatting Variables
22221 @cindex formatting variables
22222
22223 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
22224 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
22225 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
22226 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
22227 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
22228 be annoyed by.
22229
22230 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
22231 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
22232 lots of percentages everywhere.
22233
22234 @menu
22235 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
22236 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
22237 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
22238 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
22239 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
22240 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
22241 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
22242 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
22243 @end menu
22244
22245 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
22246 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
22247 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
22248 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
22249 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
22250 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
22251 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
22252 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
22253
22254 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
22255 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
22256
22257 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
22258 @findex gnus-update-format
22259 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
22260 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
22261 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
22262 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
22263
22264
22265
22266 @node Formatting Basics
22267 @subsection Formatting Basics
22268
22269 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
22270 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
22271 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
22272
22273 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
22274 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
22275 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
22276 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
22277 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
22278 the right instead.
22279
22280 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
22281 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
22282 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
22283 less than 4 characters wide.
22284
22285 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
22286 @samp{%&user-date;}.
22287
22288
22289 @node Mode Line Formatting
22290 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
22291
22292 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
22293 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
22294 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
22295 with the following two differences:
22296
22297 @enumerate
22298
22299 @item
22300 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
22301
22302 @item
22303 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
22304 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
22305 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
22306 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
22307 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
22308 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
22309 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
22310
22311 @end enumerate
22312
22313
22314 @node Advanced Formatting
22315 @subsection Advanced Formatting
22316
22317 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
22318 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
22319 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
22320 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
22321
22322 These are the valid modifiers:
22323
22324 @table @code
22325 @item pad
22326 @itemx pad-left
22327 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
22328 length.
22329
22330 @item pad-right
22331 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
22332 length.
22333
22334 @item max
22335 @itemx max-left
22336 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
22337
22338 @item max-right
22339 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
22340 length.
22341
22342 @item cut
22343 @itemx cut-left
22344 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
22345
22346 @item cut-right
22347 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
22348
22349 @item ignore
22350 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
22351
22352 @item form
22353 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
22354 used.
22355
22356 Here's an example:
22357
22358 @lisp
22359 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
22360 @end lisp
22361
22362 @end table
22363
22364 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
22365 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
22366 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
22367 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
22368 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
22369 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
22370 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
22371
22372 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
22373 last operation, padding.
22374
22375
22376 @node User-Defined Specs
22377 @subsection User-Defined Specs
22378
22379 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
22380 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
22381 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
22382 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
22383 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
22384 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
22385 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
22386 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
22387 should protect against that.
22388
22389 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
22390 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
22391
22392 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
22393 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
22394 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
22395 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
22396 inserted.
22397
22398
22399 @node Formatting Fonts
22400 @subsection Formatting Fonts
22401
22402 @cindex %(, %)
22403 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22404 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
22405 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
22406 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
22407 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
22408 over it.
22409
22410 @cindex %@{, %@}
22411 @vindex gnus-face-0
22412 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
22413 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
22414 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
22415 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
22416 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
22417 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
22418
22419 @cindex %<<, %>>, guillemets
22420 @c @cindex %<<, %>>, %«, %», guillemets
22421 @vindex gnus-balloon-face-0
22422 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
22423 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
22424 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
22425 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
22426 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
22427 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
22428 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
22429 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
22430 (in Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
22431 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
22432 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
22433 paragraph.)
22434
22435 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
22436
22437 @lisp
22438 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
22439 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
22440 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
22441
22442 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
22443 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
22444 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
22445 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
22446 ;; @r{Set the color.}
22447 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
22448 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
22449
22450 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
22451 (setq gnus-group-line-format
22452 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
22453 @end lisp
22454
22455 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
22456 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
22457
22458 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
22459 mode-line variables.
22460
22461 @node Positioning Point
22462 @subsection Positioning Point
22463
22464 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
22465 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
22466 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
22467
22468 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
22469
22470 @findex gnus-goto-colon
22471 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
22472 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
22473
22474 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
22475 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
22476 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
22477 place point there.
22478
22479
22480 @node Tabulation
22481 @subsection Tabulation
22482
22483 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
22484 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
22485 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
22486 about lining up the following text afterwards.
22487
22488 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
22489 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
22490
22491 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22492 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
22493 This is the soft tabulator.
22494
22495 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22496 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
22497 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
22498
22499
22500 @node Wide Characters
22501 @subsection Wide Characters
22502
22503 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
22504 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
22505 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
22506
22507 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
22508 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
22509 these countries, that's not true.
22510
22511 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
22512 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
22513 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
22514 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
22515 for Emacs.
22516
22517
22518 @node Window Layout
22519 @section Window Layout
22520 @cindex window layout
22521
22522 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
22523
22524 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
22525 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
22526 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
22527 @code{t} by default.
22528
22529 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
22530 glitches. Use at your own peril.
22531
22532 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
22533 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
22534 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
22535
22536 @lisp
22537 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)))
22538 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22539 (article 1.0))))
22540 @end lisp
22541
22542 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
22543 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
22544 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
22545 possible names is listed below.
22546
22547 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
22548 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
22549
22550 @lisp
22551 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22552 (article 1.0)))
22553 @end lisp
22554
22555 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
22556 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
22557 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
22558 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
22559 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
22560 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
22561 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
22562 size spec per split.
22563
22564 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
22565 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
22566 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
22567 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
22568 present) gets focus.
22569
22570 Here's a more complicated example:
22571
22572 @lisp
22573 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
22574 (summary 0.25 point)
22575 (article 1.0)))
22576 @end lisp
22577
22578 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
22579 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
22580 occupy, not a percentage.
22581
22582 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
22583 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
22584 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
22585 be used as a split.
22586
22587 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
22588
22589 @lisp
22590 (article (horizontal 1.0
22591 (vertical 0.5
22592 (group 1.0))
22593 (vertical 1.0
22594 (summary 0.25 point)
22595 (article 1.0))))
22596 @end lisp
22597
22598 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
22599 @code{horizontal} thingie?
22600
22601 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
22602 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
22603 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
22604 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
22605 the screen is to be given to this strip.
22606
22607 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
22608 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
22609 lines from the splits.
22610
22611 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
22612 may look like:
22613
22614 @example
22615 @group
22616 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
22617 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
22618 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
22619 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
22620 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
22621 size = number | frame-params
22622 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
22623 @end group
22624 @end example
22625
22626 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
22627 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
22628 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
22629 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
22630
22631 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
22632 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
22633 @cindex window height
22634 @cindex window width
22635 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
22636 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
22637 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
22638 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
22639 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
22640 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
22641
22642 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
22643 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
22644 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
22645 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
22646
22647 @findex gnus-configure-frame
22648 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
22649 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
22650 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
22651 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
22652 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
22653 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
22654 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
22655 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
22656 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
22657 configuration list.
22658
22659 @lisp
22660 (gnus-configure-frame
22661 '(horizontal 1.0
22662 (vertical 10
22663 (group 1.0)
22664 (article 0.3 point))
22665 (vertical 1.0
22666 (article 1.0)
22667 (horizontal 4
22668 (group 1.0)
22669 (article 10)))))
22670 @end lisp
22671
22672 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
22673 @code{frame} split:
22674
22675 @lisp
22676 (gnus-configure-frame
22677 '(frame 1.0
22678 (vertical 1.0
22679 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
22680 (article 1.0))
22681 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
22682 (user-position . t)
22683 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22684 (picon 1.0))))
22685
22686 @end lisp
22687
22688 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22689 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22690 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22691 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22692 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22693 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22694 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22695 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22696 is such a plist.
22697 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22698 be found in its default value.
22699
22700 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22701 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22702 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22703 might be used:
22704
22705 @lisp
22706 (message (horizontal 1.0
22707 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22708 (vertical 0.24
22709 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22710 '(summary 0.5))
22711 (group 1.0))))
22712 @end lisp
22713
22714 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22715 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22716 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22717
22718 @lisp
22719 (message
22720 (frame 1.0
22721 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22722 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22723 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22724 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22725 (name . "Message"))
22726 (message 1.0 point))))
22727 @end lisp
22728
22729 @findex gnus-add-configuration
22730 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22731 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22732 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22733 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22734
22735 @lisp
22736 (gnus-add-configuration
22737 '(article (vertical 1.0
22738 (group 4)
22739 (summary .25 point)
22740 (article 1.0))))
22741 @end lisp
22742
22743 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22744 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22745 Gnus has been loaded.
22746
22747 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22748 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22749 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22750 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
22751 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22752
22753 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22754 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22755 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22756 windows resized.
22757
22758 @subsection Window Configuration Names
22759
22760 Here's a list of most of the currently known window configurations,
22761 and when they're used:
22762
22763 @table @code
22764 @item group
22765 The group buffer.
22766
22767 @item summary
22768 Entering a group and showing only the summary.
22769
22770 @item article
22771 Selecting an article.
22772
22773 @item server
22774 The server buffer.
22775
22776 @item browse
22777 Browsing groups from the server buffer.
22778
22779 @item message
22780 Composing a (new) message.
22781
22782 @item only-article
22783 Showing only the article buffer.
22784
22785 @item edit-article
22786 Editing an article.
22787
22788 @item edit-form
22789 Editing group parameters and the like.
22790
22791 @item edit-score
22792 Editing a server definition.
22793
22794 @item post
22795 Composing a news message.
22796
22797 @item reply
22798 Replying or following up an article without yanking the text.
22799
22800 @item forward
22801 Forwarding a message.
22802
22803 @item reply-yank
22804 Replying or following up an article with yanking the text.
22805
22806 @item mail-bound
22807 Bouncing a message.
22808
22809 @item pipe
22810 Sending an article to an external process.
22811
22812 @item bug
22813 Sending a bug report.
22814
22815 @item score-trace
22816 Displaying the score trace.
22817
22818 @item score-words
22819 Displaying the score words.
22820
22821 @item split-trace
22822 Displaying the split trace.
22823
22824 @item compose-bounce
22825 Composing a bounce message.
22826
22827 @item mml-preview
22828 Previewing a @acronym{MIME} part.
22829
22830 @end table
22831
22832
22833 @subsection Example Window Configurations
22834
22835 @itemize @bullet
22836 @item
22837 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22838 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22839
22840 @ifinfo
22841 @example
22842 +---+---------+
22843 | G | Summary |
22844 | r +---------+
22845 | o | |
22846 | u | Article |
22847 | p | |
22848 +---+---------+
22849 @end example
22850 @end ifinfo
22851
22852 @lisp
22853 (gnus-add-configuration
22854 '(article
22855 (horizontal 1.0
22856 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22857 (vertical 1.0
22858 (summary 0.16 point)
22859 (article 1.0)))))
22860
22861 (gnus-add-configuration
22862 '(summary
22863 (horizontal 1.0
22864 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22865 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22866 @end lisp
22867
22868 @end itemize
22869
22870
22871 @node Faces and Fonts
22872 @section Faces and Fonts
22873 @cindex faces
22874 @cindex fonts
22875 @cindex colors
22876
22877 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22878 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22879 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
22880 interface.
22881
22882
22883 @node Mode Lines
22884 @section Mode Lines
22885 @cindex mode lines
22886
22887 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
22888 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
22889 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
22890 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
22891 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
22892 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
22893 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
22894 quicker.
22895
22896 @cindex display-time
22897
22898 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
22899 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
22900 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
22901 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
22902 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
22903 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
22904 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
22905 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
22906 this variable:
22907
22908 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
22909 @lisp
22910 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
22911 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
22912 (+ 21
22913 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
22914 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
22915 (length display-time-string)))))
22916 @end lisp
22917
22918 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
22919 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
22920 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
22921 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
22922 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
22923
22924
22925 @node Highlighting and Menus
22926 @section Highlighting and Menus
22927 @cindex visual
22928 @cindex highlighting
22929 @cindex menus
22930
22931 @vindex gnus-visual
22932 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
22933 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
22934 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
22935 file.
22936
22937 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
22938 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
22939
22940 @table @code
22941 @item group-highlight
22942 Do highlights in the group buffer.
22943 @item summary-highlight
22944 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
22945 @item article-highlight
22946 Do highlights in the article buffer.
22947 @item highlight
22948 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
22949 @item group-menu
22950 Create menus in the group buffer.
22951 @item summary-menu
22952 Create menus in the summary buffers.
22953 @item article-menu
22954 Create menus in the article buffer.
22955 @item browse-menu
22956 Create menus in the browse buffer.
22957 @item server-menu
22958 Create menus in the server buffer.
22959 @item score-menu
22960 Create menus in the score buffers.
22961 @item menu
22962 Create menus in all buffers.
22963 @end table
22964
22965 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
22966 buffers, you could say something like:
22967
22968 @lisp
22969 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
22970 @end lisp
22971
22972 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
22973
22974 @lisp
22975 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
22976 @end lisp
22977
22978 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
22979 in all Gnus buffers.
22980
22981 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
22982
22983 @table @code
22984 @item gnus-mouse-face
22985 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22986 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
22987 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
22988
22989 @end table
22990
22991 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
22992
22993 @table @code
22994
22995 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
22996 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
22997 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
22998
22999 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
23000 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
23001 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
23002
23003 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
23004 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
23005 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
23006
23007 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
23008 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
23009 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
23010
23011 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
23012 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
23013 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
23014
23015 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
23016 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
23017 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
23018
23019 @end table
23020
23021
23022 @node Daemons
23023 @section Daemons
23024 @cindex demons
23025 @cindex daemons
23026
23027 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
23028 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
23029 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
23030 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
23031 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
23032
23033 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
23034 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
23035 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
23036
23037 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
23038 been idle for thirty minutes:
23039
23040 @lisp
23041 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
23042 @end lisp
23043
23044 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
23045 Emacs is idle:
23046
23047 @lisp
23048 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
23049 @end lisp
23050
23051 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
23052 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
23053 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23054
23055 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
23056 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
23057 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
23058 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23059
23060 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
23061 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
23062 @var{idle} minutes.
23063
23064 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
23065 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
23066 minutes.
23067
23068 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
23069 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
23070 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
23071
23072 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
23073 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
23074 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
23075 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
23076
23077 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
23078 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23079
23080 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
23081 @lisp
23082 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
23083 @end lisp
23084
23085 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
23086 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
23087 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
23088 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
23089 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
23090 @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
23091 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
23092 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
23093 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
23094 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
23095
23096 @findex gnus-demon-init
23097 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
23098 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
23099 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
23100 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
23101 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
23102
23103 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
23104 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
23105 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
23106 behave.
23107
23108
23109 @node Undo
23110 @section Undo
23111 @cindex undo
23112
23113 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
23114 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
23115 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
23116
23117 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
23118 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
23119 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
23120 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
23121 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
23122 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
23123 @code{undo} function.
23124
23125 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
23126 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
23127 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
23128 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
23129 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
23130 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
23131 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
23132 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
23133 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
23134 never be totally undoable.
23135
23136 @findex gnus-undo-mode
23137 @vindex gnus-use-undo
23138 @findex gnus-undo
23139 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
23140 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
23141 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
23142 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
23143 command.
23144
23145
23146 @node Predicate Specifiers
23147 @section Predicate Specifiers
23148 @cindex predicate specifiers
23149
23150 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
23151 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
23152 to type all that much.
23153
23154 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
23155
23156 Here's an example:
23157
23158 @lisp
23159 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
23160 gnus-article-unread-p)
23161 @end lisp
23162
23163 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
23164 functions all take one parameter.
23165
23166 @findex gnus-make-predicate
23167 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
23168 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
23169 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
23170 specifier.
23171
23172
23173 @node Moderation
23174 @section Moderation
23175 @cindex moderation
23176
23177 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
23178 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
23179 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
23180 get a copy.
23181
23182 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
23183 buffers. Put
23184
23185 @lisp
23186 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
23187 @end lisp
23188
23189 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
23190
23191 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
23192 supposed to work:
23193
23194 @enumerate
23195 @item
23196 You split your incoming mail by matching on
23197 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
23198 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
23199
23200 @item
23201 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
23202 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
23203
23204 @item
23205 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
23206 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
23207 @kbd{c} command.
23208 @end enumerate
23209
23210 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
23211
23212 @lisp
23213 (setq gnus-moderated-list
23214 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
23215 @end lisp
23216
23217
23218 @node Fetching a Group
23219 @section Fetching a Group
23220 @cindex fetching a group
23221
23222 @findex gnus-fetch-group
23223 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
23224 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
23225 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
23226 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
23227 It takes the group name as a parameter.
23228
23229
23230 @node Image Enhancements
23231 @section Image Enhancements
23232
23233 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
23234 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
23235 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
23236
23237 @menu
23238 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
23239 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
23240 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
23241 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
23242 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
23243 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
23244 @end menu
23245
23246
23247 @node X-Face
23248 @subsection X-Face
23249 @cindex x-face
23250
23251 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
23252 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
23253 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
23254 readers.
23255
23256 @cindex x-face
23257 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
23258 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
23259 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
23260 @iftex
23261 @iflatex
23262 \include{xface}
23263 @end iflatex
23264 @end iftex
23265 @c @anchor{X-Face}
23266
23267 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
23268 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
23269 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
23270 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
23271 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
23272 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
23273 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
23274 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
23275 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
23276 @code{display} program.
23277
23278 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
23279 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
23280 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
23281 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
23282 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
23283 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
23284 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
23285 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
23286
23287 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
23288 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
23289 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
23290 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
23291 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
23292 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
23293
23294 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
23295 @code{xface}).
23296
23297 @noindent
23298 Face and variable:
23299
23300 @table @code
23301 @item gnus-x-face
23302 @vindex gnus-x-face
23303 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
23304 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
23305 default colors are black and white.
23306
23307 @item gnus-face-properties-alist
23308 @vindex gnus-face-properties-alist
23309 Alist of image types and properties applied to Face (@pxref{Face}) and
23310 X-Face images. The default value is @code{((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face))
23311 (png . nil))} for Emacs or @code{((xface . (:face gnus-x-face)))} for
23312 XEmacs. Here are examples:
23313
23314 @lisp
23315 ;; Specify the altitude of Face and X-Face images in the From header.
23316 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23317 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :ascent 80))
23318 (png . (:ascent 80))))
23319
23320 ;; Show Face and X-Face images as pressed buttons.
23321 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23322 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :relief -2))
23323 (png . (:relief -2))))
23324 @end lisp
23325
23326 @pxref{Image Descriptors, ,Image Descriptors, elisp, The Emacs Lisp
23327 Reference Manual} for the valid properties for various image types.
23328 Currently, @code{pbm} is used for X-Face images and @code{png} is used
23329 for Face images in Emacs. Only the @code{:face} property is effective
23330 on the @code{xface} image type in XEmacs if it is built with the
23331 @samp{libcompface} library.
23332 @end table
23333
23334 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
23335 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
23336 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
23337 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
23338 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
23339 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
23340
23341 @findex gnus-random-x-face
23342 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
23343 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
23344 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
23345 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
23346 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
23347 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
23348 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
23349 header data as a string.
23350
23351 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
23352 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
23353 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
23354 randomly generated data.
23355
23356 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
23357 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
23358 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
23359 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
23360 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
23361
23362 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
23363 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23364
23365 @lisp
23366 (setq message-required-news-headers
23367 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23368 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
23369 @end lisp
23370
23371 Using the last function would be something like this:
23372
23373 @lisp
23374 (setq message-required-news-headers
23375 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23376 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
23377 (gnus-x-face-from-file
23378 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
23379 @end lisp
23380
23381
23382 @node Face
23383 @subsection Face
23384 @cindex face
23385
23386 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
23387
23388 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
23389 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
23390 represent the author of the message.
23391
23392 @cindex face
23393 @findex gnus-article-display-face
23394 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
23395 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
23396 specifications.
23397
23398 The @code{gnus-face-properties-alist} variable affects the appearance of
23399 displayed Face images. @xref{X-Face}.
23400
23401 Viewing a @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
23402 PNG images.
23403 @c Maybe add this:
23404 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
23405 @c (featurep 'png)
23406 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
23407
23408 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
23409 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
23410
23411 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
23412 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
23413 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
23414
23415 @findex gnus-face-from-file
23416 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
23417 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
23418 converts the file to Face format by using the
23419 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
23420
23421 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
23422 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23423
23424 @lisp
23425 (setq message-required-news-headers
23426 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23427 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
23428 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
23429 @end lisp
23430
23431
23432 @node Smileys
23433 @subsection Smileys
23434 @cindex smileys
23435
23436 @iftex
23437 @iflatex
23438 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
23439 \input{smiley}
23440 @end iflatex
23441 @end iftex
23442
23443 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
23444 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
23445
23446 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
23447 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23448
23449 @lisp
23450 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
23451 @end lisp
23452
23453 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
23454 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
23455 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
23456 text and maps that to file names.
23457
23458 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
23459 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
23460 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
23461 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
23462 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
23463 displayed.
23464
23465 The following variables customize the appearance of the smileys:
23466
23467 @table @code
23468
23469 @item smiley-style
23470 @vindex smiley-style
23471 Specifies the smiley style. Predefined smiley styles include
23472 @code{low-color} (small 13x14 pixel, three-color images), @code{medium}
23473 (more colorful images, 16x16 pixel), and @code{grayscale} (grayscale
23474 images, 14x14 pixel). The default depends on the height of the default
23475 face.
23476
23477 @item smiley-data-directory
23478 @vindex smiley-data-directory
23479 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files. You shouldn't set this
23480 variable anymore. Customize @code{smiley-style} instead.
23481
23482 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
23483 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
23484 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
23485
23486 @end table
23487
23488
23489 @node Picons
23490 @subsection Picons
23491
23492 @iftex
23493 @iflatex
23494 \include{picons}
23495 @end iflatex
23496 @end iftex
23497
23498 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
23499 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
23500 over your shoulder as you read news.
23501
23502 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
23503
23504 @iftex
23505 @iflatex
23506 \margindex{}
23507 @end iflatex
23508 @end iftex
23509
23510 @quotation
23511 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
23512 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
23513 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
23514 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
23515 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
23516 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
23517 @code{GIF} formats.
23518 @end quotation
23519
23520 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23521 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
23522 point your Web browser at
23523 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
23524
23525 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
23526 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
23527
23528 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
23529 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
23530 Picons databases.
23531
23532 @vindex gnus-picon-style
23533 The variable @code{gnus-picon-style} controls how picons are displayed.
23534 If @code{inline}, the textual representation is replaced. If
23535 @code{right}, picons are added right to the textual representation.
23536
23537 @vindex gnus-picon-properties
23538 The value of the variable @code{gnus-picon-properties} is a list of
23539 properties applied to picons.
23540
23541 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
23542
23543 @table @code
23544
23545 @item gnus-picon-databases
23546 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23547 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
23548 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
23549 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
23550 "/usr/local/faces")}.
23551
23552 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
23553 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
23554 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23555 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
23556
23557 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
23558 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
23559 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
23560 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
23561
23562 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
23563 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
23564 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23565 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
23566 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
23567
23568 @item gnus-picon-file-types
23569 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
23570 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
23571 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
23572
23573 @item gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23574 @vindex gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23575 If non-@code{nil} (which is the default), don't display picons for
23576 things like @samp{.net} and @samp{.de}, which aren't usually very
23577 interesting.
23578
23579 @end table
23580
23581 @node Gravatars
23582 @subsection Gravatars
23583
23584 @iftex
23585 @iflatex
23586 \include{gravatars}
23587 @end iflatex
23588 @end iftex
23589
23590 A gravatar is an image registered to an e-mail address.
23591
23592 You can submit yours on-line at @uref{http://www.gravatar.com}.
23593
23594 The following variables offer control over how things are displayed.
23595
23596 @table @code
23597
23598 @item gnus-gravatar-size
23599 @vindex gnus-gravatar-size
23600 The size in pixels of gravatars. Gravatars are always square, so one
23601 number for the size is enough.
23602
23603 @item gnus-gravatar-properties
23604 @vindex gnus-gravatar-properties
23605 List of image properties applied to Gravatar images.
23606
23607 @item gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23608 @vindex gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23609 Regexp that matches mail addresses or names of people of which avatars
23610 should not be displayed, or @code{nil}. It default to the value of
23611 @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (@pxref{X-Face}).
23612
23613 @end table
23614
23615 If you want to see them in the From field, set:
23616 @lisp
23617 (setq gnus-treat-from-gravatar 'head)
23618 @end lisp
23619
23620 If you want to see them in the Cc and To fields, set:
23621
23622 @lisp
23623 (setq gnus-treat-mail-gravatar 'head)
23624 @end lisp
23625
23626
23627 @node XVarious
23628 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
23629
23630 @table @code
23631 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23632 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23633 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
23634 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
23635 unusual directory structure.
23636
23637 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23638 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23639 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23640 default.
23641
23642 @end table
23643
23644 @subsubsection Toolbar
23645
23646 @table @code
23647
23648 @item gnus-use-toolbar
23649 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23650 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23651 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23652 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23653 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23654 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23655 names show. The default is @code{default}.
23656
23657 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23658 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23659 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23660 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23661 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23662 The default is that of the default toolbar.
23663
23664 @item gnus-group-toolbar
23665 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23666 The toolbar in the group buffer.
23667
23668 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
23669 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23670 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23671
23672 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23673 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23674 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23675
23676 @end table
23677
23678 @iftex
23679 @iflatex
23680 \margindex{}
23681 @end iflatex
23682 @end iftex
23683
23684
23685 @node Fuzzy Matching
23686 @section Fuzzy Matching
23687 @cindex fuzzy matching
23688
23689 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23690 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23691
23692 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23693 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23694 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23695
23696 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23697 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23698 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23699 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23700 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23701
23702
23703 @node Thwarting Email Spam
23704 @section Thwarting Email Spam
23705 @cindex email spam
23706 @cindex spam
23707 @cindex UCE
23708 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23709
23710 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23711 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23712 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23713 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23714 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23715 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23716 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23717 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23718 in the end.
23719
23720 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23721 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23722 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23723 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23724 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23725 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23726
23727 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23728
23729 @menu
23730 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23731 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23732 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23733 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23734 @end menu
23735
23736 @node The problem of spam
23737 @subsection The problem of spam
23738 @cindex email spam
23739 @cindex spam filtering approaches
23740 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
23741 @cindex UCE
23742 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23743
23744 First, some background on spam.
23745
23746 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23747 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23748 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23749 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23750 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23751 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23752 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23753 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23754 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23755
23756 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23757 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23758 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23759 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23760 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23761 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23762 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23763 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23764 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23765 and processing.
23766
23767 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23768 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23769 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23770 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23771 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23772 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23773 from Bulgarian IPs.
23774
23775 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23776 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
23777 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
23778 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23779
23780 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23781 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23782 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23783 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23784
23785 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23786 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23787 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23788 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23789 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23790 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23791 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23792 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23793 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23794
23795 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23796 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23797 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23798 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23799 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23800 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23801 down for some time because of the incident.
23802
23803 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23804 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23805 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23806 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23807 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23808 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23809 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23810 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23811 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23812 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23813 the server that it has misclassified mail.
23814
23815 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23816 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23817 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23818 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23819 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23820 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23821 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23822 spam plague.
23823
23824 @node Anti-Spam Basics
23825 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23826 @cindex email spam
23827 @cindex spam
23828 @cindex UCE
23829 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23830
23831 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23832 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23833
23834 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23835 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23836 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23837 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23838 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23839 part of the mail address.)
23840
23841 @lisp
23842 (setq message-default-news-headers
23843 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23844 @end lisp
23845
23846 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23847 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23848
23849 @lisp
23850 (...
23851 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23852 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23853 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23854 "spam"))
23855 ...)
23856 @end lisp
23857
23858 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23859 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23860 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23861 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23862
23863 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23864 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23865 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23866 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23867 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23868 your fancy split rule in this way:
23869
23870 @lisp
23871 (
23872 ...
23873 (to "larsi" "misc")
23874 "spam")
23875 @end lisp
23876
23877 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23878 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23879 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
23880 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
23881 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
23882
23883 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
23884 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
23885 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
23886 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
23887
23888 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
23889
23890
23891 @node SpamAssassin
23892 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
23893 @cindex SpamAssassin
23894 @cindex Vipul's Razor
23895 @cindex DCC
23896
23897 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
23898 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
23899 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
23900 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
23901 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
23902 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
23903 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
23904
23905 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
23906 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
23907 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
23908 recipes.
23909
23910 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
23911 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
23912 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
23913 Specifiers}) follow.
23914
23915 @lisp
23916 (setq mail-sources
23917 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
23918 (pop :user "jrl"
23919 :server "pophost"
23920 :postscript
23921 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
23922 @end lisp
23923
23924 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
23925 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
23926 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
23927
23928 @lisp
23929 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
23930 ...))
23931 @end lisp
23932
23933 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23934
23935 @lisp
23936 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
23937 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
23938 ...))
23939 @end lisp
23940
23941 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
23942 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
23943 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
23944 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
23945
23946 @lisp
23947 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
23948 ...))
23949 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
23950 (save-excursion
23951 (save-restriction
23952 (widen)
23953 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
23954 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
23955 "spam"))))
23956 @end lisp
23957
23958 Note that with the nnimap back end, message bodies will not be
23959 downloaded by default. You need to set
23960 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
23961 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
23962
23963 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
23964 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
23965 spam. And here is the nifty function:
23966
23967 @lisp
23968 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
23969 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
23970 (interactive)
23971 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d" t)
23972 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
23973 @end lisp
23974
23975 @node Hashcash
23976 @subsection Hashcash
23977 @cindex hashcash
23978
23979 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
23980 costly and demonstrably unique for each message they send. This has
23981 the obvious drawback that you cannot rely on everyone in the world
23982 using this technique, since it is not part of the Internet standards,
23983 but it may be useful in smaller communities.
23984
23985 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
23986 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
23987 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
23988 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
23989 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
23990 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
23991 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
23992 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
23993 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
23994 one of them separately.
23995
23996 @cindex X-Hashcash
23997 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
23998 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
23999 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:} header.
24000 For more details, and for the external application @code{hashcash} you
24001 need to install to use this feature, see
24002 @uref{http://www.hashcash.org/}. Even more information can be found
24003 at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
24004
24005 If you wish to generate hashcash for each message you send, you can
24006 customize @code{message-generate-hashcash} (@pxref{Mail Headers, ,Mail
24007 Headers,message, The Message Manual}), as in:
24008
24009 @lisp
24010 (setq message-generate-hashcash t)
24011 @end lisp
24012
24013 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
24014
24015 @table @code
24016
24017 @item hashcash-default-payment
24018 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
24019 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
24020 should consist of. By default this is 20. Suggested useful values
24021 include 17 to 29.
24022
24023 @item hashcash-payment-alist
24024 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
24025 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
24026 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
24027 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
24028 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
24029 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
24030 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
24031 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
24032
24033 @item hashcash-path
24034 @vindex hashcash-path
24035 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed. This variable should
24036 be automatically set by @code{executable-find}, but if it's @code{nil}
24037 (usually because the @code{hashcash} binary is not in your path)
24038 you'll get a warning when you check hashcash payments and an error
24039 when you generate hashcash payments.
24040
24041 @end table
24042
24043 Gnus can verify hashcash cookies, although this can also be done by
24044 hand customized mail filtering scripts. To verify a hashcash cookie
24045 in a message, use the @code{mail-check-payment} function in the
24046 @code{hashcash.el} library. You can also use the @code{spam.el}
24047 package with the @code{spam-use-hashcash} back end to validate hashcash
24048 cookies in incoming mail and filter mail accordingly (@pxref{Anti-spam
24049 Hashcash Payments}).
24050
24051 @node Spam Package
24052 @section Spam Package
24053 @cindex spam filtering
24054 @cindex spam
24055
24056 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
24057 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
24058 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
24059 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
24060
24061 @menu
24062 * Spam Package Introduction::
24063 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
24064 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
24065 * Spam and Ham Processors::
24066 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
24067 * Spam Back Ends::
24068 * Extending the Spam package::
24069 * Spam Statistics Package::
24070 @end menu
24071
24072 @node Spam Package Introduction
24073 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
24074 @cindex spam filtering
24075 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
24076 @cindex spam
24077
24078 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
24079 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
24080
24081 Make sure you read the section on the @code{spam.el} sequence of
24082 events. See @xref{Extending the Spam package}.
24083
24084 @cindex spam-initialize
24085 @vindex spam-use-stat
24086 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
24087 @code{spam-initialize}:
24088
24089 @example
24090 (spam-initialize)
24091 @end example
24092
24093 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
24094 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
24095 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
24096 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
24097 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
24098
24099 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
24100 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
24101
24102 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
24103 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
24104
24105 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
24106 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
24107 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
24108 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
24109 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
24110
24111 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
24112 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
24113 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
24114 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
24115 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
24116 Groups}.
24117
24118 @cindex spam back ends
24119 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
24120 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
24121 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
24122 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
24123 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24124
24125 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
24126 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
24127
24128 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
24129 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
24130 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
24131 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
24132 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
24133 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
24134 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
24135
24136 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
24137 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
24138 point, the Spam package does several things:
24139
24140 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
24141 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
24142 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
24143 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
24144 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
24145 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
24146 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
24147 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
24148 Ham Processors}.
24149
24150 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
24151 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
24152 group:
24153
24154 @table @kbd
24155 @item $
24156 @itemx M-d
24157 @itemx M s x
24158 @itemx S x
24159 @kindex $ (Summary)
24160 @kindex M-d (Summary)
24161 @kindex S x (Summary)
24162 @kindex M s x (Summary)
24163 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24164 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24165 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
24166 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
24167 @end table
24168
24169 @noindent
24170 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
24171 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
24172
24173 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
24174 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
24175 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
24176 to be processed as ham by setting
24177 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
24178 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
24179
24180 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24181 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24182 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
24183 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
24184 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
24185 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
24186 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
24187 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
24188 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
24189 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
24190 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
24191 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
24192
24193 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
24194 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
24195 want each article to be processed only once, load the
24196 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
24197 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
24198 Configuration Examples}.
24199
24200 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
24201 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
24202 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
24203 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
24204
24205 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
24206 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
24207
24208 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
24209 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
24210 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
24211
24212 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
24213 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
24214 @cindex spam filtering
24215 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
24216 @cindex spam
24217
24218 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
24219 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
24220 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
24221 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
24222 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
24223
24224 @example
24225 (: spam-split)
24226 @end example
24227
24228 @vindex spam-split-group
24229 @noindent
24230 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
24231 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
24232 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
24233 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
24234 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
24235 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
24236 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
24237 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
24238 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
24239
24240 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
24241
24242 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
24243 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
24244 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
24245 you should also set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to
24246 @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can ``scan''
24247 the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only retrieves
24248 the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells it to
24249 retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by default
24250 because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
24251 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Client-Side
24252 IMAP Splitting}.
24253
24254 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
24255 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
24256 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
24257 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
24258 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
24259 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
24260 ends, and the following split rule:
24261
24262 @example
24263 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24264 (any "ding" "ding")
24265 (: spam-split)
24266 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24267 "mail")
24268 @end example
24269
24270 @noindent
24271 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
24272 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
24273 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
24274 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
24275 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
24276 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
24277
24278 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
24279 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
24280 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
24281 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
24282
24283 @example
24284 nnimap-split-fancy
24285 '(|
24286 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
24287 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24288 (any "ding" "ding")
24289 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
24290 (: spam-split)
24291 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24292 "mail")
24293 @end example
24294
24295 @noindent
24296 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
24297 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
24298 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
24299 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
24300 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
24301 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
24302 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
24303
24304 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24305 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24306 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24307 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24308
24309 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
24310 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
24311 @c don't.}
24312
24313 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
24314 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
24315
24316 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
24317 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
24318 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
24319 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
24320
24321 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24322 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24323 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24324 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
24325
24326 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
24327 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
24328 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
24329
24330 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
24331 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
24332 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
24333 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
24334 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
24335 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
24336 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
24337
24338 @node Spam and Ham Processors
24339 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
24340 @cindex spam filtering
24341 @cindex spam filtering variables
24342 @cindex spam variables
24343 @cindex spam
24344
24345 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
24346 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
24347 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
24348 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
24349 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
24350 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
24351 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
24352
24353 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
24354 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
24355 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
24356 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
24357
24358 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24359 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
24360 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
24361 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
24362 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
24363 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
24364 by customizing the corresponding variable
24365 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
24366 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
24367 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
24368 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
24369 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
24370 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
24371 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
24372 default.
24373
24374 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
24375 @cindex $
24376 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
24377 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
24378 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
24379 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
24380 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
24381 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
24382 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
24383 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
24384 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
24385 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
24386 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
24387 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
24388 processor which will study them as spam samples.
24389
24390 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
24391 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
24392 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
24393 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
24394 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
24395 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
24396 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
24397 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
24398
24399 @defvar ham-marks
24400 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24401 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
24402 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
24403 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
24404 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
24405 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
24406 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
24407 happy for you.
24408 @end defvar
24409
24410 @defvar spam-marks
24411 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24412 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
24413 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
24414 you really want to.
24415 @end defvar
24416
24417 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
24418 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
24419 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
24420 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
24421 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
24422 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
24423 and nothing else.
24424
24425 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24426 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
24427 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
24428 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
24429 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
24430 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
24431 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
24432 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
24433 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
24434 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
24435 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
24436 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
24437 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
24438 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
24439 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
24440
24441 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24442 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24443
24444 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24445 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
24446 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
24447
24448 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
24449 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
24450
24451 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
24452 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
24453 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
24454 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
24455 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
24456
24457 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
24458 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
24459 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
24460 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
24461 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
24462 it there.
24463
24464 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24465 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
24466 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
24467 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
24468 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
24469 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
24470 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
24471 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
24472 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
24473 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
24474 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
24475 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
24476 group buffer then you need it here as well.
24477
24478 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24479 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24480
24481 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24482 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
24483 training} groups.
24484
24485 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
24486 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
24487 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
24488 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
24489 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
24490 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
24491 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
24492
24493 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
24494 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
24495 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
24496 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
24497
24498 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
24499 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
24500 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
24501 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
24502 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
24503 from the mail server.
24504
24505 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
24506 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
24507 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
24508 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
24509
24510 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
24511 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
24512 @cindex spam filtering
24513 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
24514 @cindex spam configuration examples
24515 @cindex spam
24516
24517 @subsubheading Ted's setup
24518
24519 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
24520 @example
24521 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
24522 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
24523 (gnus-registry-initialize)
24524 (spam-initialize)
24525
24526 (setq
24527 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
24528 spam-use-BBDB t
24529 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
24530 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
24531 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24532 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24533 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
24534 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
24535 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
24536 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
24537 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
24538 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
24539 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24540 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
24541 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
24542 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
24543 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24544 (any "ding" "ding")
24545 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
24546 (: spam-split)
24547 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24548 "mail"))
24549
24550 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
24551
24552 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
24553 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
24554 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
24555 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
24556
24557 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24558
24559 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
24560 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
24561 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
24562 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
24563 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24564
24565 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
24566 ((spam-autodetect . t))
24567
24568 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
24569
24570 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
24571 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
24572
24573 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
24574 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
24575 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
24576
24577 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
24578
24579 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
24580 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
24581
24582 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
24583 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
24584 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
24585 (ham-marks
24586 (gnus-ticked-mark))
24587 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
24588 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
24589 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
24590
24591 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
24592 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
24593 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
24594
24595 @end example
24596
24597 @subsubheading Using @code{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
24598 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24599
24600 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
24601 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
24602 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
24603 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
24604 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
24605 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
24606 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
24607 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
24608 @samp{training.spam} folders.
24609
24610 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
24611 does most of the job for me:
24612
24613 @lisp
24614 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
24615 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
24616 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
24617 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24618 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
24619 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
24620 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
24621 @end lisp
24622
24623 @itemize
24624
24625 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
24626
24627 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
24628 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
24629 bogofilter or DCC).
24630
24631 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
24632 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
24633 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
24634 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
24635 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
24636 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
24637 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
24638
24639 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
24640 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
24641 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
24642 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
24643 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
24644 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
24645
24646 @item @b{Ham folders:}
24647
24648 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24649 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24650 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
24651 @samp{training.spam}.
24652 @end itemize
24653
24654 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24655
24656 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24657
24658 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24659 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24660 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24661
24662 @lisp
24663 ("^gmane\\."
24664 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24665 @end lisp
24666
24667 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24668 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
24669 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
24670 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24671 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24672
24673 @node Spam Back Ends
24674 @subsection Spam Back Ends
24675 @cindex spam back ends
24676
24677 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24678 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24679 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24680 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24681 Processors}).
24682
24683 @menu
24684 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
24685 * BBDB Whitelists::
24686 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
24687 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24688 * Blackholes::
24689 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24690 * Bogofilter::
24691 * SpamAssassin back end::
24692 * ifile spam filtering::
24693 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
24694 * SpamOracle::
24695 @end menu
24696
24697 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
24698 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24699 @cindex spam filtering
24700 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24701 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24702 @cindex spam
24703
24704 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
24705
24706 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24707 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24708 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24709 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24710 be spammers.
24711
24712 @end defvar
24713
24714 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
24715
24716 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24717 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24718 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24719 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24720 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24721
24722 @end defvar
24723
24724 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24725
24726 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24727 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24728 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24729
24730 @end defvar
24731
24732 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24733
24734 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24735 customizing the group parameters or the
24736 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24737 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24738 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24739
24740 @emph{WARNING}
24741
24742 Instead of the obsolete
24743 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
24744 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
24745 the same way, we promise.
24746
24747 @end defvar
24748
24749 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24750
24751 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24752 customizing the group parameters or the
24753 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24754 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24755 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24756 whitelist.
24757
24758 @emph{WARNING}
24759
24760 Instead of the obsolete
24761 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
24762 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
24763 the same way, we promise.
24764
24765 @end defvar
24766
24767 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24768 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24769 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24770 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24771 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24772
24773 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24774 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24775 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24776 Emacs regular expression syntax.
24777
24778 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24779 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24780 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24781 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24782 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24783 @file{blacklist} respectively.
24784
24785 @node BBDB Whitelists
24786 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24787 @cindex spam filtering
24788 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24789 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24790 @cindex spam
24791
24792 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
24793
24794 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24795 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24796 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24797 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24798 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24799 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24800 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24801
24802 @end defvar
24803
24804 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24805
24806 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24807 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24808 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
24809 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24810 classified as spammers.
24811
24812 While @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} @emph{can} be used as an alias
24813 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} as far as @code{spam.el} is concerned, it is
24814 @emph{not} a separate back end. If you set
24815 @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} to t, @emph{all} your BBDB splitting
24816 will be exclusive.
24817
24818 @end defvar
24819
24820 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24821
24822 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24823 customizing the group parameters or the
24824 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24825 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24826 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24827 BBDB.
24828
24829 @emph{WARNING}
24830
24831 Instead of the obsolete
24832 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
24833 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
24834 the same way, we promise.
24835
24836 @end defvar
24837
24838 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
24839 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24840 @cindex spam reporting
24841 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24842 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24843 @cindex spam
24844
24845 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24846
24847 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24848 customizing the group parameters or the
24849 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24850 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24851 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24852 HTTP request.
24853
24854 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24855
24856 @emph{WARNING}
24857
24858 Instead of the obsolete
24859 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
24860 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
24861 same way, we promise.
24862
24863 @end defvar
24864
24865 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24866
24867 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24868 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24869 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24870 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
24871 @code{spam-report.el} will fetch the number from the article headers.
24872
24873 @end defvar
24874
24875 @defvar spam-report-user-mail-address
24876
24877 Mail address exposed in the User-Agent spam reports to Gmane. It allows
24878 the Gmane administrators to contact you in case of misreports. The
24879 default is @code{user-mail-address}.
24880
24881 @end defvar
24882
24883 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24884 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24885 @cindex spam filtering
24886 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
24887 @cindex spam
24888
24889 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
24890
24891 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24892 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
24893 instead of the sender address. Messages without a hashcash payment
24894 token will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an explicit
24895 filter, meaning that unless a hashcash token is found, the messages
24896 are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24897
24898 @end defvar
24899
24900 @node Blackholes
24901 @subsubsection Blackholes
24902 @cindex spam filtering
24903 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
24904 @cindex spam
24905
24906 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
24907
24908 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
24909 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
24910 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
24911 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
24912 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
24913 contains outdated servers.
24914
24915 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
24916 @code{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
24917 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
24918 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
24919 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
24920 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
24921
24922 @end defvar
24923
24924 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
24925
24926 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
24927
24928 @end defvar
24929
24930 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
24931
24932 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
24933 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
24934
24935 @end defvar
24936
24937 @defvar spam-use-dig
24938
24939 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
24940 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
24941
24942 @end defvar
24943
24944 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
24945 ham processor for blackholes.
24946
24947 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
24948 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
24949 @cindex spam filtering
24950 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
24951 @cindex spam
24952
24953 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
24954
24955 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
24956 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
24957 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
24958 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
24959 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
24960 message is spam or ham, respectively.
24961
24962 @end defvar
24963
24964 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
24965
24966 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
24967 the message, positively identify it as spam.
24968
24969 @end defvar
24970
24971 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
24972
24973 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
24974 the message, positively identify it as ham.
24975
24976 @end defvar
24977
24978 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
24979 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
24980
24981 @node Bogofilter
24982 @subsubsection Bogofilter
24983 @cindex spam filtering
24984 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
24985 @cindex spam
24986
24987 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
24988
24989 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
24990 speedy Bogofilter.
24991
24992 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
24993 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
24994 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
24995 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
24996 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
24997 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
24998
24999 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
25000 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
25001 documentation.
25002
25003 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
25004 processing will be turned off.
25005
25006 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
25007
25008 @end defvar
25009
25010 @table @kbd
25011 @item M s t
25012 @itemx S t
25013 @kindex M s t
25014 @kindex S t
25015 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
25016 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
25017 @end table
25018
25019 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
25020
25021 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25022 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
25023 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
25024 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
25025 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
25026 installation documents for details.
25027
25028 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
25029
25030 @end defvar
25031
25032 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
25033 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25034 customizing the group parameters or the
25035 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25036 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
25037 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
25038
25039 @emph{WARNING}
25040
25041 Instead of the obsolete
25042 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25043 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25044 the same way, we promise.
25045 @end defvar
25046
25047 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
25048 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25049 customizing the group parameters or the
25050 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25051 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25052 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
25053 of non-spam messages.
25054
25055 @emph{WARNING}
25056
25057 Instead of the obsolete
25058 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25059 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25060 the same way, we promise.
25061 @end defvar
25062
25063 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
25064
25065 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
25066 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
25067 database directory.
25068
25069 @end defvar
25070
25071 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
25072 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25073 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
25074 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
25075 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
25076 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
25077
25078 @node SpamAssassin back end
25079 @subsubsection SpamAssassin back end
25080 @cindex spam filtering
25081 @cindex spamassassin, spam filtering
25082 @cindex spam
25083
25084 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin
25085
25086 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use SpamAssassin.
25087
25088 SpamAssassin assigns a score to each article based on a set of rules
25089 and tests, including a Bayesian filter. The Bayesian filter can be
25090 trained by associating the @samp{$} mark for spam articles. The
25091 spam score can be viewed by using the command @kbd{S t} in summary
25092 mode.
25093
25094 If you set this variable, each article will be processed by
25095 SpamAssassin when @code{spam-split} is called. If your mail is
25096 preprocessed by SpamAssassin, and you want to just use the
25097 SpamAssassin headers, set @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}
25098 instead.
25099
25100 You should not enable this if you use
25101 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}.
25102
25103 @end defvar
25104
25105 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin-headers
25106
25107 Set this variable if your mail is preprocessed by SpamAssassin and
25108 want @code{spam-split} to split based on the SpamAssassin headers.
25109
25110 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-spamassassin}.
25111
25112 @end defvar
25113
25114 @defvar spam-spamassassin-program
25115
25116 This variable points to the SpamAssassin executable. If you have
25117 @code{spamd} running, you can set this variable to the @code{spamc}
25118 executable for faster processing. See the SpamAssassin documentation
25119 for more information on @code{spamd}/@code{spamc}.
25120
25121 @end defvar
25122
25123 SpamAssassin is a powerful and flexible spam filter that uses a wide
25124 variety of tests to identify spam. A ham and a spam processors are
25125 provided, plus the @code{spam-use-spamassassin} and
25126 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers} variables to indicate to
25127 spam-split that SpamAssassin should be either used, or has already
25128 been used on the article. The 2.63 version of SpamAssassin was used
25129 to test this functionality.
25130
25131 @node ifile spam filtering
25132 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
25133 @cindex spam filtering
25134 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
25135 @cindex spam
25136
25137 @defvar spam-use-ifile
25138
25139 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
25140 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
25141
25142 @end defvar
25143
25144 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
25145
25146 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
25147 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
25148 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
25149
25150 @end defvar
25151
25152 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
25153
25154 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
25155 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
25156 the default value of @samp{spam}.
25157 @end defvar
25158
25159 @defvar spam-ifile-database
25160
25161 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
25162 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
25163
25164 @end defvar
25165
25166 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
25167 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25168 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
25169 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
25170 functionality.
25171
25172 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
25173 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
25174 @cindex spam filtering
25175 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
25176 @cindex spam-stat
25177 @cindex spam
25178
25179 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
25180 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
25181 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
25182 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
25183 spam-stat dictionary}.
25184
25185 @defvar spam-use-stat
25186
25187 @end defvar
25188
25189 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
25190 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25191 customizing the group parameters or the
25192 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25193 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
25194 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
25195
25196 @emph{WARNING}
25197
25198 Instead of the obsolete
25199 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25200 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25201 the same way, we promise.
25202 @end defvar
25203
25204 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
25205 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25206 customizing the group parameters or the
25207 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25208 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25209 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
25210 of non-spam messages.
25211
25212 @emph{WARNING}
25213
25214 Instead of the obsolete
25215 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25216 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25217 the same way, we promise.
25218 @end defvar
25219
25220 This enables @code{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
25221 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
25222 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
25223 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
25224 @code{spam-split} are provided.
25225
25226 @node SpamOracle
25227 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
25228 @cindex spam filtering
25229 @cindex SpamOracle
25230 @cindex spam
25231
25232 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
25233 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
25234 installed separately.
25235
25236 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
25237 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
25238 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
25239 mail as a spam mail or not.
25240
25241 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
25242 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
25243 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
25244
25245 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
25246 call SpamOracle.
25247
25248 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
25249 To enable SpamOracle usage by @code{spam.el}, set the variable
25250 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
25251 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
25252 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
25253 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
25254 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
25255 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
25256
25257 @example
25258 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
25259 spam-split-group "Junk"
25260 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
25261 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
25262 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
25263 @end example
25264
25265 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
25266 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
25267 SpamOracle.
25268 @end defvar
25269
25270 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
25271 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
25272 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
25273 can be customized.
25274 @end defvar
25275
25276 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
25277 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
25278 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
25279 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
25280 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
25281 database to live somewhere special, set
25282 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
25283 @end defvar
25284
25285 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
25286 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
25287 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
25288 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
25289 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
25290 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
25291 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
25292 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
25293 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
25294 @xref{Spam Package}.
25295
25296 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
25297 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25298 customizing the group parameter or the
25299 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25300 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
25301 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
25302
25303 @emph{WARNING}
25304
25305 Instead of the obsolete
25306 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25307 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25308 the same way, we promise.
25309 @end defvar
25310
25311 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
25312 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25313 customizing the group parameter or the
25314 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25315 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
25316 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
25317 messages.
25318
25319 @emph{WARNING}
25320
25321 Instead of the obsolete
25322 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25323 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25324 the same way, we promise.
25325 @end defvar
25326
25327 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
25328 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
25329 messages.
25330 @example
25331 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
25332 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
25333 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
25334 @end example
25335 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
25336 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
25337 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
25338 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
25339 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
25340 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
25341
25342 @node Extending the Spam package
25343 @subsection Extending the Spam package
25344 @cindex spam filtering
25345 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
25346 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
25347
25348 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
25349 incoming mail, provide the following:
25350
25351 @enumerate
25352
25353 @item
25354 Code
25355
25356 @lisp
25357 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
25358 "True if blackbox should be used.")
25359 @end lisp
25360
25361 Write @code{spam-check-blackbox} if Blackbox can check incoming mail.
25362
25363 Write @code{spam-blackbox-register-routine} and
25364 @code{spam-blackbox-unregister-routine} using the bogofilter
25365 register/unregister routines as a start, or other register/unregister
25366 routines more appropriate to Blackbox, if Blackbox can
25367 register/unregister spam and ham.
25368
25369 @item
25370 Functionality
25371
25372 The @code{spam-check-blackbox} function should return @samp{nil} or
25373 @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other conventions. See the
25374 existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for examples of what you can
25375 do, and stick to the template unless you fully understand the reasons
25376 why you aren't.
25377
25378 @end enumerate
25379
25380 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
25381
25382 @enumerate
25383
25384 @item
25385 Code
25386
25387 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
25388 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
25389
25390 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
25391 variables. Instead the form @code{(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
25392 @code{(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
25393 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
25394
25395 @lisp
25396 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
25397 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
25398 Only applicable to spam groups.")
25399
25400 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
25401 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
25402 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
25403
25404 @end lisp
25405
25406 @item
25407 Gnus parameters
25408
25409 Add
25410 @lisp
25411 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
25412 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
25413 @end lisp
25414 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
25415 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
25416 variable customization.
25417
25418 Add
25419 @lisp
25420 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
25421 @end lisp
25422 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
25423 @code{gnus.el} if Blackbox can check incoming mail for spam contents.
25424
25425 Finally, use the appropriate @code{spam-install-*-backend} function in
25426 @code{spam.el}. Here are the available functions.
25427
25428
25429 @enumerate
25430
25431 @item
25432 @code{spam-install-backend-alias}
25433
25434 This function will simply install an alias for a back end that does
25435 everything like the original back end. It is currently only used to
25436 make @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} act like @code{spam-use-BBDB}.
25437
25438 @item
25439 @code{spam-install-nocheck-backend}
25440
25441 This function installs a back end that has no check function, but can
25442 register/unregister ham or spam. The @code{spam-use-gmane} back end is
25443 such a back end.
25444
25445 @item
25446 @code{spam-install-checkonly-backend}
25447
25448 This function will install a back end that can only check incoming mail
25449 for spam contents. It can't register or unregister messages.
25450 @code{spam-use-blackholes} and @code{spam-use-hashcash} are such
25451 back ends.
25452
25453 @item
25454 @code{spam-install-statistical-checkonly-backend}
25455
25456 This function installs a statistical back end (one which requires the
25457 full body of a message to check it) that can only check incoming mail
25458 for contents. @code{spam-use-regex-body} is such a filter.
25459
25460 @item
25461 @code{spam-install-statistical-backend}
25462
25463 This function install a statistical back end with incoming checks and
25464 registration/unregistration routines. @code{spam-use-bogofilter} is
25465 set up this way.
25466
25467 @item
25468 @code{spam-install-backend}
25469
25470 This is the most normal back end installation, where a back end that can
25471 check and register/unregister messages is set up without statistical
25472 abilities. The @code{spam-use-BBDB} is such a back end.
25473
25474 @item
25475 @code{spam-install-mover-backend}
25476
25477 Mover back ends are internal to @code{spam.el} and specifically move
25478 articles around when the summary is exited. You will very probably
25479 never install such a back end.
25480 @end enumerate
25481
25482 @end enumerate
25483
25484 @node Spam Statistics Package
25485 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
25486 @cindex Paul Graham
25487 @cindex Graham, Paul
25488 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
25489 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
25490 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
25491
25492 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
25493 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
25494 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
25495 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
25496 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
25497 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
25498 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
25499 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
25500 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
25501 or not.
25502
25503 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
25504 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
25505 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
25506 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
25507 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
25508 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
25509 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
25510 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
25511
25512 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
25513 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
25514 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
25515
25516 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
25517 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
25518 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
25519 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
25520 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
25521
25522 @menu
25523 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
25524 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
25525 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
25526 @end menu
25527
25528 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25529 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25530
25531 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
25532 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
25533 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
25534 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
25535 need several hundred emails in both collections.
25536
25537 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
25538 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
25539 per mail. Use the following:
25540
25541 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
25542 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
25543 is treated as one spam mail.
25544 @end defun
25545
25546 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
25547 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
25548 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
25549 @end defun
25550
25551 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
25552 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
25553 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
25554 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
25555 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
25556 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
25557
25558 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
25559 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
25560 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
25561 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
25562 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
25563
25564 @defvar spam-stat
25565 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
25566 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
25567 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
25568 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
25569 @end defvar
25570
25571 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
25572 reset the dictionary.
25573
25574 @defun spam-stat-reset
25575 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
25576 @end defun
25577
25578 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
25579 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
25580 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
25581 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
25582 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
25583 only non-spam mails.
25584
25585 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
25586 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
25587 to update the dictionary incrementally.
25588 @end defun
25589
25590 @defun spam-stat-save
25591 Save the dictionary.
25592 @end defun
25593
25594 @defvar spam-stat-file
25595 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
25596 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
25597 @end defvar
25598
25599 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
25600 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
25601
25602 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
25603 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
25604
25605 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25606
25607 @lisp
25608 (require 'spam-stat)
25609 (spam-stat-load)
25610 @end lisp
25611
25612 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
25613 created.
25614
25615 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
25616 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
25617 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
25618 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
25619
25620 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
25621 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
25622 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
25623 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
25624
25625 @lisp
25626 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25627 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25628 "mail.misc"))
25629 @end lisp
25630
25631 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
25632 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
25633 @end defvar
25634
25635 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
25636 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
25637 expression are considered potential spam.
25638
25639 @lisp
25640 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25641 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25642 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25643 "mail.misc"))
25644 @end lisp
25645
25646 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
25647 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
25648 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
25649 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
25650 mails, when creating the dictionary!
25651
25652 @lisp
25653 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25654 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25655 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25656 "mail.misc"))
25657 @end lisp
25658
25659 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
25660 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
25661 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
25662 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
25663 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
25664 dictionary!
25665
25666 @lisp
25667 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25668 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
25669 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25670 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25671 "mail.misc"))
25672 @end lisp
25673
25674
25675 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25676 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25677
25678 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
25679
25680 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
25681 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
25682 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25683 @end defun
25684
25685 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
25686 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
25687 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25688 @end defun
25689
25690 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
25691 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
25692 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
25693 already been processed as non-spam.
25694 @end defun
25695
25696 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
25697 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
25698 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
25699 been processed as spam.
25700 @end defun
25701
25702 @defun spam-stat-save
25703 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
25704 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25705 @end defun
25706
25707 @defun spam-stat-load
25708 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
25709 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25710 @end defun
25711
25712 @defun spam-stat-score-word
25713 Return the spam score for a word.
25714 @end defun
25715
25716 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
25717 Return the spam score for a buffer.
25718 @end defun
25719
25720 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
25721 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
25722 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
25723 @end defun
25724
25725 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
25726 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25727
25728 @lisp
25729 (require 'spam-stat)
25730 (spam-stat-load)
25731 @end lisp
25732
25733 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
25734
25735 @smallexample
25736 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25737 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25738 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25739 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25740 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25741 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25742 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25743 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25744 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25745 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25746 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25747 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25748 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25749 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25750 @end smallexample
25751
25752 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25753
25754 @smallexample
25755 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25756 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25757 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25758 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25759 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25760 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25761 @end smallexample
25762
25763 @node The Gnus Registry
25764 @section The Gnus Registry
25765 @cindex registry
25766 @cindex split
25767 @cindex track
25768
25769 The Gnus registry is a package that tracks messages by their
25770 Message-ID across all backends. This allows Gnus users to do several
25771 cool things, be the envy of the locals, get free haircuts, and be
25772 experts on world issues. Well, maybe not all of those, but the
25773 features are pretty cool.
25774
25775 Although they will be explained in detail shortly, here's a quick list
25776 of said features in case your attention span is... never mind.
25777
25778 @enumerate
25779 @item
25780 Split messages to their parent
25781
25782 This keeps discussions in the same group. You can use the subject and
25783 the sender in addition to the Message-ID. Several strategies are
25784 available.
25785
25786 @item
25787 Refer to messages by ID
25788
25789 Commands like @code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article} can take
25790 advantage of the registry to jump to the referred article, regardless
25791 of the group the message is in.
25792
25793 @item
25794 Store custom flags and keywords
25795
25796 The registry can store custom flags and keywords for a message. For
25797 instance, you can mark a message ``To-Do'' this way and the flag will
25798 persist whether the message is in the nnimap, nnml, nnmaildir,
25799 etc. backends.
25800
25801 @item
25802 Store arbitrary data
25803
25804 Through a simple ELisp API, the registry can remember any data for a
25805 message. A built-in inverse map, when activated, allows quick lookups
25806 of all messages matching a particular set of criteria.
25807 @end enumerate
25808
25809 @menu
25810 * Gnus Registry Setup::
25811 * Fancy splitting to parent::
25812 * Registry Article Refer Method::
25813 * Store custom flags and keywords::
25814 * Store arbitrary data::
25815 @end menu
25816
25817 @node Gnus Registry Setup
25818 @subsection Gnus Registry Setup
25819
25820 Fortunately, setting up the Gnus registry is pretty easy:
25821
25822 @lisp
25823 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25824
25825 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25826 @end lisp
25827
25828 This adds registry saves to Gnus newsrc saves (which happen on exit
25829 and when you press @kbd{s} from the @code{*Group*} buffer. It also
25830 adds registry calls to article actions in Gnus (copy, move, etc.) so
25831 it's not easy to undo the initialization. See
25832 @code{gnus-registry-initialize} for the gory details.
25833
25834 Here are other settings used by the author of the registry (understand
25835 what they do before you copy them blindly).
25836
25837 @lisp
25838 (setq
25839 gnus-registry-split-strategy 'majority
25840 gnus-registry-ignored-groups '(("nntp" t)
25841 ("nnrss" t)
25842 ("spam" t)
25843 ("train" t))
25844 gnus-registry-max-entries 500000
25845 ;; this is the default
25846 gnus-registry-track-extra '(sender subject))
25847 @end lisp
25848
25849 They say: keep a lot of messages around, track messages by sender and
25850 subject (not just parent Message-ID), and when the registry splits
25851 incoming mail, use a majority rule to decide where messages should go
25852 if there's more than one possibility. In addition, the registry
25853 should ignore messages in groups that match ``nntp'', ``nnrss'',
25854 ``spam'', or ``train.''
25855
25856 You are doubtless impressed by all this, but you ask: ``I am a Gnus
25857 user, I customize to live. Give me more.'' Here you go, these are
25858 the general settings.
25859
25860 @defvar gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups
25861 The groups that will not be followed by
25862 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}. They will still be
25863 remembered by the registry. This is a list of regular expressions.
25864 By default any group name that ends with ``delayed'', ``drafts'',
25865 ``queue'', or ``INBOX'', belongs to the nnmairix backend, or contains
25866 the word ``archive'' is not followed.
25867 @end defvar
25868
25869 @defvar gnus-registry-max-entries
25870 The number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries the
25871 registry will keep.
25872 @end defvar
25873
25874 @defvar gnus-registry-max-pruned-entries
25875 The maximum number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries
25876 the registry will keep after pruning.
25877 @end defvar
25878
25879 @defvar gnus-registry-cache-file
25880 The file where the registry will be stored between Gnus sessions. By
25881 default the file name is @code{.gnus.registry.eioio} in the same
25882 directory as your @code{.newsrc.eld}.
25883 @end defvar
25884
25885 @node Registry Article Refer Method
25886 @subsection Fetching by @code{Message-ID} Using the Registry
25887
25888 The registry knows how to map each @code{Message-ID} to the group it's
25889 in. This can be leveraged to enhance the ``article refer method'',
25890 the thing that tells Gnus how to look up an article given its
25891 Message-ID (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25892
25893 @vindex nnregistry
25894 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
25895
25896 The @code{nnregistry} refer method does exactly that. It has the
25897 advantage that an article may be found regardless of the group it's
25898 in---provided its @code{Message-ID} is known to the registry. It can
25899 be enabled by augmenting the start-up file with something along these
25900 lines:
25901
25902 @example
25903 ;; Keep enough entries to have a good hit rate when referring to an
25904 ;; article using the registry. Use long group names so that Gnus
25905 ;; knows where the article is.
25906 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25907
25908 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25909
25910 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
25911 '(current
25912 (nnregistry)
25913 (nnweb "gmane" (nnweb-type gmane))))
25914 @end example
25915
25916 The example above instructs Gnus to first look up the article in the
25917 current group, or, alternatively, using the registry, and finally, if
25918 all else fails, using Gmane.
25919
25920 @node Fancy splitting to parent
25921 @subsection Fancy splitting to parent
25922
25923 Simply put, this lets you put followup e-mail where it belongs.
25924
25925 Every message has a Message-ID, which is unique, and the registry
25926 remembers it. When the message is moved or copied, the registry will
25927 notice this and offer the new group as a choice to the splitting
25928 strategy.
25929
25930 When a followup is made, usually it mentions the original message's
25931 Message-ID in the headers. The registry knows this and uses that
25932 mention to find the group where the original message lives. You only
25933 have to put a rule like this:
25934
25935 @lisp
25936 (setq nnimap-my-split-fancy '(|
25937
25938 ;; split to parent: you need this
25939 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
25940
25941 ;; other rules, as an example
25942 (: spam-split)
25943 ;; default mailbox
25944 "mail")
25945 @end lisp
25946
25947 in your fancy split setup. In addition, you may want to customize the
25948 following variables.
25949
25950 @defvar gnus-registry-track-extra
25951 This is a list of symbols, so it's best to change it from the
25952 Customize interface. By default it's @code{(subject sender)}, which
25953 may work for you. It can be annoying if your mail flow is large and
25954 people don't stick to the same groups.
25955 @end defvar
25956
25957 @defvar gnus-registry-split-strategy
25958 This is a symbol, so it's best to change it from the Customize
25959 interface. By default it's @code{nil}, but you may want to set it to
25960 @code{majority} or @code{first} to split by sender or subject based on
25961 the majority of matches or on the first found. I find @code{majority}
25962 works best.
25963 @end defvar
25964
25965 @node Store custom flags and keywords
25966 @subsection Store custom flags and keywords
25967
25968 The registry lets you set custom flags and keywords per message. You
25969 can use the Gnus->Registry Marks menu or the @kbd{M M x} keyboard
25970 shortcuts, where @code{x} is the first letter of the mark's name.
25971
25972 @defvar gnus-registry-marks
25973 The custom marks that the registry can use. You can modify the
25974 default list, if you like. If you do, you'll have to exit Emacs
25975 before they take effect (you can also unload the registry and reload
25976 it or evaluate the specific macros you'll need, but you probably don't
25977 want to bother). Use the Customize interface to modify the list.
25978
25979 By default this list has the @code{Important}, @code{Work},
25980 @code{Personal}, @code{To-Do}, and @code{Later} marks. They all have
25981 keyboard shortcuts like @kbd{M M i} for Important, using the first
25982 letter.
25983 @end defvar
25984
25985 @defun gnus-registry-mark-article
25986 Call this function to mark an article with a custom registry mark. It
25987 will offer the available marks for completion.
25988 @end defun
25989
25990 You can use @code{defalias} to install a summary line formatting
25991 function that will show the registry marks. There are two flavors of
25992 this function, either showing the marks as single characters, using
25993 their @code{:char} property, or showing the marks as full strings.
25994
25995 @lisp
25996 ;; show the marks as single characters (see the :char property in
25997 ;; `gnus-registry-marks'):
25998 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-chars)
25999
26000 ;; show the marks by name (see `gnus-registry-marks'):
26001 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-names)
26002 @end lisp
26003
26004
26005 @node Store arbitrary data
26006 @subsection Store arbitrary data
26007
26008 The registry has a simple API that uses a Message-ID as the key to
26009 store arbitrary data (as long as it can be converted to a list for
26010 storage).
26011
26012 @defun gnus-registry-set-id-key (id key value)
26013 Store @code{value} under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26014 @end defun
26015
26016 @defun gnus-registry-get-id-key (id key)
26017 Get the data under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26018 @end defun
26019
26020 @defvar gnus-registry-extra-entries-precious
26021 If any extra entries are precious, their presence will make the
26022 registry keep the whole entry forever, even if there are no groups for
26023 the Message-ID and if the size limit of the registry is reached. By
26024 default this is just @code{(marks)} so the custom registry marks are
26025 precious.
26026 @end defvar
26027
26028 @node Other modes
26029 @section Interaction with other modes
26030
26031 @subsection Dired
26032 @cindex dired
26033
26034 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
26035 buffers. It is enabled with
26036 @lisp
26037 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
26038 @end lisp
26039
26040 @table @kbd
26041 @item C-c C-m C-a
26042 @findex gnus-dired-attach
26043 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
26044 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
26045 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
26046
26047 @item C-c C-m C-l
26048 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
26049 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
26050 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
26051 buffer.
26052
26053 @item C-c C-m C-p
26054 @findex gnus-dired-print
26055 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
26056 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
26057 @end table
26058
26059 @node Various Various
26060 @section Various Various
26061 @cindex mode lines
26062 @cindex highlights
26063
26064 @table @code
26065
26066 @item gnus-home-directory
26067 @vindex gnus-home-directory
26068 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
26069 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
26070
26071 @item gnus-directory
26072 @vindex gnus-directory
26073 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
26074 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
26075 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
26076
26077 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
26078 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
26079 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
26080 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
26081
26082 @item gnus-default-directory
26083 @vindex gnus-default-directory
26084 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
26085 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
26086 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
26087 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
26088 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
26089 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
26090
26091 @item gnus-verbose
26092 @vindex gnus-verbose
26093 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
26094 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
26095 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
26096 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
26097 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
26098
26099 @item gnus-verbose-backends
26100 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
26101 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
26102 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
26103
26104 @item gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26105 @vindex gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26106 This variable controls whether to add timestamps to messages that are
26107 controlled by @code{gnus-verbose} and @code{gnus-verbose-backends} and
26108 are issued. The default value is @code{nil} which means never to add
26109 timestamp. If it is @code{log}, add timestamps to only the messages
26110 that go into the @samp{*Messages*} buffer (in XEmacs, it is the
26111 @w{@samp{ *Message-Log*}} buffer). If it is neither @code{nil} nor
26112 @code{log}, add timestamps not only to log messages but also to the ones
26113 displayed in the echo area.
26114
26115 @item nnheader-max-head-length
26116 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
26117 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
26118 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
26119 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
26120 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
26121 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
26122 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
26123 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
26124 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
26125
26126 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
26127 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
26128 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
26129 read when doing the operation described above.
26130
26131 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26132 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26133 @cindex file names
26134 @cindex invalid characters in file names
26135 @cindex characters in file names
26136 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
26137 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
26138 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
26139
26140 @lisp
26141 @group
26142 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26143 '((?: . ?_)))
26144 @end group
26145 @end lisp
26146
26147 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
26148 Windows (phooey) systems.
26149
26150 @item gnus-hidden-properties
26151 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
26152 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
26153 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
26154 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
26155
26156 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
26157 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
26158 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
26159 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
26160 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
26161
26162 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
26163 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
26164 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
26165
26166 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26167 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26168
26169 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
26170 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
26171 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
26172 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
26173 group).
26174
26175 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
26176
26177 @item gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26178 @vindex gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26179 Groups in which links in html articles are considered all safe. The
26180 value may be a regexp matching those groups, a list of group names, or
26181 @code{nil}. This overrides @code{mm-w3m-safe-url-regexp}. The default
26182 value is @code{"\\`nnrss[+:]"}. This is effective only when emacs-w3m
26183 renders html articles, i.e., in the case @code{mm-text-html-renderer} is
26184 set to @code{w3m}. @xref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization,
26185 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}.
26186
26187 @end table
26188
26189 @node The End
26190 @chapter The End
26191
26192 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
26193 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
26194
26195 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
26196
26197 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
26198
26199 @quotation
26200 @strong{Te Deum}
26201
26202 @sp 1
26203 Not because of victories @*
26204 I sing,@*
26205 having none,@*
26206 but for the common sunshine,@*
26207 the breeze,@*
26208 the largess of the spring.
26209
26210 @sp 1
26211 Not for victory@*
26212 but for the day's work done@*
26213 as well as I was able;@*
26214 not for a seat upon the dais@*
26215 but at the common table.@*
26216 @end quotation
26217
26218
26219 @node Appendices
26220 @chapter Appendices
26221
26222 @menu
26223 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
26224 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
26225 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
26226 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
26227 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
26228 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
26229 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
26230 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
26231 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
26232 @end menu
26233
26234
26235 @node XEmacs
26236 @section XEmacs
26237 @cindex XEmacs
26238 @cindex installing under XEmacs
26239
26240 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
26241 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
26242 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
26243 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
26244 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
26245 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
26246
26247
26248 @node History
26249 @section History
26250
26251 @cindex history
26252 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
26253 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
26254
26255 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
26256 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
26257 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
26258 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
26259 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
26260
26261 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
26262 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
26263 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
26264 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
26265 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
26266 appropriate name, don't you think?)
26267
26268 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
26269 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
26270 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
26271 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
26272
26273 @menu
26274 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
26275 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
26276 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
26277 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
26278 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
26279 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
26280 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
26281 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
26282 @end menu
26283
26284
26285 @node Gnus Versions
26286 @subsection Gnus Versions
26287 @cindex ding Gnus
26288 @cindex September Gnus
26289 @cindex Red Gnus
26290 @cindex Quassia Gnus
26291 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
26292 @cindex Oort Gnus
26293 @cindex No Gnus
26294 @cindex Ma Gnus
26295 @cindex Gnus versions
26296
26297 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
26298 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
26299 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
26300
26301 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
26302 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
26303
26304 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
26305 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
26306
26307 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
26308 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
26309
26310 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
26311 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
26312 1999.
26313
26314 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
26315 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
26316
26317 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
26318
26319 On April 19, 2010 Gnus development was moved to Git. See
26320 http://git.gnus.org for details (http://www.gnus.org will be updated
26321 with the information when possible).
26322
26323 On the January 31th 2012, Ma Gnus was begun.
26324
26325 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
26326 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
26327 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'', ``Ma Gnus'' -- don't
26328 panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly.
26329 Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of
26330 its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to
26331 that instead.
26332
26333
26334 @node Why?
26335 @subsection Why?
26336
26337 What's the point of Gnus?
26338
26339 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
26340 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
26341 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
26342 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
26343 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
26344 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
26345 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
26346 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
26347 keep track of millions of people who post?
26348
26349 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
26350 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
26351 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
26352 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
26353 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
26354 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
26355 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
26356 every one of you to explore and invent.
26357
26358 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
26359 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
26360
26361
26362 @node Compatibility
26363 @subsection Compatibility
26364
26365 @cindex compatibility
26366 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
26367 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
26368 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
26369
26370 Our motto is:
26371 @quotation
26372 @cartouche
26373 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
26374 @end cartouche
26375 @end quotation
26376
26377 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
26378 their names.
26379
26380 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
26381 Articles}.
26382
26383 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
26384 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
26385 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
26386 important variables have their values copied into their global
26387 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
26388 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
26389
26390 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
26391 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
26392 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
26393 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
26394 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
26395 peculiar results.
26396
26397 @cindex hilit19
26398 @cindex highlighting
26399 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
26400 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
26401 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
26402 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
26403 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
26404 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
26405 Away!
26406
26407 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
26408 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
26409 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
26410 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
26411
26412 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
26413 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
26414 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
26415 to stop doing it the old way.
26416
26417 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
26418
26419 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26420 @findex gnus-bug
26421 @cindex reporting bugs
26422 @cindex bugs
26423 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
26424 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
26425 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
26426
26427 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
26428 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
26429 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
26430 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
26431 up at you.
26432
26433
26434 @node Conformity
26435 @subsection Conformity
26436
26437 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
26438 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
26439 with, of course.
26440
26441 @table @strong
26442
26443 @item RFC (2)822
26444 @cindex RFC 822
26445 @cindex RFC 2822
26446 There are no known breaches of this standard.
26447
26448 @item RFC 1036
26449 @cindex RFC 1036
26450 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
26451
26452 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
26453 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
26454 We do have some breaches to this one.
26455
26456 @table @emph
26457
26458 @item X-Newsreader
26459 @itemx User-Agent
26460 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
26461 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
26462 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
26463 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
26464 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
26465 @end table
26466
26467 @item USEFOR
26468 @cindex USEFOR
26469 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
26470 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
26471 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
26472 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
26473
26474 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
26475 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
26476 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
26477
26478 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
26479 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
26480
26481 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
26482 @cindex RFC 1991
26483 @cindex RFC 2440
26484 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
26485 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
26486 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
26487 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
26488 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
26489 decryption).
26490
26491 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
26492 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
26493 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
26494 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
26495
26496 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
26497 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
26498
26499 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
26500 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
26501 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
26502 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
26503 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
26504 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
26505 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
26506 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
26507
26508 @end table
26509
26510 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
26511 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
26512 know.
26513
26514
26515 @node Emacsen
26516 @subsection Emacsen
26517 @cindex Emacsen
26518 @cindex XEmacs
26519 @cindex Mule
26520 @cindex Emacs
26521
26522 This version of Gnus should work on:
26523
26524 @itemize @bullet
26525
26526 @item
26527 Emacs 21.1 and up.
26528
26529 @item
26530 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
26531
26532 @end itemize
26533
26534 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
26535 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
26536 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
26537 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
26538
26539 @c No-merge comment: The paragraph added in v5-10 here must not be
26540 @c synced here!
26541
26542 @node Gnus Development
26543 @subsection Gnus Development
26544
26545 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
26546 discussion on the development mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}, where people
26547 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
26548 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
26549 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
26550 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
26551 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
26552 have names like ``Oort Gnus'' and ``No Gnus''. @xref{Gnus Versions}.
26553
26554 After futzing around for 10-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
26555 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
26556 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.10.1'' instead. Normal people are
26557 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
26558 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup. This newgroup is mirrored to the
26559 mailing list @samp{info-gnus-english@@gnu.org} which is carried on Gmane
26560 as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.user}. These releases are finally integrated
26561 in Emacs.
26562
26563 @cindex Incoming*
26564 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26565 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26566 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26567 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26568 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26569
26570 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
26571 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
26572 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
26573 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
26574 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
26575 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
26576 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
26577 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
26578 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
26579 can't be assumed to do so.
26580
26581 So if you have problems with or questions about the alpha versions,
26582 direct those to the ding mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}. This list
26583 is also available on Gmane as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.general}.
26584
26585 @cindex Incoming*
26586 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26587 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26588 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26589 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26590 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26591
26592 @node Contributors
26593 @subsection Contributors
26594 @cindex contributors
26595
26596 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
26597 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
26598 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
26599 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
26600 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
26601 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
26602 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
26603 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
26604 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
26605 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
26606
26607 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
26608 wrong show.
26609
26610 @itemize @bullet
26611
26612 @item
26613 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
26614
26615 @item
26616 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el,
26617 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
26618 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
26619 functionality and stuff.
26620
26621 @item
26622 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
26623 well as numerous other things).
26624
26625 @item
26626 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
26627
26628 @item
26629 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
26630
26631 @item
26632 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
26633
26634 @item
26635 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
26636
26637 @item
26638 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
26639 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
26640
26641 @item
26642 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
26643
26644 @item
26645 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section.
26646
26647 @item
26648 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
26649
26650 @item
26651 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
26652
26653 @item
26654 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bug detection and fixes.
26655
26656 @item
26657 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
26658
26659 @item
26660 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
26661 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
26662
26663 @item
26664 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
26665
26666 @item
26667 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
26668
26669 @item
26670 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
26671
26672 @item
26673 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
26674 .newsrc files.
26675
26676 @item
26677 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
26678
26679 @item
26680 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
26681
26682 @item
26683 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
26684
26685 @item
26686 Fran@,{c}ois Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
26687 well as autoconf support.
26688
26689 @end itemize
26690
26691 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
26692 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
26693
26694 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
26695
26696 Christopher Davis,
26697 Andrew Eskilsson,
26698 Kai Grossjohann,
26699 Kevin Greiner,
26700 Jesper Harder,
26701 Paul Jarc,
26702 Simon Josefsson,
26703 David K@aa{}gedal,
26704 Richard Pieri,
26705 Fabrice Popineau,
26706 Daniel Quinlan,
26707 Michael Shields,
26708 Reiner Steib,
26709 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
26710 Jack Vinson,
26711 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
26712 and
26713 Teodor Zlatanov.
26714
26715 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
26716
26717 Jari Aalto,
26718 Adrian Aichner,
26719 Vladimir Alexiev,
26720 Russ Allbery,
26721 Peter Arius,
26722 Matt Armstrong,
26723 Marc Auslander,
26724 Miles Bader,
26725 Alexei V. Barantsev,
26726 Frank Bennett,
26727 Robert Bihlmeyer,
26728 Chris Bone,
26729 Mark Borges,
26730 Mark Boyns,
26731 Lance A. Brown,
26732 Rob Browning,
26733 Kees de Bruin,
26734 Martin Buchholz,
26735 Joe Buehler,
26736 Kevin Buhr,
26737 Alastair Burt,
26738 Joao Cachopo,
26739 Zlatko Calusic,
26740 Massimo Campostrini,
26741 Castor,
26742 David Charlap,
26743 Dan Christensen,
26744 Kevin Christian,
26745 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
26746 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
26747 Laura Conrad,
26748 Michael R. Cook,
26749 Glenn Coombs,
26750 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
26751 Neil Crellin,
26752 Frank D. Cringle,
26753 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
26754 Andre Deparade,
26755 Ulrik Dickow,
26756 Dave Disser,
26757 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
26758 Joev Dubach,
26759 Michael Welsh Duggan,
26760 Dave Edmondson,
26761 Paul Eggert,
26762 Mark W. Eichin,
26763 Karl Eichwalder,
26764 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
26765 Michael Ernst,
26766 Luc Van Eycken,
26767 Sam Falkner,
26768 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
26769 Sigbjorn Finne,
26770 Sven Fischer,
26771 Paul Fisher,
26772 Decklin Foster,
26773 Gary D. Foster,
26774 Paul Franklin,
26775 Guy Geens,
26776 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
26777 David S. Goldberg,
26778 Michelangelo Grigni,
26779 Dale Hagglund,
26780 D. Hall,
26781 Magnus Hammerin,
26782 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
26783 Raja R. Harinath,
26784 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
26785 P. E. Jareth Hein,
26786 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
26787 Scott Hofmann,
26788 Tassilo Horn,
26789 Marc Horowitz,
26790 Gunnar Horrigmo,
26791 Richard Hoskins,
26792 Brad Howes,
26793 Miguel de Icaza,
26794 Fran@,{c}ois Felix Ingrand,
26795 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
26796 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
26797 Lee Iverson,
26798 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
26799 Rajappa Iyer,
26800 Andreas Jaeger,
26801 Adam P. Jenkins,
26802 Randell Jesup,
26803 Fred Johansen,
26804 Gareth Jones,
26805 Greg Klanderman,
26806 Karl Kleinpaste,
26807 Michael Klingbeil,
26808 Peter Skov Knudsen,
26809 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
26810 Petr Konecny,
26811 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
26812 Thor Kristoffersen,
26813 Jens Lautenbacher,
26814 Martin Larose,
26815 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
26816 Joerg Lenneis,
26817 Carsten Leonhardt,
26818 James LewisMoss,
26819 Christian Limpach,
26820 Markus Linnala,
26821 Dave Love,
26822 Mike McEwan,
26823 Tonny Madsen,
26824 Shlomo Mahlab,
26825 Nat Makarevitch,
26826 Istvan Marko,
26827 David Martin,
26828 Jason R. Mastaler,
26829 Gordon Matzigkeit,
26830 Timo Metzemakers,
26831 Richard Mlynarik,
26832 Lantz Moore,
26833 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
26834 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
26835 Hrvoje Niksic,
26836 Andy Norman,
26837 Fred Oberhauser,
26838 C. R. Oldham,
26839 Alexandre Oliva,
26840 Ken Olstad,
26841 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
26842 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
26843 Ettore Perazzoli,
26844 William Perry,
26845 Stephen Peters,
26846 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
26847 Ulrich Pfeifer,
26848 Matt Pharr,
26849 Andy Piper,
26850 John McClary Prevost,
26851 Bill Pringlemeir,
26852 Mike Pullen,
26853 Jim Radford,
26854 Colin Rafferty,
26855 Lasse Rasinen,
26856 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
26857 Joe Reiss,
26858 Renaud Rioboo,
26859 Roland B. Roberts,
26860 Bart Robinson,
26861 Christian von Roques,
26862 Markus Rost,
26863 Jason Rumney,
26864 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
26865 Jay Sachs,
26866 Dewey M. Sasser,
26867 Conrad Sauerwald,
26868 Loren Schall,
26869 Dan Schmidt,
26870 Ralph Schleicher,
26871 Philippe Schnoebelen,
26872 Andreas Schwab,
26873 Randal L. Schwartz,
26874 Danny Siu,
26875 Matt Simmons,
26876 Paul D. Smith,
26877 Jeff Sparkes,
26878 Toby Speight,
26879 Michael Sperber,
26880 Darren Stalder,
26881 Richard Stallman,
26882 Greg Stark,
26883 Sam Steingold,
26884 Paul Stevenson,
26885 Jonas Steverud,
26886 Paul Stodghill,
26887 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
26888 Kurt Swanson,
26889 Samuel Tardieu,
26890 Teddy,
26891 Chuck Thompson,
26892 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
26893 Philippe Troin,
26894 James Troup,
26895 Trung Tran-Duc,
26896 Jack Twilley,
26897 Aaron M. Ucko,
26898 Aki Vehtari,
26899 Didier Verna,
26900 Vladimir Volovich,
26901 Jan Vroonhof,
26902 Stefan Waldherr,
26903 Pete Ware,
26904 Barry A. Warsaw,
26905 Christoph Wedler,
26906 Joe Wells,
26907 Lee Willis,
26908 and
26909 Lloyd Zusman.
26910
26911
26912 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
26913 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
26914 (550kB and counting).
26915
26916 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
26917 sure.
26918
26919 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
26920 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
26921
26922
26923 @node New Features
26924 @subsection New Features
26925 @cindex new features
26926
26927 @menu
26928 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
26929 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
26930 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
26931 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
26932 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
26933 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
26934 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13.
26935 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
26936 @end menu
26937
26938 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
26939 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
26940 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
26941
26942 @node ding Gnus
26943 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
26944
26945 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
26946
26947 @itemize @bullet
26948
26949 @item
26950 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
26951 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
26952
26953 @item
26954 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
26955 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
26956
26957 @item
26958 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
26959
26960 @item
26961 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
26962 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
26963 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
26964
26965 @item
26966 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
26967 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
26968 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
26969 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
26970
26971 @item
26972 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
26973 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
26974
26975 @item
26976 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
26977 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
26978 (@pxref{The Active File}).
26979
26980 @item
26981 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
26982 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
26983
26984 @item
26985 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
26986 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
26987 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
26988
26989 @item
26990 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
26991 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
26992 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
26993
26994 @item
26995 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
26996 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
26997
26998 @item
26999 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
27000 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
27001
27002 @item
27003 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
27004 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27005
27006 @item
27007 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
27008 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
27009
27010 @item
27011 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
27012 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27013
27014 @item
27015 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
27016
27017 @item
27018 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
27019 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
27020
27021 @item
27022 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
27023 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
27024
27025 @item
27026 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
27027 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
27028
27029 @item
27030 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
27031
27032 @item
27033 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
27034 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27035
27036 @item
27037 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
27038 Articles}).
27039
27040 @item
27041 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
27042 Buttons}).
27043
27044 @item
27045 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
27046 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
27047
27048 @end itemize
27049
27050
27051 @node September Gnus
27052 @subsubsection September Gnus
27053
27054 @iftex
27055 @iflatex
27056 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
27057 @end iflatex
27058 @end iftex
27059
27060 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
27061
27062 @itemize @bullet
27063
27064 @item
27065 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
27066 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
27067 now obsolete.
27068
27069 @item
27070 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
27071 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
27072 Threading}).
27073
27074 @lisp
27075 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
27076 @end lisp
27077
27078 @item
27079 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
27080 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
27081
27082 @item
27083 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
27084 referred.
27085
27086 @item
27087 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions.
27088
27089 @item
27090 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
27091
27092 @item
27093 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
27094
27095 @lisp
27096 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
27097 @end lisp
27098
27099 @item
27100 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
27101 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
27102
27103 @lisp
27104 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
27105 @end lisp
27106
27107 @item
27108 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
27109 Groups}).
27110
27111 @item
27112 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
27113 Topics}).
27114
27115 @lisp
27116 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
27117 @end lisp
27118
27119 @item
27120 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
27121
27122 @item
27123 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
27124 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
27125
27126 @lisp
27127 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
27128 @end lisp
27129
27130 @item
27131 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
27132 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
27133
27134 @item
27135 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
27136
27137 @item
27138 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
27139 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
27140 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27141
27142 @item
27143 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets.
27144
27145 @item
27146 The Gnus cache is much faster.
27147
27148 @item
27149 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
27150 Groups}).
27151
27152 @item
27153 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
27154 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
27155
27156 @item
27157 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
27158 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
27159
27160 @item
27161 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
27162 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
27163
27164 @item
27165 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
27166 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
27167 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
27168
27169 @item
27170 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
27171 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
27172
27173 @item
27174 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
27175
27176 @item
27177 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27178
27179 @item
27180 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
27181
27182 @item
27183 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
27184
27185 @item
27186 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
27187 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
27188
27189 @item
27190 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
27191 Layout}).
27192
27193 @item
27194 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
27195 @iftex
27196 @iflatex
27197 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
27198 @end iflatex
27199 @end iftex
27200
27201 @item
27202 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27203
27204 @lisp
27205 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
27206 @end lisp
27207
27208 @item
27209 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
27210
27211 @item
27212 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
27213
27214 @item
27215 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
27216 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27217
27218 @lisp
27219 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
27220 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
27221 @end lisp
27222
27223 @item
27224 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
27225 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
27226
27227 @lisp
27228 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
27229 @end lisp
27230
27231 @item
27232 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
27233 buffer to allow easier treatment.
27234
27235 @item
27236 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
27237
27238 @item
27239 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
27240 Articles}).
27241
27242 @lisp
27243 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
27244 @end lisp
27245
27246 @item
27247 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
27248 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
27249
27250 @lisp
27251 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
27252 @end lisp
27253
27254 @item
27255 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
27256 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27257
27258 @item
27259 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
27260 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27261
27262 @lisp
27263 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
27264 @end lisp
27265
27266 @item
27267 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27268
27269 @item
27270 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
27271
27272 @item
27273 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
27274
27275 @end itemize
27276
27277
27278 @node Red Gnus
27279 @subsubsection Red Gnus
27280
27281 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
27282
27283 @iftex
27284 @iflatex
27285 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
27286 @end iflatex
27287 @end iftex
27288
27289 @itemize @bullet
27290
27291 @item
27292 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
27293
27294 @item
27295 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
27296 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27297
27298 @item
27299 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
27300 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
27301 Scoring}).
27302
27303 @item
27304 Article washing status can be displayed in the
27305 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
27306
27307 @item
27308 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
27309
27310 @item
27311 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
27312 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
27313
27314 @lisp
27315 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
27316 @end lisp
27317
27318 @item
27319 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
27320 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
27321 been added.
27322
27323 @item
27324 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extensible (@pxref{Document
27325 Server Internals}).
27326
27327 @item
27328 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
27329 Parameters}).
27330
27331 @item
27332 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
27333
27334 @item
27335 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
27336 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
27337
27338 @item
27339 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
27340 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
27341 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
27342
27343 @item
27344 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
27345 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27346
27347 @item
27348 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
27349 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
27350
27351 @item
27352 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
27353 (@pxref{Undo}).
27354
27355 @item
27356 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
27357 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27358
27359 @item
27360 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
27361 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27362
27363 @lisp
27364 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
27365 @end lisp
27366
27367 @item
27368 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
27369
27370 @lisp
27371 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
27372 @end lisp
27373
27374 @item
27375 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
27376 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27377
27378 @item
27379 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
27380 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27381
27382 @item
27383 A new command for reading collections of documents
27384 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
27385 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
27386
27387 @item
27388 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
27389 Marks}).
27390
27391 @item
27392 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
27393 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
27394
27395 @item
27396 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
27397 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
27398 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
27399
27400 @item
27401 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
27402 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
27403 Sorting}).
27404
27405 @item
27406 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
27407 Groups}).
27408
27409 @item
27410 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
27411 Commands}).
27412 @iftex
27413 @iflatex
27414 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
27415 @end iflatex
27416 @end iftex
27417
27418 @item
27419 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
27420 Variables}).
27421
27422 @item
27423 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
27424 Mail}).
27425
27426 @item
27427 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
27428 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
27429
27430 @item
27431 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
27432
27433 @end itemize
27434
27435
27436 @node Quassia Gnus
27437 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
27438
27439 New features in Gnus 5.6:
27440
27441 @itemize @bullet
27442
27443 @item
27444 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
27445 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
27446 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
27447
27448 @item
27449 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
27450 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
27451 group, which is created automatically.
27452
27453 @item
27454 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
27455 values.
27456
27457 @item
27458 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
27459
27460 @item
27461 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
27462 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
27463
27464 @item
27465 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
27466 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
27467
27468 @item
27469 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
27470
27471 @item
27472 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
27473 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
27474
27475 @item
27476 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
27477
27478 @item
27479 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
27480 details.
27481
27482 @item
27483 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
27484 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
27485
27486 @item
27487 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
27488 control over simplification.
27489
27490 @item
27491 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
27492
27493 @item
27494 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
27495 limit.
27496
27497 @item
27498 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
27499
27500 @item
27501 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
27502
27503 @item
27504 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
27505 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
27506 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
27507
27508 @item
27509 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
27510 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
27511
27512 @item
27513 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
27514 text---@kbd{W d}.
27515
27516 @item
27517 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
27518 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
27519
27520 @item
27521 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
27522 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
27523
27524 @item
27525 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
27526 has been added.
27527
27528 @item
27529 A history of where mails have been split is available.
27530
27531 @item
27532 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
27533
27534 @item
27535 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
27536 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
27537
27538 @item
27539 A new function for citing in Message has been
27540 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
27541
27542 @item
27543 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
27544
27545 @item
27546 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
27547 been added.
27548
27549 @item
27550 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
27551 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
27552
27553 @item
27554 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
27555 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
27556
27557 @item
27558 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
27559
27560 @item
27561 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
27562
27563 @end itemize
27564
27565 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
27566 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
27567
27568 New features in Gnus 5.8:
27569
27570 @itemize @bullet
27571
27572 @item
27573 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
27574 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
27575
27576 If you used procmail like in
27577
27578 @lisp
27579 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
27580 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
27581 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
27582 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
27583 @end lisp
27584
27585 this now has changed to
27586
27587 @lisp
27588 (setq mail-sources
27589 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
27590 :suffix ".in")))
27591 @end lisp
27592
27593 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
27594
27595 @item
27596 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
27597 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
27598
27599 @item
27600 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
27601 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
27602
27603 @item
27604 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
27605 called to position point.
27606
27607 @item
27608 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
27609 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
27610
27611 @item
27612 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
27613 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
27614
27615 @item
27616 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
27617 subtly different manner.
27618
27619 @item
27620 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
27621 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
27622 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
27623
27624 @item
27625 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
27626
27627 @end itemize
27628
27629 @node Oort Gnus
27630 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
27631 @cindex Oort Gnus
27632
27633 New features in Gnus 5.10:
27634
27635 @itemize @bullet
27636
27637 @item Installation changes
27638 @c ***********************
27639
27640 @itemize @bullet
27641 @item
27642 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
27643
27644 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
27645 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
27646 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
27647 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
27648 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
27649 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
27650 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
27651 isn't save in general.
27652
27653 @item
27654 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
27655 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
27656 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
27657 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
27658 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
27659 remove-installed-shadows}.
27660
27661 @item
27662 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
27663
27664 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
27665 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
27666 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
27667 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
27668 the second parameter.
27669
27670 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
27671 automatic recognition of XEmacs and Emacs, generates
27672 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
27673 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
27674 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
27675 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
27676 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
27677 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
27678 cycle used under Unix systems.
27679
27680 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
27681 superfluous, so they have been removed.
27682
27683 @item
27684 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
27685
27686 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
27687 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
27688 hierarchy.
27689
27690 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
27691 @c the repository. We should find a better place for this item.
27692 @item
27693 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
27694
27695 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
27696 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
27697 lisp directory into load-path.
27698
27699 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
27700 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
27701
27702 @end itemize
27703
27704 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
27705 @c *****************************************
27706
27707 @itemize @bullet
27708
27709 @item
27710 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
27711 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
27712
27713 @item
27714 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
27715
27716 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
27717 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GnuTLS.
27718
27719 @item
27720 Improved anti-spam features.
27721
27722 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
27723 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
27724 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
27725 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
27726 are also new. @ref{Thwarting Email Spam} and @ref{Spam Package}.
27727 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
27728
27729 @item
27730 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
27731
27732 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
27733 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
27734 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
27735 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
27736 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
27737
27738 @end itemize
27739
27740 @item Changes in group mode
27741 @c ************************
27742
27743 @itemize @bullet
27744
27745 @item
27746 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
27747 using @kbd{G M}.
27748
27749 @item
27750 Retrieval of charters and control messages
27751
27752 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
27753 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
27754
27755 @item
27756 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
27757
27758 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
27759 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
27760 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
27761 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
27762 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
27763 parameters, a'la:
27764 @lisp
27765 (setq gnus-parameters
27766 '(("mail\\..*"
27767 (gnus-show-threads nil)
27768 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
27769 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
27770 (to-group . "\\1"))))
27771 @end lisp
27772
27773 @item
27774 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
27775
27776 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
27777 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
27778 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
27779 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
27780 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
27781 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
27782 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
27783 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
27784 when getting new mail, remove the function.
27785
27786 @item
27787 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
27788
27789 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
27790 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
27791 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
27792
27793 @item
27794 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
27795 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
27796
27797 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
27798 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
27799 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
27800 @lisp
27801 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
27802 @end lisp
27803
27804 @item
27805 Old intermediate incoming mail files (@file{Incoming*}) are deleted
27806 after a couple of days, not immediately. @xref{Mail Source
27807 Customization}. (New in Gnus 5.10.10 / Emacs 22.2)
27808
27809 @end itemize
27810
27811 @item Changes in summary and article mode
27812 @c **************************************
27813
27814 @itemize @bullet
27815
27816 @item
27817 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
27818 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
27819 region if the region is active.
27820
27821 @item
27822 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
27823 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
27824
27825 @item
27826 Article Buttons
27827
27828 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
27829 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
27830 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
27831 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
27832
27833 @item
27834 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
27835
27836 @item
27837 Picons
27838
27839 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
27840 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
27841
27842 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
27843 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
27844 @xref{Picons}.
27845
27846 @item
27847 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
27848 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
27849
27850 @item
27851 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
27852
27853 @item
27854 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
27855 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
27856
27857 @item
27858 Warn about email replies to news
27859
27860 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
27861 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
27862 you.
27863
27864 @item
27865 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
27866 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
27867 built.
27868
27869 @item
27870 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
27871 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
27872
27873 @item
27874 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
27875 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
27876
27877 @item
27878 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
27879 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
27880
27881 @item
27882 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
27883
27884 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
27885 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
27886 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
27887 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
27888 citations.
27889
27890 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
27891 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
27892 Outlook (Express) articles.
27893
27894 @item
27895 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
27896
27897 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
27898 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
27899 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
27900 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
27901
27902 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
27903 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
27904 message cited below.
27905
27906 @item
27907 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now displayed graphically in
27908 Emacs too.
27909
27910 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
27911 disable it.
27912
27913 @item
27914 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
27915
27916 @item
27917 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
27918 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
27919
27920 @item
27921 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
27922
27923 @item
27924 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
27925
27926 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
27927 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
27928 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
27929 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
27930 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
27931 groups.
27932
27933 @item
27934 Deleting of attachments.
27935
27936 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
27937 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
27938 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
27939 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
27940 that support editing.
27941
27942 @item
27943 @code{gnus-default-charset}
27944
27945 The default value is determined from the
27946 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
27947 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
27948 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
27949
27950 @item
27951 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
27952
27953 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
27954 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
27955 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
27956
27957 @item
27958 Extended format specs.
27959
27960 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
27961 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
27962 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
27963 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
27964 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
27965 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
27966
27967 @item
27968 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
27969 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
27970
27971 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
27972 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
27973 out other articles.
27974
27975 @item
27976 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
27977
27978 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
27979 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
27980 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
27981 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
27982
27983 @item
27984 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
27985
27986 @end itemize
27987
27988 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
27989 @c ****************************************************
27990
27991 @itemize @bullet
27992
27993 @item
27994 Delayed articles
27995
27996 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
27997 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
27998 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
27999
28000 @item
28001 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
28002 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
28003
28004 @item
28005 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
28006 Gcc articles as read.
28007
28008 @item
28009 Externalizing of attachments
28010
28011 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
28012 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
28013 local files as external parts.
28014
28015 @item
28016 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
28017 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
28018
28019 @item
28020 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
28021
28022 Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
28023 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
28024 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
28025 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
28026 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
28027 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
28028 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
28029 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
28030 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
28031
28032 @item
28033 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
28034
28035 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
28036 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
28037 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
28038 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
28039 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
28040 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
28041
28042 @item
28043 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
28044 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
28045 @code{nil}.
28046
28047 @item
28048 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
28049
28050 @item
28051 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
28052
28053 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
28054 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
28055 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
28056 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
28057 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
28058 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
28059 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
28060 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
28061 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
28062 was inserted directly.
28063
28064 @item
28065 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
28066
28067 @c FIXME should that not be 'message-user-agent?
28068 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
28069 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
28070 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
28071 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
28072
28073 @item
28074 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
28075
28076 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
28077 @lisp
28078 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
28079 'bbdb-complete-name)
28080 @end lisp
28081
28082 @item
28083 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
28084
28085 Add a new format of match like
28086 @lisp
28087 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
28088 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28089 @end lisp
28090 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
28091 @lisp
28092 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
28093 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28094 @end lisp
28095
28096 @item
28097 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
28098
28099 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
28100 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
28101 need add those two headers too.
28102
28103 @item
28104 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
28105 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
28106 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
28107 versions.
28108
28109 @item
28110 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
28111 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
28112 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
28113 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
28114 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
28115
28116 @item
28117 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
28118
28119 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
28120
28121 @item
28122 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
28123
28124 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
28125 the valid values.
28126
28127 @item
28128 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
28129
28130 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
28131 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
28132 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
28133 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
28134 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
28135 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
28136 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
28137 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
28138
28139 @item
28140 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
28141 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
28142
28143 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
28144 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
28145 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
28146 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
28147
28148 @item
28149 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
28150 C-m}.
28151
28152 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
28153 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
28154
28155 @item
28156 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
28157 @code{best}.
28158
28159 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
28160 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
28161 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
28162 invalidate the digital signature.
28163
28164 @item
28165 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
28166 decompressed when activated.
28167 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
28168
28169 @item
28170 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
28171
28172 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
28173 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
28174 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
28175 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
28176 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
28177 controls this.
28178
28179 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
28180 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
28181 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
28182 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.1)
28183
28184 @item @code{auto-fill-mode} is enabled by default in Message mode.
28185 See @code{message-fill-column}. @xref{Various Message Variables, ,
28186 Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
28187 @c New in Gnus 5.10.12 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.3)
28188
28189 @end itemize
28190
28191 @item Changes in back ends
28192 @c ***********************
28193
28194 @itemize @bullet
28195 @item
28196 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
28197
28198 @item
28199 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
28200
28201 @item
28202 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
28203
28204 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
28205
28206 @item
28207 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
28208
28209 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
28210 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
28211 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
28212 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
28213 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
28214 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
28215 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
28216 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
28217 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
28218 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
28219 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
28220
28221 @end itemize
28222
28223 @item Appearance
28224 @c *************
28225
28226 @itemize @bullet
28227
28228 @item
28229 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
28230 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
28231
28232 @item
28233 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
28234 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
28235 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
28236 message, Message Manual}).
28237
28238 @item
28239 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
28240 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars: @kbd{M-x
28241 customize-apropos RET -tool-bar$} should get you started. This is a new
28242 feature in Gnus 5.10.10. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
28243
28244 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
28245 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
28246 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
28247 in Gnus 5.10.9.
28248 @end itemize
28249
28250
28251 @item Miscellaneous changes
28252 @c ************************
28253
28254 @itemize @bullet
28255
28256 @item
28257 @code{gnus-agent}
28258
28259 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
28260 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
28261 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
28262 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
28263 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
28264 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
28265 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
28266 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
28267 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
28268 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
28269 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
28270 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
28271 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
28272 is not needed any more.
28273
28274 @item
28275 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
28276
28277 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
28278 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
28279 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
28280
28281 @item
28282 Dired integration
28283
28284 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
28285 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
28286 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
28287 entry.
28288
28289 @item
28290 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
28291
28292 @item
28293 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
28294
28295 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
28296
28297 @end itemize
28298
28299 @end itemize
28300
28301 @node No Gnus
28302 @subsubsection No Gnus
28303 @cindex No Gnus
28304
28305 New features in No Gnus:
28306 @c FIXME: Gnus 5.12?
28307
28308 @include gnus-news.texi
28309
28310 @node Ma Gnus
28311 @subsubsection Ma Gnus
28312 @cindex Ma Gnus
28313
28314 I'm sure there will be lots of text here. It's really spelled 真
28315 Gnus.
28316
28317 New features in Ma Gnus:
28318
28319 @itemize @bullet
28320
28321 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28322 @c ****************************************************
28323
28324 @itemize @bullet
28325
28326 @item
28327 The new hooks @code{gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook} and
28328 @code{gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook} are run before/after encoding
28329 the message body of the Gcc copy of a sent message. See
28330 @xref{Archived Messages}.
28331
28332 @end itemize
28333
28334 @end itemize
28335
28336 @iftex
28337
28338 @page
28339 @node The Manual
28340 @section The Manual
28341 @cindex colophon
28342 @cindex manual
28343
28344 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
28345 either @code{texi2dvi}
28346 @iflatex
28347 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
28348 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
28349 @end iflatex
28350 to get what you hold in your hands now.
28351
28352 The following conventions have been used:
28353
28354 @enumerate
28355
28356 @item
28357 This is a @samp{string}
28358
28359 @item
28360 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
28361
28362 @item
28363 This is a @file{file}
28364
28365 @item
28366 This is a @code{symbol}
28367
28368 @end enumerate
28369
28370 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
28371 mean:
28372
28373 @lisp
28374 (setq flargnoze "yes")
28375 @end lisp
28376
28377 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
28378
28379 @lisp
28380 (setq flumphel 'yes)
28381 @end lisp
28382
28383 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
28384 ever get them confused.
28385
28386 @iflatex
28387 @c @head
28388 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
28389 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
28390 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
28391 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
28392 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
28393 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
28394 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
28395 @end iflatex
28396
28397 @end iftex
28398
28399
28400 @node On Writing Manuals
28401 @section On Writing Manuals
28402
28403 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
28404 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
28405 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
28406 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
28407 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
28408 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
28409 in hand.
28410
28411 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
28412 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
28413 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
28414 started with Gnus.
28415
28416 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
28417 reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
28418
28419
28420 @page
28421 @node Terminology
28422 @section Terminology
28423
28424 @cindex terminology
28425 @table @dfn
28426
28427 @item news
28428 @cindex news
28429 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
28430 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
28431 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
28432 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
28433 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
28434
28435 @item mail
28436 @cindex mail
28437 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
28438 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
28439 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
28440 not posting, and replying is not following up.
28441
28442 @item reply
28443 @cindex reply
28444 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
28445
28446 @item follow up
28447 @cindex follow up
28448 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
28449 are reading.
28450
28451 @item back end
28452 @cindex back end
28453 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
28454 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
28455 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
28456 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
28457 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
28458 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
28459 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
28460 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
28461 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
28462 number 4711''.
28463
28464 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
28465 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
28466 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
28467 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
28468 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
28469 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
28470
28471 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
28472 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
28473 access the articles.
28474
28475 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
28476 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
28477 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
28478 confusing.
28479
28480 @item native
28481 @cindex native
28482 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
28483 default, way of getting news. Groups from the native select method
28484 have names like @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}.
28485
28486 @item foreign
28487 @cindex foreign
28488 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same
28489 time. These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends
28490 for getting news. Foreign groups have names like
28491 @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28492
28493 @item secondary
28494 @cindex secondary
28495 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and
28496 being foreign, but they mostly act like they are native, but they, too
28497 have names like @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28498
28499 @item article
28500 @cindex article
28501 A message that has been posted as news.
28502
28503 @item mail message
28504 @cindex mail message
28505 A message that has been mailed.
28506
28507 @item message
28508 @cindex message
28509 A mail message or news article
28510
28511 @item head
28512 @cindex head
28513 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
28514 put.
28515
28516 @item body
28517 @cindex body
28518 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
28519 body.
28520
28521 @item header
28522 @cindex header
28523 A line from the head of an article.
28524
28525 @item headers
28526 @cindex headers
28527 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
28528 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
28529
28530 @item @acronym{NOV}
28531 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
28532 @acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
28533 header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
28534 of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
28535 back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
28536 Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
28537
28538 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
28539 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
28540 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
28541 normal @sc{head} format.
28542
28543 The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
28544 Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
28545 where each line has the header information of one article. The header
28546 information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
28547 an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
28548 references, etc.
28549
28550 Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
28551 the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
28552 for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
28553 parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
28554 Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
28555 (@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
28556 know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
28557
28558 @item level
28559 @cindex levels
28560 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
28561 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
28562 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
28563 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
28564 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
28565 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
28566
28567 @item killed groups
28568 @cindex killed groups
28569 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
28570 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
28571
28572 @item zombie groups
28573 @cindex zombie groups
28574 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
28575
28576 @item active file
28577 @cindex active file
28578 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
28579 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
28580 is rather large, as you might surmise.
28581
28582 @item bogus groups
28583 @cindex bogus groups
28584 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
28585 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
28586 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
28587
28588 @item activating
28589 @cindex activating groups
28590 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
28591 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
28592 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
28593
28594 @item spool
28595 @cindex spool
28596 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
28597 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
28598 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
28599
28600 @item server
28601 @cindex server
28602 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
28603
28604 @item select method
28605 @cindex select method
28606 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
28607 server settings.
28608
28609 @item virtual server
28610 @cindex virtual server
28611 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
28612 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
28613 whole is a virtual server.
28614
28615 @item washing
28616 @cindex washing
28617 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
28618 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
28619 original.
28620
28621 @item ephemeral groups
28622 @cindex ephemeral groups
28623 @cindex temporary groups
28624 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
28625 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
28626 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
28627
28628 @item solid groups
28629 @cindex solid groups
28630 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
28631 group buffer are solid groups.
28632
28633 @item sparse articles
28634 @cindex sparse articles
28635 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
28636 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
28637
28638 @item threading
28639 @cindex threading
28640 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
28641 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
28642
28643 @item root
28644 @cindex root
28645 @cindex thread root
28646 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
28647 articles in the thread.
28648
28649 @item parent
28650 @cindex parent
28651 An article that has responses.
28652
28653 @item child
28654 @cindex child
28655 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
28656
28657 @item digest
28658 @cindex digest
28659 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
28660 specified by RFC 1153.
28661
28662 @item splitting
28663 @cindex splitting, terminology
28664 @cindex mail sorting
28665 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
28666 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
28667 incorrectly called mail filtering.
28668
28669 @end table
28670
28671
28672 @page
28673 @node Customization
28674 @section Customization
28675 @cindex general customization
28676
28677 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
28678 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
28679 for some quite common situations.
28680
28681 @menu
28682 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
28683 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
28684 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
28685 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
28686 @end menu
28687
28688
28689 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
28690 @subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
28691
28692 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
28693 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
28694 Gnus has to get from the server.
28695
28696 @table @code
28697
28698 @item gnus-read-active-file
28699 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
28700 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
28701 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28702 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
28703 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
28704
28705 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
28706 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
28707 Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
28708 default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
28709 (@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
28710 Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
28711 instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
28712 @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
28713 @acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
28714 headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
28715 Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
28716
28717 As the variables for the other back ends, there are
28718 @code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
28719 @code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
28720 @code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, and @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}. Note that a
28721 non-@code{nil} value for @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those
28722 variables.
28723 @end table
28724
28725
28726 @node Slow Terminal Connection
28727 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
28728
28729 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
28730 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
28731 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
28732
28733 @table @code
28734
28735 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
28736 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
28737 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
28738 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
28739 horizontal and vertical recentering.
28740
28741 @item gnus-visible-headers
28742 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
28743 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
28744 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
28745 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
28746
28747 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
28748 @lisp
28749 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
28750 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
28751 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
28752 @end lisp
28753
28754 @item gnus-use-full-window
28755 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
28756 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
28757 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
28758 want to read them anyway.
28759
28760 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
28761 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
28762 hidden initially.
28763
28764
28765 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
28766 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
28767 lines, which might save some time.
28768 @end table
28769
28770
28771 @node Little Disk Space
28772 @subsection Little Disk Space
28773 @cindex disk space
28774
28775 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
28776 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
28777
28778 @table @code
28779
28780 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
28781 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
28782 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28783 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28784 default.
28785
28786 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
28787 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
28788 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28789 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28790 default.
28791
28792 @item gnus-save-killed-list
28793 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
28794 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
28795 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
28796 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
28797
28798 @end table
28799
28800
28801 @node Slow Machine
28802 @subsection Slow Machine
28803 @cindex slow machine
28804
28805 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
28806 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
28807
28808 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28809 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
28810
28811 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
28812 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
28813 summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
28814
28815
28816 @page
28817 @node Troubleshooting
28818 @section Troubleshooting
28819 @cindex troubleshooting
28820
28821 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
28822 problems, really.
28823
28824 Ahem.
28825
28826 @enumerate
28827
28828 @item
28829 Make sure your computer is switched on.
28830
28831 @item
28832 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
28833 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
28834 Gnus will work.
28835
28836 @item
28837 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
28838 like @c
28839 @samp{Gnus v5.13} @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change this line!
28840 @c
28841 you have the right files loaded. Otherwise you have some old @file{.el}
28842 files lying around. Delete these.
28843
28844 @item
28845 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
28846 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
28847
28848 @item
28849 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
28850 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
28851 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
28852 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
28853 something like that.
28854 @end enumerate
28855
28856 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
28857
28858 @cindex bugs
28859 @cindex reporting bugs
28860
28861 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
28862 @findex gnus-bug
28863 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
28864 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
28865 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
28866 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
28867
28868 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
28869 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
28870 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
28871 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
28872 time.
28873
28874 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
28875 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
28876 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
28877 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
28878 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
28879 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
28880
28881 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
28882 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
28883 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
28884 the bug report.
28885
28886 @cindex patches
28887 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
28888 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
28889
28890 @cindex edebug
28891 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
28892 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
28893 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
28894 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
28895 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
28896 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
28897 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
28898 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
28899 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
28900 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
28901 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
28902 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
28903 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
28904 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
28905
28906 @cindex elp
28907 @cindex profile
28908 @cindex slow
28909 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
28910 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
28911 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
28912 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
28913 helps isolating the real problem areas).
28914
28915 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
28916 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
28917 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
28918 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
28919 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
28920 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
28921 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
28922 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
28923 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
28924 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
28925 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
28926 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
28927 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
28928 work perfectly.
28929
28930 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
28931 @cindex ding mailing list
28932 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
28933 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
28934 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
28935 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
28936
28937
28938 @page
28939 @node Gnus Reference Guide
28940 @section Gnus Reference Guide
28941
28942 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
28943 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
28944 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
28945 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
28946 it.
28947
28948 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
28949 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
28950 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
28951 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
28952 and general methods of operation.
28953
28954 @menu
28955 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
28956 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
28957 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
28958 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
28959 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
28960 * Group Info:: The group info format.
28961 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
28962 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
28963 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
28964 @end menu
28965
28966
28967 @node Gnus Utility Functions
28968 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
28969 @cindex Gnus utility functions
28970 @cindex utility functions
28971 @cindex functions
28972 @cindex internal variables
28973
28974 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
28975 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
28976 Below is a list of the most common ones.
28977
28978 @table @code
28979
28980 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
28981 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
28982 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
28983
28984 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
28985 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
28986 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
28987
28988 @item gnus-group-real-name
28989 @findex gnus-group-real-name
28990 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
28991 name.
28992
28993 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
28994 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
28995 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
28996 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
28997
28998 @item gnus-get-info
28999 @findex gnus-get-info
29000 Returns the group info list for @var{group} (@pxref{Group Info}).
29001
29002 @item gnus-group-unread
29003 @findex gnus-group-unread
29004 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
29005 unknown.
29006
29007 @item gnus-active
29008 @findex gnus-active
29009 The active entry (i.e., a cons cell containing the lowest and highest
29010 article numbers) for @var{group}.
29011
29012 @item gnus-set-active
29013 @findex gnus-set-active
29014 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
29015
29016 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29017 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29018 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
29019 exit.
29020
29021 @item gnus-continuum-version
29022 @findex gnus-continuum-version
29023 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
29024 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
29025 versions.
29026
29027 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
29028 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
29029 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
29030
29031 @item gnus-news-group-p
29032 @findex gnus-news-group-p
29033 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
29034
29035 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29036 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29037 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
29038
29039 @item gnus-server-to-method
29040 @findex gnus-server-to-method
29041 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
29042
29043 @item gnus-server-equal
29044 @findex gnus-server-equal
29045 Says whether two virtual servers are essentially equal. For instance,
29046 two virtual servers may have server parameters in different order, but
29047 this function will consider them equal.
29048
29049 @item gnus-group-native-p
29050 @findex gnus-group-native-p
29051 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
29052
29053 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
29054 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
29055 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
29056
29057 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
29058 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
29059 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
29060
29061 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
29062 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
29063 Returns the parameter list of @var{group} (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
29064 If given a second parameter, returns the value of that parameter for
29065 @var{group}.
29066
29067 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
29068 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
29069 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
29070
29071 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
29072 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
29073 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
29074
29075 @item gnus-check-backend-function
29076 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
29077 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
29078 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
29079
29080 @lisp
29081 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
29082 @result{} t
29083 @end lisp
29084
29085 @item gnus-read-method
29086 @findex gnus-read-method
29087 Prompts the user for a select method.
29088
29089 @end table
29090
29091
29092 @node Back End Interface
29093 @subsection Back End Interface
29094
29095 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
29096 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
29097 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
29098 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
29099 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
29100 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
29101
29102 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
29103 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
29104 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
29105 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
29106 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
29107 been opened, the function should fail.
29108
29109 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
29110 name. Take this example:
29111
29112 @lisp
29113 (nntp "odd-one"
29114 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
29115 (nntp-port-number 4324))
29116 @end lisp
29117
29118 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
29119 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
29120
29121 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
29122 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
29123 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
29124
29125 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
29126 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
29127 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
29128
29129 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
29130 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
29131 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
29132 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
29133 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
29134 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
29135 return value.
29136
29137 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
29138 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
29139 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
29140 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
29141 more.
29142
29143 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
29144 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
29145 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
29146 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
29147 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
29148 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
29149 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
29150 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
29151 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
29152 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
29153
29154 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
29155 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
29156 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
29157 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
29158 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
29159 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
29160 of numbers as long as possible.
29161
29162 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
29163 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
29164 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
29165
29166 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
29167 @code{nnchoke}.
29168
29169 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
29170
29171 @menu
29172 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
29173 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
29174 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
29175 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
29176 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
29177 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
29178 @end menu
29179
29180
29181 @node Required Back End Functions
29182 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
29183
29184 @table @code
29185
29186 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
29187
29188 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
29189 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
29190 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
29191 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
29192
29193 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
29194 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
29195 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
29196 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
29197
29198 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
29199 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
29200 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
29201 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
29202 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
29203 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
29204 number, do maximum fetches.
29205
29206 Here's an example HEAD:
29207
29208 @example
29209 221 1056 Article retrieved.
29210 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
29211 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
29212 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
29213 Subject: Re: Something very droll
29214 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
29215 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
29216 Lines: 26
29217 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
29218 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
29219 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
29220 .
29221 @end example
29222
29223 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
29224 these in the data buffer.
29225
29226 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
29227
29228 @example
29229 headers = *head
29230 head = error / valid-head
29231 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
29232 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
29233 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
29234 header = <text> eol
29235 @end example
29236
29237 @cindex BNF
29238 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
29239
29240 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
29241 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
29242 separated by tabs.
29243
29244 @example
29245 nov-buffer = *nov-line
29246 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
29247 field = <text except TAB>
29248 @end example
29249
29250 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
29251 @pxref{Headers}.
29252
29253
29254 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
29255
29256 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
29257 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
29258
29259 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
29260 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
29261 server. In fact, it should do so.
29262
29263 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
29264 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
29265
29266
29267 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
29268
29269 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
29270 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
29271 reason.
29272
29273 There should be no data returned.
29274
29275
29276 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
29277
29278 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
29279 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
29280 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
29281 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
29282
29283 There should be no data returned.
29284
29285
29286 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
29287
29288 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
29289 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
29290 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
29291 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
29292
29293 There should be no data returned.
29294
29295
29296 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
29297
29298 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
29299
29300 There should be no data returned.
29301
29302
29303 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
29304
29305 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
29306 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
29307 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
29308 it would be nice if that were possible.
29309
29310 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
29311 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
29312 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
29313 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
29314 into its article buffer.
29315
29316 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
29317 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
29318 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
29319 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
29320 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
29321 on successful article retrieval.
29322
29323
29324 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST INFO)
29325
29326 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
29327 making @var{group} the current group.
29328
29329 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
29330 the current group.
29331
29332 If @var{info}, it allows the backend to update the group info
29333 structure.
29334
29335 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
29336
29337 @example
29338 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
29339 @end example
29340
29341 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
29342 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
29343 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
29344 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
29345 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
29346 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
29347 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
29348 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
29349 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
29350 highest as 0.
29351
29352 @example
29353 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
29354 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
29355 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
29356 @end example
29357
29358
29359 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29360
29361 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
29362 a no-op on most back ends.
29363
29364 There should be no data returned.
29365
29366
29367 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
29368
29369 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
29370 @emph{all}.
29371
29372 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
29373
29374 @example
29375 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
29376 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
29377 @end example
29378
29379 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
29380 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
29381 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
29382 and the highest as 0.
29383
29384 @example
29385 active-file = *active-line
29386 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
29387 name = <string>
29388 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
29389 @end example
29390
29391 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
29392 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
29393 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
29394
29395
29396 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
29397
29398 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
29399 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
29400 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
29401 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
29402 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
29403 clear if the posting could not be completed.
29404
29405 There should be no result data from this function.
29406
29407 @end table
29408
29409
29410 @node Optional Back End Functions
29411 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
29412
29413 @table @code
29414
29415 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
29416
29417 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
29418 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
29419 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
29420
29421 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
29422 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
29423 former is in the same format as the data from
29424 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
29425 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
29426
29427 @example
29428 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
29429 @end example
29430
29431
29432 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
29433
29434 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
29435 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
29436 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
29437 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
29438 should return a non-@code{nil} value (exceptionally,
29439 @code{nntp-request-update-info} always returns @code{nil} not to waste
29440 the network resources).
29441
29442 There should be no result data from this function.
29443
29444
29445 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
29446
29447 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
29448 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
29449 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
29450 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
29451 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
29452 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
29453 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
29454 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
29455
29456 There should be no result data from this function.
29457
29458
29459 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
29460
29461 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
29462 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
29463 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
29464 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
29465 propagate the mark information to the server.
29466
29467 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
29468
29469 @example
29470 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
29471 @end example
29472
29473 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
29474 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
29475 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
29476 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
29477 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
29478 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend}, and
29479 @code{forward}, but your back end should, if possible, not limit
29480 itself to these.
29481
29482 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
29483 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
29484 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
29485 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
29486
29487 An example action list:
29488
29489 @example
29490 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
29491 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
29492 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
29493 @end example
29494
29495 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
29496 mark on (currently not used for anything).
29497
29498 There should be no result data from this function.
29499
29500 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
29501
29502 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
29503 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
29504 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
29505 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
29506 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
29507
29508 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
29509 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
29510 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
29511 expirable.
29512
29513 There should be no result data from this function.
29514
29515
29516 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
29517
29518 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
29519 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
29520 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
29521 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
29522 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
29523 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
29524 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
29525 local if that's practical.
29526
29527 There should be no result data from this function.
29528
29529
29530 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
29531
29532 The result data from this function should be a description of
29533 @var{group}.
29534
29535 @example
29536 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
29537 name = <string>
29538 description = <text>
29539 @end example
29540
29541 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
29542
29543 The result data from this function should be the description of all
29544 groups available on the server.
29545
29546 @example
29547 description-buffer = *description-line
29548 @end example
29549
29550
29551 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
29552
29553 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
29554 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
29555 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
29556 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
29557 in the active buffer format.
29558
29559 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
29560 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
29561 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
29562 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
29563 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
29564 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
29565 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
29566
29567
29568 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29569
29570 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
29571
29572 There should be no return data.
29573
29574
29575 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
29576
29577 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
29578 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
29579 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
29580 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
29581 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
29582 they are.
29583
29584 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
29585 able to delete.
29586
29587 There should be no result data returned.
29588
29589
29590 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
29591
29592 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
29593 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
29594
29595 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
29596 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
29597 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
29598 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
29599 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
29600 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
29601
29602 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
29603 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
29604 optimizations.
29605
29606 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29607 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29608
29609 There should be no data returned.
29610
29611
29612 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
29613
29614 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
29615 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
29616 this function in short order.
29617
29618 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29619 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29620
29621 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
29622 article for that group.
29623
29624 There should be no data returned.
29625
29626
29627 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
29628
29629 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
29630 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
29631
29632 There should be no data returned.
29633
29634
29635 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
29636
29637 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
29638 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
29639 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
29640
29641 There should be no data returned.
29642
29643
29644 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
29645
29646 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
29647 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
29648
29649 There should be no data returned.
29650
29651 @end table
29652
29653
29654 @node Error Messaging
29655 @subsubsection Error Messaging
29656
29657 @findex nnheader-report
29658 @findex nnheader-get-report
29659 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
29660 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
29661 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
29662 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
29663 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
29664 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
29665
29666 @lisp
29667 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
29668
29669 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
29670 @end lisp
29671
29672 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
29673 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
29674 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
29675 takes one argument---the server symbol.
29676
29677 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
29678 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
29679 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
29680
29681
29682 @node Writing New Back Ends
29683 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
29684
29685 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
29686 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
29687 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
29688 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
29689 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
29690 editing articles.
29691
29692 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
29693 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
29694 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
29695
29696 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
29697 package called @code{nnoo}.
29698
29699 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
29700 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
29701 following macros:
29702
29703 @table @code
29704
29705 @item nnoo-declare
29706 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
29707 parameters. For instance:
29708
29709 @lisp
29710 (nnoo-declare nndir
29711 nnml nnmh)
29712 @end lisp
29713
29714 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
29715 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
29716
29717 @item defvoo
29718 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
29719 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
29720 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
29721
29722 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
29723 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
29724 a function in those back ends.
29725
29726 @lisp
29727 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29728 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29729 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29730 @end lisp
29731
29732 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
29733 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
29734 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
29735
29736 @item nnoo-define-basics
29737 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
29738 have.
29739
29740 @lisp
29741 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29742 @end lisp
29743
29744 @item deffoo
29745 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
29746 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
29747 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
29748
29749 @item nnoo-map-functions
29750 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
29751 functions from the parent back ends.
29752
29753 @lisp
29754 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29755 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29756 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
29757 @end lisp
29758
29759 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
29760 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
29761 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
29762 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
29763
29764 @item nnoo-import
29765 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
29766 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
29767 haven't already been defined.
29768
29769 @lisp
29770 (nnoo-import nndir
29771 (nnmh
29772 nnmh-request-list
29773 nnmh-request-newgroups)
29774 (nnml))
29775 @end lisp
29776
29777 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
29778 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
29779 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
29780 defined now.
29781
29782 @end table
29783
29784 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
29785
29786 @lisp
29787 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
29788 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
29789
29790 ;;; @r{Code:}
29791
29792 (require 'nnheader)
29793 (require 'nnmh)
29794 (require 'nnml)
29795 (require 'nnoo)
29796 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
29797
29798 (nnoo-declare nndir
29799 nnml nnmh)
29800
29801 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29802 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29803 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29804
29805 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
29806 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
29807 nnml-nov-is-evil)
29808
29809 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
29810 nil
29811 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
29812 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
29813 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
29814
29815 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
29816 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
29817
29818 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
29819
29820 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29821
29822 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
29823 (setq nndir-directory
29824 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
29825 server))
29826 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
29827 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
29828 (push `(nndir-current-group
29829 ,(file-name-nondirectory
29830 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29831 defs)
29832 (push `(nndir-top-directory
29833 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29834 defs)
29835 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
29836
29837 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29838 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29839 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29840 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
29841 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
29842
29843 (nnoo-import nndir
29844 (nnmh
29845 nnmh-status-message
29846 nnmh-request-list
29847 nnmh-request-newgroups))
29848
29849 (provide 'nndir)
29850 @end lisp
29851
29852
29853 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29854 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29855
29856 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
29857 @findex gnus-declare-backend
29858 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
29859 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
29860 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
29861
29862 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
29863 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
29864
29865 Here's an example:
29866
29867 @lisp
29868 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
29869 @end lisp
29870
29871 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
29872
29873 The abilities can be:
29874
29875 @table @code
29876 @item mail
29877 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
29878 @item post
29879 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
29880 @item post-mail
29881 This back end supports both mail and news.
29882 @item none
29883 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
29884 different.
29885 @item respool
29886 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
29887 articles and groups.
29888 @item address
29889 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
29890 true for almost all back ends.
29891 @item prompt-address
29892 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
29893 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
29894 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
29895 @end table
29896
29897
29898 @node Mail-like Back Ends
29899 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
29900
29901 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
29902 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
29903 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
29904 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
29905
29906 @lisp
29907 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
29908 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
29909 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
29910 @end lisp
29911
29912 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
29913 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
29914 mail.
29915
29916 This function takes four parameters.
29917
29918 @table @var
29919 @item method
29920 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
29921 the call.
29922
29923 @item exit-function
29924 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
29925
29926 @item temp-directory
29927 Where the temporary files should be stored.
29928
29929 @item group
29930 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
29931 performed for one group only.
29932 @end table
29933
29934 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
29935 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
29936 find the article number assigned to this article.
29937
29938 The function also uses the following variables:
29939 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
29940 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
29941 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
29942 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
29943 this:
29944
29945 @example
29946 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
29947 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
29948 @end example
29949
29950
29951 @node Score File Syntax
29952 @subsection Score File Syntax
29953
29954 Score files are meant to be easily parsable, but yet extremely
29955 malleable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
29956 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
29957
29958 Here's a typical score file:
29959
29960 @lisp
29961 (("summary"
29962 ("Windows 95" -10000 nil s)
29963 ("Gnus"))
29964 ("from"
29965 ("Lars" -1000))
29966 (mark -100))
29967 @end lisp
29968
29969 BNF definition of a score file:
29970
29971 @example
29972 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
29973 element = rule / atom
29974 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
29975 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
29976 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
29977 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
29978 quote = <ascii 34>
29979 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
29980 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
29981 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
29982 date-header = "date"
29983 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
29984 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
29985 score = "nil" / <integer>
29986 date = "nil" / <natural number>
29987 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
29988 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
29989 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
29990 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
29991 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
29992 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
29993 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
29994 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
29995 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
29996 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
29997 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
29998 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
29999 exclude-files / read-only / touched
30000 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
30001 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
30002 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
30003 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
30004 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
30005 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
30006 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
30007 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
30008 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
30009 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
30010 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
30011 eval = "eval" space <form>
30012 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
30013 @end example
30014
30015 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
30016 discarded.
30017
30018 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
30019 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
30020 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
30021 one looong line, then that's ok.
30022
30023 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
30024 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
30025
30026
30027 @node Headers
30028 @subsection Headers
30029
30030 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
30031 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
30032 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
30033 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
30034
30035 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
30036 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
30037 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
30038 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
30039 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
30040 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
30041 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
30042
30043 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
30044 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
30045 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
30046 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
30047 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
30048
30049 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
30050 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
30051
30052
30053 @node Ranges
30054 @subsection Ranges
30055
30056 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
30057 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
30058
30059 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
30060 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
30061 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
30062 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
30063
30064 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
30065 sequence.
30066
30067 @example
30068 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
30069 @end example
30070
30071 is transformed into
30072
30073 @example
30074 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
30075 @end example
30076
30077 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
30078 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
30079
30080 @example
30081 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
30082 @end example
30083
30084 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
30085 is slightly tricky:
30086
30087 @example
30088 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
30089 @end example
30090
30091 and
30092
30093 @example
30094 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
30095 @end example
30096
30097 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
30098
30099 @example
30100 (1 2 3 4 5)
30101 @end example
30102
30103 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
30104 also valid:
30105
30106 @example
30107 (1 . 5)
30108 @end example
30109
30110 and is equal to the previous range.
30111
30112 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
30113 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
30114 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
30115 range handling.)
30116
30117 @example
30118 range = simple-range / normal-range
30119 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
30120 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
30121 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
30122 number *[ " " contents ]
30123 @end example
30124
30125 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
30126 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
30127 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
30128 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
30129 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
30130 sequences.)
30131
30132
30133 @node Group Info
30134 @subsection Group Info
30135
30136 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
30137 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
30138 describes the group.
30139
30140 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
30141 second is a more complex one:
30142
30143 @example
30144 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
30145
30146 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
30147 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
30148 (nnml "")
30149 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
30150 @end example
30151
30152 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
30153 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
30154 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
30155 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
30156 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
30157 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
30158 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
30159 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
30160 this section is about.
30161
30162 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
30163 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
30164 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
30165
30166 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
30167
30168 @example
30169 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
30170 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
30171 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30172 group = quote <string> quote
30173 ralevel = rank / level
30174 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30175 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
30176 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30177 read = range
30178 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
30179 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
30180 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
30181 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
30182 @end example
30183
30184 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
30185 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
30186 in pseudo-BNF.
30187
30188 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
30189 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
30190
30191 @table @code
30192 @item gnus-info-group
30193 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
30194 @findex gnus-info-group
30195 @findex gnus-info-set-group
30196 Get/set the group name.
30197
30198 @item gnus-info-rank
30199 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
30200 @findex gnus-info-rank
30201 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
30202 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
30203
30204 @item gnus-info-level
30205 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
30206 @findex gnus-info-level
30207 @findex gnus-info-set-level
30208 Get/set the group level.
30209
30210 @item gnus-info-score
30211 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
30212 @findex gnus-info-score
30213 @findex gnus-info-set-score
30214 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
30215
30216 @item gnus-info-read
30217 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
30218 @findex gnus-info-read
30219 @findex gnus-info-set-read
30220 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
30221
30222 @item gnus-info-marks
30223 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
30224 @findex gnus-info-marks
30225 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
30226 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
30227
30228 @item gnus-info-method
30229 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
30230 @findex gnus-info-method
30231 @findex gnus-info-set-method
30232 Get/set the group select method.
30233
30234 @item gnus-info-params
30235 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
30236 @findex gnus-info-params
30237 @findex gnus-info-set-params
30238 Get/set the group parameters.
30239 @end table
30240
30241 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
30242 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
30243
30244 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
30245 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
30246 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
30247 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
30248
30249
30250 @node Extended Interactive
30251 @subsection Extended Interactive
30252 @cindex interactive
30253 @findex gnus-interactive
30254
30255 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
30256 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
30257 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
30258
30259 @lisp
30260 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
30261 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
30262 ...
30263 )
30264 @end lisp
30265
30266 The best thing to do would have been to implement
30267 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
30268 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
30269 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
30270 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
30271 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
30272 @code{interactive}.
30273
30274 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
30275 adds a few more.
30276
30277 @table @samp
30278 @item y
30279 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
30280 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
30281 variable.
30282
30283 @item Y
30284 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
30285 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
30286 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
30287
30288 @item A
30289 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
30290 function.
30291
30292 @item H
30293 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
30294 function.
30295
30296 @item g
30297 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
30298 function.
30299
30300 @end table
30301
30302
30303 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
30304 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
30305 @cindex XEmacs
30306 @cindex Emacsen
30307
30308 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
30309 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
30310 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
30311
30312 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
30313 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
30314 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
30315 Gnus, that's very useful.
30316
30317 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
30318 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
30319 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
30320 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
30321 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
30322 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
30323 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
30324 following function:
30325
30326 @lisp
30327 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
30328 (start-itimer
30329 "gnus-run-at-time"
30330 `(lambda ()
30331 (,function ,@@args))
30332 time repeat))
30333 @end lisp
30334
30335 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
30336 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
30337 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
30338 all over.
30339
30340 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
30341 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
30342 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
30343
30344 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
30345 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
30346 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
30347
30348
30349 @node Various File Formats
30350 @subsection Various File Formats
30351
30352 @menu
30353 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
30354 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
30355 @end menu
30356
30357
30358 @node Active File Format
30359 @subsubsection Active File Format
30360
30361 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
30362 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
30363 in each group.
30364
30365 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
30366
30367 @example
30368 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
30369 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
30370 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
30371 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
30372 no.general 1000 900 y
30373 @end example
30374
30375 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
30376
30377 @example
30378 active = *group-line
30379 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
30380 group = <non-white-space string>
30381 spc = " "
30382 high-number = <non-negative integer>
30383 low-number = <positive integer>
30384 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
30385 @end example
30386
30387 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
30388 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
30389
30390
30391 @node Newsgroups File Format
30392 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
30393
30394 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
30395 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
30396 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
30397 the user.
30398
30399 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
30400 Here's the definition:
30401
30402 @example
30403 newsgroups = *line
30404 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
30405 group = <non-white-space string>
30406 tab = <TAB>
30407 description = <string>
30408 @end example
30409
30410
30411 @page
30412 @node Emacs for Heathens
30413 @section Emacs for Heathens
30414
30415 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
30416 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
30417 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
30418 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
30419 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
30420 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
30421 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
30422 cat instead.
30423
30424 @menu
30425 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
30426 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
30427 @end menu
30428
30429
30430 @node Keystrokes
30431 @subsection Keystrokes
30432
30433 @itemize @bullet
30434 @item
30435 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
30436
30437 @item
30438 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
30439 @end itemize
30440
30441 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
30442 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
30443 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
30444 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
30445 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
30446 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
30447
30448 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
30449 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
30450 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
30451 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
30452 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
30453 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
30454 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
30455
30456 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
30457 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
30458 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
30459 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
30460 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
30461 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
30462 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
30463
30464 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
30465 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
30466 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
30467 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
30468 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
30469 it.
30470
30471
30472
30473 @node Emacs Lisp
30474 @subsection Emacs Lisp
30475
30476 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
30477 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
30478 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
30479 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
30480
30481 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
30482 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
30483 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
30484 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
30485 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
30486 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
30487 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
30488 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
30489 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
30490 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
30491
30492 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
30493 write the following:
30494
30495 @lisp
30496 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
30497 @end lisp
30498
30499 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
30500 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
30501 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
30502 change how Gnus works.
30503
30504 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
30505 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
30506 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
30507 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
30508 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
30509
30510 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
30511 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
30512 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
30513
30514 Some pitfalls:
30515
30516 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
30517 that means:
30518
30519 @lisp
30520 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
30521 @end lisp
30522
30523 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server-file} to
30524 @samp{/etc/nntpserver}'', that means:
30525
30526 @lisp
30527 (setq gnus-nntp-server-file "/etc/nntpserver")
30528 @end lisp
30529
30530 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
30531 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
30532
30533 @page
30534 @include gnus-faq.texi
30535
30536 @node GNU Free Documentation License
30537 @chapter GNU Free Documentation License
30538 @include doclicense.texi
30539
30540 @node Index
30541 @chapter Index
30542 @printindex cp
30543
30544 @node Key Index
30545 @chapter Key Index
30546 @printindex ky
30547
30548 @bye
30549
30550 @iftex
30551 @iflatex
30552 \end{document}
30553 @end iflatex
30554 @end iftex
30555
30556 @c Local Variables:
30557 @c mode: texinfo
30558 @c coding: utf-8
30559 @c End: